002 SM
002 SM
002 SM
D197/D198/D199/
D200/D201/D202
It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained
within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best
interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies.
DOCUMENTATION HISTORY
REV. NO. DATE COMMENTS
* 11/2014 Original Printing
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ............................................................................... 2-1
2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL ............................................................................. 2-1
2.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS ............................................... 2-1
2.1.4 MACHINE DIMENSIONS .................................................................. 2-2
2.1.5 POWER REQUIREMENTS .............................................................. 2-3
2.2 MAIN MACHINE INSTALLATION .............................................................. 2-4
2.2.1 IMPORTANT NOTICE ON SECURITY ISSUES ............................... 2-4
Overview .............................................................................................. 2-4
Password Setting Procedure ................................................................ 2-5
2.2.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART........................................................ 2-9
D197/D198/D199.................................................................................. 2-9
D200/D201/D202................................................................................ 2-10
2.2.3 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-11
2.2.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-12
Unloading ........................................................................................... 2-12
Tapes and Retainers .......................................................................... 2-12
Toner Bottle........................................................................................ 2-15
Paper Exit Tray Stopper ..................................................................... 2-20
Emblem, Decals ................................................................................. 2-21
Completion ......................................................................................... 2-22
2.2.5 SECURITY SETTINGS ................................................................... 2-22
2.2.6 CHECK IMAGE QUALITY / SETTINGS.......................................... 2-23
Loading Paper .................................................................................... 2-23
Checking the copy image with the test chart ...................................... 2-23
SP Settings ........................................................................................ 2-23
Upper Tray (Size Adjust Tray 1) ......................................................... 2-23
Lower Tray (Size Adjust Tray 2) ......................................................... 2-23
By-Pass Tray (By-Pass Size Detection) ............................................. 2-24
2.2.7 MOVING THE MACHINE ................................................................ 2-24
2.2.8 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE .................................................. 2-25
2.3 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3210/ PB3220 .................................................... 2-26
2.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-26
2.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-26
2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3150 ................................................................... 2-32
2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-32
2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-32
2.5 LCIT PB3170/ PB3230............................................................................. 2-37
2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-37
2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-37
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 ii SM
Changing the paper size .................................................................... 2-42
2.6 LCIT RT3030 ........................................................................................... 2-44
2.6.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-44
2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-44
Changing the Paper Size ................................................................... 2-50
2.7 CASTER TABLE TYPE M3 ...................................................................... 2-52
2.7.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-52
2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-52
For Installing Directly under the Main Machine .................................. 2-53
For Installing under PB3150 ............................................................... 2-54
2.8 PLATEN COVER PN2000 (D700) ........................................................... 2-56
2.8.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-56
2.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-56
2.9 ARDF DF3090 ......................................................................................... 2-59
2.9.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .................................................................... 2-59
2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-59
When feeding thin paper .................................................................... 2-63
2.10 SPDF DF3080 .................................................................................... 2-65
2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-65
2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-66
Attaching the SPDF ............................................................................ 2-66
Attaching the Sub IPU ........................................................................ 2-68
Adjust SP Settings.............................................................................. 2-73
2.11 BRIDGE UNIT BU3070 ...................................................................... 2-74
2.11.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-74
2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-74
2.12 1 BIN TRAY BN3110 .......................................................................... 2-78
2.12.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-78
2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-78
2.13 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3070 ...................................................... 2-85
2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-85
2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-85
2.14 SIDE TRAY TYPE M3 ........................................................................ 2-90
2.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-90
2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-91
2.15 BOOKLET FINISHER SR3170 / FINISHER SR3160 ......................... 2-94
2.15.1 ACCESSORY CHECK .............................................................. 2-94
Booklet Finisher SR3170 (D688) / Finisher SR3160 (D689) .............. 2-94
2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ................................................. 2-95
SM iii D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
2.15.3 ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLING THE FINISHER ............ 2-101
How to Check and Adjust the Side-to-Side Registration .................. 2-101
2.15.4 AUXILIARY TRAY ................................................................... 2-102
2.16 PUNCH UNIT PU3060 ..................................................................... 2-103
2.16.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-103
2.16.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-104
2.17 BOOKLET FINISHER SR3150 / FINISHER SR3140 ....................... 2-114
2.17.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-114
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140 .................................... 2-114
2.17.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-115
SR3150 ............................................................................................ 2-118
SR3140 ............................................................................................ 2-118
2.17.3 ADJUSTMENT AFTER INSTALLING FINISHER .................... 2-120
How to Check and Adjust the Side-to-Side Registration .................. 2-120
2.18 PUNCH UNIT PU3050 ..................................................................... 2-121
2.18.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-121
2.18.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-122
2.19 INTERNAL FINISHER SR3180 ........................................................ 2-134
2.19.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-134
2.19.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-135
Staple Setting as an Initial Setting.................................................... 2-144
2.20 INTERNAL FINISHER SR3130 ........................................................ 2-146
2.20.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-146
2.20.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-146
2.21 PUNCH UNIT PU3040 ..................................................................... 2-155
2.21.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-155
2.21.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-156
2.22 SMART OPERATION PANEL TYPE M3 .......................................... 2-161
2.22.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-161
2.22.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-161
2.23 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER TYPE M12 ................................. 2-165
2.23.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-165
2.23.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-166
Anti-Condensation Heater (Scanner) ............................................... 2-166
Anti-Condensation Heater (PCU) ..................................................... 2-176
2.24 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER FOR TRAYS .............................. 2-180
2.24.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-180
2.24.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-181
Anti-Condensation Heater for Paper Feed Tray (Main Unit)............. 2-181
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 iv SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Paper Feed Unit PB3210 / PB3220 .. 2-188
Anti-Condensation Heater for Paper Feed Unit PB3150 .................. 2-190
Anti-Condensation Heater for LCIT PB3170/ PB3230 ...................... 2-192
2.25 CARD READER BRACKET TYPE 3352 .......................................... 2-195
2.25.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-195
2.25.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-196
Scanner Right Cover ........................................................................ 2-198
Upper Rear Cover ............................................................................ 2-198
2.26 KEY COUNTER BRACKET TYPE M3 ............................................. 2-199
2.26.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-199
2.26.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-199
2.27 OPTIONAL COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT TYPE M12 .................... 2-203
2.27.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-203
2.27.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-203
2.28 SMART CARD READER BUILT-IN UNIT TYPE M12 ...................... 2-206
2.28.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-206
2.28.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-207
2.29 INTERNAL OPTIONS ...................................................................... 2-215
2.29.1 LIST OF SLOTS ...................................................................... 2-215
2.30 PRINTER/SCANNER UNIT TYPE M12 ........................................... 2-216
2.30.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-216
2.30.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-217
2.31 IEEE 1284 INTERFACE BOARD TYPE A ....................................... 2-221
2.31.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-221
2.31.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-222
2.32 IEEE 802.11A/G/N INTERFACE UNIT TYPE M2............................. 2-223
2.32.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-223
2.32.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-224
2.32.3 USER TOOL SETTINGS FOR IEEE 802.11A/G/N ................. 2-226
SP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 Wireless LAN ............................ 2-228
2.33 BLUETOOTH INTERFACE UNIT TYPE D ....................................... 2-229
2.33.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-229
2.33.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-229
2.34 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER TYPE E ............................................ 2-230
2.34.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-230
2.34.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-230
2.35 USB DEVICE SERVER OPTION TYPE M12 ................................... 2-232
2.35.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-232
Interface Board Surface ................................................................... 2-232
SM v D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
2.35.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-233
What Do the LED Indications Mean? ............................................... 2-236
Notes for Energy Save Mode Setting ............................................... 2-236
2.35.3 IP ADDRESS SETTING .......................................................... 2-237
2.36 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE G .......................................... 2-239
2.36.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-239
2.36.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-239
User Tool Setting.............................................................................. 2-241
2.37 HARD DISK DRIVE OPTION TYPE M12 ......................................... 2-242
2.37.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-242
2.37.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-243
2.38 SD CARD OPTION .......................................................................... 2-245
2.38.1 SD CARD SLOTS ................................................................... 2-245
2.38.2 LIST OF SLOTS USED ........................................................... 2-246
2.39 SD CARD APPLI MOVE .................................................................. 2-247
2.39.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 2-247
2.39.2 MOVE EXEC ........................................................................... 2-247
2.39.3 UNDO EXEC ........................................................................... 2-248
2.40 OCR UNIT TYPE M2........................................................................ 2-249
2.40.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ............................................................ 2-249
2.40.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-249
2.40.3 RECOVERY PROCEDURE .................................................... 2-252
2.41 BROWSER UNIT TYPE M12 ........................................................... 2-253
2.41.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-253
2.41.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-253
To update EXJS ............................................................................... 2-255
When checking the version of EXJS ................................................ 2-256
Browser unit uninstallation procedure .............................................. 2-257
2.41.3 SETTINGS .............................................................................. 2-257
Browser default setting ..................................................................... 2-257
2.42 SD CARD FOR NETWARE PRINTING TYPE M12 ......................... 2-258
2.42.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-258
2.42.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-258
2.43 POSTSCRIPT3 UNIT TYPE M12 ..................................................... 2-260
2.43.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-260
2.43.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-260
2.44 XPS DIRECT PRINT OPTION TYPE M12 ....................................... 2-262
2.44.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-262
2.44.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-262
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 vi SM
2.45 IPDS UNIT TYPE M12 ..................................................................... 2-264
2.45.1 ACCESSORIES ...................................................................... 2-264
2.45.2 INSTALLATION ....................................................................... 2-264
2.46 EXTERNAL KEYBOARD BRACKET TYPE M3 (D739-10) .............. 2-267
2.46.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................... 2-267
2.46.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-267
2.47 DATA OVERWRITE SECURITY UNIT TYPE I (D362) .................... 2-272
2.47.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 2-272
2.47.2 COMPONENT LIST ................................................................ 2-272
2.47.3 BEFORE YOU BEGIN THE PROCEDURE ............................. 2-272
Seal Check and Removal ................................................................. 2-273
2.47.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................... 2-274
2.48 SECURITY SETTING....................................................................... 2-275
2.48.1 SECURITY FUNCTION INSTALLATION ................................ 2-275
2.48.2 DATA OVERWRITE SECURITY ............................................. 2-276
Before You Begin the Procedure...................................................... 2-276
Using Auto Erase Memory ............................................................... 2-276
2.48.3 HDD ENCRYPTION ................................................................ 2-278
Before You Begin the Procedure:..................................................... 2-278
Enable Encryption Setting ................................................................ 2-278
Backing Up the Encryption Key ........................................................ 2-280
Encryption Key Restoration .............................................................. 2-281
2.49 @REMOTE SETTINGS ................................................................... 2-283
2.50 OPERATION GUIDANCE FOR USERS .......................................... 2-288
SM ix D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Procedure for the Scanner ................................................................. 4-65
4.8 LASER UNIT ............................................................................................ 4-66
4.8.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATION ....................................................... 4-66
4.8.2 LASER UNIT ................................................................................... 4-67
Removing the Laser Unit .................................................................... 4-67
Installing a New Laser Unit................................................................. 4-68
Mainframe Claws................................................................................ 4-68
Laser Unit Claws ................................................................................ 4-69
After Installing the New Laser Unit ..................................................... 4-70
4.8.3 QUENCHING LAMP ....................................................................... 4-70
4.8.4 PCL (PRE CLEANING LIGHT) ....................................................... 4-71
4.9 PCDU ....................................................................................................... 4-72
4.9.1 BEFORE REPLACING A PCU OR DEVELOPMENT UNIT ............ 4-72
4.9.2 PCDU.............................................................................................. 4-72
4.9.3 PCU/DEVELOPMENT UNIT ........................................................... 4-74
Notes When Installing the Face Plates............................................... 4-74
Face plate for front side...................................................................... 4-75
Face plate for rear side ...................................................................... 4-75
Installing a PCU.................................................................................. 4-75
Installing a Development Unit............................................................. 4-75
4.9.4 OPC DRUM .................................................................................... 4-77
4.9.5 CHARGE ROLLER, CLEANING ROLLER ...................................... 4-78
4.9.6 PICK-OFF PAWLS.......................................................................... 4-79
4.9.7 CLEANING BLADE ......................................................................... 4-80
4.9.8 DEVELOPER .................................................................................. 4-81
4.9.9 DEVELOPMENT FILTER ............................................................... 4-87
4.9.10 TD SENSOR ............................................................................. 4-88
4.9.11 DEVELOPMENT MIXING AUGER BEARINGS ........................ 4-89
4.9.12 DEVELOPMENT MIXING AUGER (L / R) ................................. 4-91
4.10 WASTE TONER ................................................................................. 4-93
4.10.1 WASTE TONER BOTTLE ......................................................... 4-93
4.10.2 TONER COLLECTION FULL SENSOR .................................... 4-93
4.10.3 RECYCLING SHUTTER SOLENOID ........................................ 4-94
4.10.4 RECYCLING SHUTTER ........................................................... 4-97
4.11 TRANSFER UNIT............................................................................... 4-99
4.11.1 TRANSFER UNIT...................................................................... 4-99
4.11.2 TRANSFER ROLLER UNIT .................................................... 4-101
4.11.3 ID SENSOR ............................................................................ 4-102
Before Replacing the ID Sensor ....................................................... 4-102
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 x SM
Replacement Procedure................................................................... 4-102
4.11.4 TRANSFER UNIT OPEN/CLOSE LED ................................... 4-103
4.11.5 TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY SENSOR ................................... 4-104
4.11.6 FUSING ENTRANCE SENSOR .............................................. 4-105
4.11.7 TRANSFER UNIT OPEN/CLOSE SENSOR ........................... 4-106
4.12 DRIVE UNIT ..................................................................................... 4-107
4.12.1 DRUM/WASTE TONER MOTOR ............................................ 4-107
4.12.2 DEVELOPMENT MOTOR ....................................................... 4-107
4.12.3 FUSING/PAPER EXIT MOTOR (D197/D199 ONLY) .............. 4-107
4.12.4 FUSING MOTOR (D200/D201/D202 ONLY)........................... 4-108
4.12.5 PAPER EXIT MOTOR (D200/D201/D202 ONLY) ................... 4-108
4.12.6 REGISTRATION MOTOR ....................................................... 4-108
4.12.7 PAPER FEED MOTOR ........................................................... 4-109
4.12.8 VERTICAL TRANSPORT MOTOR ......................................... 4-109
4.12.9 TRANSFER ROLLER CONTACT MOTOR ............................. 4-109
4.12.10 TONER HOPPER ................................................................ 4-110
4.12.11 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR ................................................... 4-112
4.13 FUSING UNIT .................................................................................. 4-114
4.13.1 FUSING UNIT ......................................................................... 4-114
Replacement .................................................................................... 4-114
4.13.2 FUSING ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE ..................................... 4-117
Cleaning the Fusing Entrance Guide Plate ...................................... 4-117
4.13.3 FUSING EXIT GUIDE PLATE ................................................. 4-118
4.13.4 FUSING UPPER COVER ........................................................ 4-119
4.13.5 FUSING LOWER COVER ....................................................... 4-120
4.13.6 HEATING SLEEVE BELT UNIT .............................................. 4-121
Replacement .................................................................................... 4-122
To Clear SC544-02 or SC554-02 ..................................................... 4-123
4.13.7 PRESSURE ROLLER AND PRESSURE ROLLER BEARINGS4-124
Adjustment before Replacing the Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller
Bearings ........................................................................................... 4-124
Replacement .................................................................................... 4-124
4.13.8 THERMOSTAT UNIT .............................................................. 4-126
4.13.9 FUSING ROLLER TEMPERATURE SENSOR ....................... 4-126
4.13.10 PRESSURE ROLLER TEMPERATURE SENSOR.............. 4-126
4.13.11 FUSING THERMOPILE ....................................................... 4-127
4.13.12 NOTES WHEN REASSEMBLING THE FUSING UNIT ....... 4-128
Harness route: when looking at the bottom of the fusing unit ........... 4-128
Harness route: when looking at the side of the fusing unit ............... 4-128
SM xi D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
4.14 PAPER EXIT .................................................................................... 4-129
4.14.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT .................................................................. 4-129
4.14.2 PAPER EXIT SWITCHING SOLENOID .................................. 4-130
4.14.3 PAPER EXIT SENSOR ........................................................... 4-131
4.14.4 REVERSE SENSOR ............................................................... 4-132
4.14.5 PAPER EXIT FULL SENSOR ................................................. 4-133
4.14.6 REVERSE MOTOR ................................................................. 4-134
4.14.7 FUSING EXIT SENSOR .......................................................... 4-135
4.15 PAPER FEED .................................................................................. 4-136
4.15.1 PAPER FEED UNIT ................................................................ 4-136
1st Paper Feed Unit ......................................................................... 4-136
2nd Paper Feed Unit ........................................................................ 4-137
4.15.2 PAPER DUST COLLECTION UNIT ........................................ 4-139
4.15.3 PICK-UP ROLLER, PAPER FEED ROLLER, SEPARATION
ROLLER, TORQUE LIMITER ................................................................ 4-141
4.15.4 1ST / 2ND PAPER FEED TRAY LIFT MOTOR ....................... 4-143
4.15.5 1ST / 2ND PAPER FEED SENSOR ........................................ 4-144
4.15.6 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR........................................ 4-145
4.15.7 LIMIT SENSOR ....................................................................... 4-146
4.15.8 1ST PAPER END SENSOR / 2ND PAPER END SENSOR .... 4-146
4.15.9 REGISTRATION SENSOR ..................................................... 4-148
4.16 DUPLEX UNIT ................................................................................. 4-149
4.16.1 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR ................................................... 4-149
4.16.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE MOTOR ............................................... 4-150
4.16.3 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR ............................................. 4-151
4.16.4 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR ......................................................... 4-153
4.17 BYPASS TRAY UNIT ....................................................................... 4-154
4.17.1 BYPASS TRAY ....................................................................... 4-154
4.17.2 BYPASS PAPER END SENSOR ............................................ 4-156
4.17.3 BYPASS PICK-UP ROLLER ................................................... 4-157
4.17.4 BYPASS PAPER FEED ROLLER ........................................... 4-158
4.17.5 BYPASS SEPARATION ROLLER........................................... 4-158
4.17.6 TORQUE LIMITER .................................................................. 4-158
4.17.7 BYPASS WIDTH SENSOR ..................................................... 4-159
4.17.8 BYPASS LENGTH SENSOR .................................................. 4-161
4.18 PCBS AND OTHER ITEMS ............................................................. 4-162
4.18.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 4-162
Around the Controller Box ................................................................ 4-162
Around the Power Supply Box ......................................................... 4-163
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 xii SM
4.18.2 IPU .......................................................................................... 4-164
IPU Sub (If SPDF is installed) .......................................................... 4-164
4.18.3 BCU......................................................................................... 4-165
When installing the new BCU ........................................................... 4-165
Replacing the NVRAM (EEPROM) on the BCU ............................... 4-166
4.18.4 CONTROLLER BOARD .......................................................... 4-167
NVRAM on the controller board ....................................................... 4-170
4.18.5 HDD ........................................................................................ 4-173
Adjustment after replacement .......................................................... 4-173
4.18.6 HVPS ...................................................................................... 4-174
4.18.7 PSU ......................................................................................... 4-175
PSU Fuse Location .......................................................................... 4-176
4.18.8 HEATER BOARD .................................................................... 4-176
4.18.9 CONTROLLER BOX ............................................................... 4-177
4.18.10 TEMPERATURE SENSOR ................................................. 4-179
4.19 FANS/FILTERS ................................................................................ 4-180
4.19.1 ODOR FILTER ........................................................................ 4-180
4.19.2 DUST FILTER ......................................................................... 4-181
4.19.3 DEVELOPMENT EXHAUST FAN ........................................... 4-182
4.19.4 PAPER EXIT COOLING FAN ................................................. 4-183
4.19.5 FUSING FAN .......................................................................... 4-184
4.19.6 DEVELOPMENT BEARING COOLING FAN (D200/D201/D202
ONLY) 4-185
4.19.7 PSU COOLING FAN (D200/D201/D202 ONLY) ..................... 4-186
4.20 ADJUSTMENT AFTER REPLACEMENT ......................................... 4-187
4.20.1 PRINTING ............................................................................... 4-187
Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side ........................................ 4-187
Blank Margin .................................................................................... 4-191
Main Scan Magnification .................................................................. 4-193
Parallelogram Image Adjustment ..................................................... 4-193
4.20.2 SCANNING ............................................................................. 4-195
Registration: Platen Mode ................................................................ 4-195
Magnification .................................................................................... 4-196
4.20.3 SCANNER WIRE .................................................................... 4-197
4.20.4 ADF IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ................................................... 4-197
Registration ...................................................................................... 4-197
Sub Scan Magnification.................................................................... 4-198
4.20.5 TOUCH SCREEN CALIBRATION ........................................... 4-199
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 xiv SM
5.13.1 SP8-XXX (DATA LOG 2)......................................................... 5-276
Keys and abbreviations in Data Log 2 .............................................. 5-277
5.14 SP MODE TABLES - SP8000-2 ....................................................... 5-310
5.14.1 SP8-XXX (DATA LOG 2)......................................................... 5-310
5.15 PRINTER SP MODE ........................................................................ 5-335
5.15.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) .................................................. 5-335
5.16 SCANNER SP MODE ...................................................................... 5-349
5.16.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS)....................................... 5-349
5.16.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY) .............................. 5-353
5.17 INPUT CHECK TABLE ..................................................................... 5-355
5.17.1 MAIN MACHINE INPUT CHECK.......................................... 5-355
5.17.2 ADF D779 INPUT CHECK ................................................... 5-368
5.17.3 1-PASS ADF D683 INPUT CHECK...................................... 5-369
5.17.4 2000/3000 SHEETS FINISHER D688 / D689 INPUT CHECK5-372
5.17.5 INTERNAL FINISHER D690 INPUT CHECK ....................... 5-379
5.17.6 1000 SHEETS FINISHER D687 INPUT CHECK.................. 5-380
5.17.7 BRIDGE UNIT D685 INPUT CHECK ................................... 5-384
5.17.8 INTERNAL FINISHER D766 INPUT CHECK ....................... 5-385
5.17.9 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY D691 INPUT CHECK ................... 5-386
5.17.10 1 BIN TRAY D692 INPUT CHECK ................................... 5-386
5.18 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE ................................................................. 5-387
5.18.1 MAIN MACHINE OUTPUT CHECK ...................................... 5-387
5.18.2 ADF D779 OUTPUT CHECK ............................................... 5-397
5.18.3 1-PASS ADF D683 OUTPUT CHECK.................................. 5-398
5.18.4 2000/3000 SHEETS FINISHER D688 / D689 OUTPUT CHECK
5-399
5.18.5 INTERNAL FINISHER D690 OUTPUT CHECK ................... 5-403
5.18.6 1000 SHEETS FINISHER D687 OUTPUT CHECK.............. 5-404
5.18.7 BRIDGE UNIT D685 OUTPUT CHECK ............................... 5-406
5.18.8 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY D691 OUTPUT CHECK ............... 5-406
5.18.9 INTERNAL FINISHER D766 OUTPUT CHECK ................... 5-407
5.19 TEST PATTERN PRINTING ............................................................ 5-408
5.20 FIRMWARE UPDATE ...................................................................... 5-410
5.20.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 5-410
5.20.2 FIRMWARE TYPE .................................................................. 5-410
5.20.3 PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 5-411
Update procedure............................................................................. 5-412
5.20.4 ERROR SCREENS DURING UPDATING .............................. 5-416
5.21 UPDATING JAVAVM ....................................................................... 5-424
SM xv D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
5.21.1 CREATING AN SD CARD FOR UPDATING ........................... 5-424
Updating Procedure ......................................................................... 5-424
List of Error Messages ..................................................................... 5-425
5.22 UPDATING THE EXJS ..................................................................... 5-428
5.22.1 TO UPDATE EXJS .................................................................. 5-428
5.22.2 WHEN CHECKING THE VERSION OF EXJS ........................ 5-430
5.23 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ............................................ 5-431
5.23.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD ........ 5-431
5.23.2 DOWNLOADING AN SD CARD TO NVRAM .......................... 5-432
5.24 UP/SP DATA IMPORT/EXPORT ..................................................... 5-433
5.24.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 5-433
Import/export conditions ................................................................... 5-433
5.24.2 UP DATA IMPORT/EXPORT .................................................. 5-433
Data that can be imported and exported .......................................... 5-433
Data that cannot be imported or exported ........................................ 5-434
Exporting Device Information ........................................................... 5-434
Importing Device Information ........................................................... 5-435
5.24.3 SP DATA IMPORT/EXPORT .................................................. 5-437
Data that can be imported and exported .......................................... 5-437
Exporting Device Information ........................................................... 5-437
Importing Device Information ........................................................... 5-439
5.24.4 POSSIBLE SOLUTIONS FOR IMPORT/EXPORT PROBLEMS5-440
5.25 ADDRESS BOOK EXPORT/IMPORT .............................................. 5-443
5.25.1 EXPORT ................................................................................. 5-443
5.25.2 IMPORT .................................................................................. 5-444
5.25.3 SPECIFICATION ..................................................................... 5-444
5.26 RFU UPDATING THE FIRMWARE .................................................. 5-445
5.26.1 RFU PERFORMABLE CONDITION ........................................ 5-445
5.27 PACKAGE FIRMWARE UPDATE .................................................... 5-446
5.27.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 5-446
Types of firmware update files, supported update methods: ............ 5-447
5.27.2 IMMEDIATE UPDATE ............................................................. 5-447
5.27.3 UPDATE AT THE NEXT VISIT (RESERVE) ........................... 5-450
How to Set the Machine to Download Firmware Later (RESERVE) . 5-450
How to Check if the Firmware Downloaded with RESERVE ............ 5-452
How to Install Firmware Downloaded with RESERVE ...................... 5-454
5.27.4 UPDATE VIA SD CARD .......................................................... 5-456
5.28 CAPTURING THE DEBUG LOGS ................................................... 5-459
5.28.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 5-459
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 xvi SM
Types of debug logs that can be saved ............................................ 5-459
Security of the Operation Log........................................................... 5-460
5.28.2 RETRIEVING THE DEBUG LOGS.......................................... 5-461
Procedure for Retrieving the Debug Log .......................................... 5-461
5.29 SP TEXT MODE (SAVING SMC LIST TO SD CARD) ..................... 5-463
5.29.1 OVERVIEW ............................................................................. 5-463
SP Text Mode .................................................................................. 5-463
5.29.2 PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 5-463
5.29.3 FILE NAMES OF THE SAVED SMC LISTS ............................ 5-465
5.29.4 ERROR MESSAGES .............................................................. 5-465
6. TROUBLESHOOTING................................................................... 6-1
6.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE ....................................................................... 6-1
6.1.1 SERVICE CALL CODES .................................................................. 6-1
Service Call Conditions ........................................................................ 6-1
6.1.2 SC LOGGING ................................................................................... 6-2
6.1.3 SC AUTOMATIC REBOOT ............................................................... 6-3
6.2 SC TABLES: SC1XX (SCANNING) ........................................................... 6-5
6.2.1 SC101-01 TO SC195-00................................................................... 6-5
6.3 SC TABLES: SC2XX (EXPOSURE) ........................................................ 6-15
6.3.1 SC202-00 TO SC270-10................................................................. 6-15
6.4 SC TABLES: SC3XX (IMAGE PROCESSING1 (CHARGE, DEVELOPMENT))
6-21
6.4.1 SC302-00 TO SC392-01................................................................. 6-21
6.5 SC TABLES: SC4XX (IMAGE PROCESSING2 (AROUND THE DRUM)) 6-27
6.5.1 SC440-00 TO SC498-00................................................................. 6-27
6.6 SC TABLES: SC5XX (PAPER FEED AND FUSING) .............................. 6-31
6.6.1 SC501-01 TO SC589-02................................................................. 6-31
6.7 SC TABLES: SC6XX (COMMUNICATION AND OTHERS) ..................... 6-69
6.7.1 SC620-01 TO SC687-00................................................................. 6-69
6.8 SC TABLES: SC7XX (PERIPHERALS) ................................................... 6-90
6.8.1 SC700-01 TO SC792-00................................................................. 6-90
6.9 SC TABLES: SC8XX ............................................................................. 6-128
6.9.1 SC816 TO SC899 ......................................................................... 6-128
6.10 SC TABLES: SC9XX (OTHERS)...................................................... 6-165
6.10.1 SC900-00 TO SC995-04 ......................................................... 6-165
6.11 WHEN SC549 IS DISPLAYED ......................................................... 6-171
6.11.1 TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART..................................... 6-171
6.11.2 FUSING SHIELD CHECK ....................................................... 6-172
6.11.3 SOLUTION .............................................................................. 6-175
SM xvii D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
6.12 JAM DETECTION ............................................................................ 6-176
6.12.1 PAPER JAM DISPLAY ............................................................ 6-176
6.12.2 JAM CODES AND DISPLAY CODES ..................................... 6-177
Main Machine ................................................................................... 6-177
ARDF DF3090.................................................................................. 6-180
ARDF DF3080.................................................................................. 6-181
Booklet Finisher SR3170/ Finisher SR3160 ..................................... 6-181
Booklet Finisher SR3150/ Finisher SR3140 ..................................... 6-183
Internal Finisher SR3130.................................................................. 6-185
Internal Finisher SR3180.................................................................. 6-186
6.12.3 SENSOR LOCATIONS ........................................................... 6-187
6.12.4 PAPER SIZE CODES ............................................................. 6-188
6.13 OTHER PROBLEMS ........................................................................ 6-189
6.13.1 WHEN SC670 IS DISPLAYED ................................................ 6-189
6.13.2 MARKS (VERTICAL STREAKS) ON PRINTS AND COPIES DUE TO
SCANNING PROBLEMS ....................................................................... 6-190
6.13.3 FINISHER REGISTRATION ADJUSTMENT ........................... 6-191
For SR3170/SR3160 ........................................................................ 6-191
For SR3150/SR3140 ........................................................................ 6-193
6.13.4 STACKING PROBLEM AT THE 1000-SHEET FINISHER ...... 6-196
Installation procedure for attaching the sheet................................... 6-196
Installation procedure for attaching the auxiliary tray to the 1000-sheet
finisher.............................................................................................. 6-197
6.13.5 EARLY PAPER FULL DETECTION AT THE 1000-SHEET FINISHER
6-199
Installation procedure ....................................................................... 6-199
6.13.6 FINISHER JOGGER PROBLEM ............................................. 6-200
Jogger Width Adjustment Procedure ................................................ 6-200
6.13.7 EARLY PAPER FULL DETECTION MYLAR FOR INTERNAL
FINISHER SR3130 (D690) .................................................................... 6-201
Pasting Mylar Procedure .................................................................. 6-201
6.13.8 HOW TO RE-INSTALL THE OCR UNIT TYPE M2 ................. 6-205
6.13.9 PAPER CURL PROBLEM FOR SR3180 ................................ 6-205
6.14 BLOWN FUSE CONDITION ............................................................ 6-208
Fuse: NA .......................................................................................... 6-208
Fuse: EU .......................................................................................... 6-209
Fuse Location................................................................................... 6-210
SM xix D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
READ THIS FIRST
The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace
only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard
used batteries in accordance with the manufacturers instructions.
Handling Toner
Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid
spilling toner on clothing or the hands.
If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well
ventilated location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water.
If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are
signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there
are signs of any problem, seek medical attention.
If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water. Never
use hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric.
Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages, cartridges,
and bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the reach of
children.
Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is
not exposed to direct sunlight.
Laser Safety
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical
units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the
requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer
Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore
directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when
replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
WARNING:
Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Unit
section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.
CAUTION MARKING:
Screw
Shoulder screw
Connector
Harness clamp
Clip
E-ring
C-ring
Timing belt
Spring
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of
PostScript is a registered trademark Microsoft Corporation in the United States and /or other
countries.of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
PRODUCT INFORMATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Product Overview
1. PRODUCT INFORMATION
Information
Product
1.1 PRODUCT OVERVIEW
SM 1-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
6 Duplex Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-2 SM
Product Overview
Information
No. Description No. Description Product
SM 1-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-4 SM
Product Overview
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
SM 1-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-6 SM
Product Overview
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
SM 1-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
Scanner Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-8 SM
Product Overview
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
1 1st paper feed sensor 9 1st paper feed tray set switch
2 1st vertical transport sensor 10 1st paper feed tray lift motor
3 1st paper end sensor 11 2nd paper feed tray set switch
4 1st paper feed tray limit sensor 12 2nd paper feed tray lift motor
6 2nd vertical transport sensor 14 1st paper feed tray size switch
7 2nd paper end sensor 15 2nd paper feed tray size switch
SM 1-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-10 SM
Product Overview
Fusing Unit
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
SM 1-11 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-12 SM
Product Overview
Duplex/Bypass Unit
Information
Product
SM 1-13 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
5 Reverse motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-14 SM
Product Overview
Air Flow
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
SM 1-15 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Product Overview
Drive Unit
4 Registration motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-16 SM
Product Overview
Electrical Component
Information
Product
No. Description No. Description
3 PSU 8 IPU
SM 1-17 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
CONFIGURATION
D197/D198/D199 (NA)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-18 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
5 LCIT PB3170 D695
SM 1-19 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D200/D201 (NA)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-20 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
9 Bridge Unit BU3070 D685
SM 1-21 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D202 (NA)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-22 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
11 Side Tray Type M3 D725
SM 1-23 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D197/D198/D199 (EU)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-24 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
9 Side Tray Type M3 D725
* Smart Operation Panel Type M3 (D148) is not provided as an option for Europe; however, Smart
Operation Panel embedded models are provided.
SM 1-25 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D200/D201 (EU)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-26 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
10 Internal Finisher SR3130 D690
* Smart Operation Panel Type M3 (D148) is not provided as an option for Europe; however, Smart
Operation Panel embedded models are provided.
SM 1-27 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D202 (EU)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-28 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
11 Booklet Finisher SR3150 D686
* Smart Operation Panel Type M3 (D148) is not provided as an option for Europe; however, Smart
Operation Panel embedded models are provided.
SM 1-29 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D197/D198/D199 (Asia)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-30 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
10 Bridge Unit BU3070 D685
SM 1-31 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D200/D201 (Asia)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-32 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
11 Bridge Unit BU3070 D685
D202 (Asia)
SM 1-33 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-34 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with The Predecessor Product
Information
Product
1.2.2 DIFFERENCES BETWEEN SIMILAR MODELS
FRR RF
Paper Feed Mainframe
(Friction Reverse Roller) (Roller Friction)
Fusing Web No No
VM Standard Standard
SM 1-35 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
FRR RF
Paper Feed Mainframe
(Friction Reverse Roller) (Roller Friction)
VM Option Standard
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 1-36 SM
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
Item D146 D197/D199/D200/D201/D202
SM 1-37 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Machine Codes and Peripherals Configuration
Information
Product
INSTALLATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SM 1-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Installation Requirements
2. INSTALLATION
Installation
2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT
1. Temperature Range: 10 C to 32 C (50 F to 89.6 F)
2. Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH
3. Ambient Illumination: Less than 1,500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight.)
4. Ventilation: Room air should turn over at least 3 times/hr/person
5. Ambient Dust: Less than 0.10 mg/m3
6. Avoid an area which is exposed to sudden temperature changes. This includes:
Areas directly exposed to cool air from an air conditioner.
Areas directly exposed to heat from a heater.
7. Do not place the machine in an area where it will be exposed to corrosive gases.
8. Do not install the machine at any location over 2,000 m (6,500 ft.) above sea level. (NA can
be installed only up to 2,500m (8,202 ft.))
9. Place the copier on a strong and level base. (Inclination on any side should be no more than 5
mm.)
10. Do not place the machine where it may be subjected to strong vibrations.
SM 2-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Installation Requirements
The 400 mm recommended for the space at the front is only for pulling out the paper tray.
If an operator stands at the front of the copier, more space is required.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-2 SM
Installation Requirements
Installation
Make sure that the wall outlet is near the copier and easily accessible.
Make sure the plug is firmly inserted in the outlet.
Avoid multi-wiring.
Be sure to ground the machine.
Input voltage level
120 V to 127 V, 60 Hz: More than 12 A: NA
220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: More than 8A: EU/AP
110V, 60 Hz: More than 13.6 A: Taiwan
220V,60Hz More than 8A:KO
Voltage tolerance
Voltage must not fluctuate by more than +8.66% or less than -10%.: NA
Voltage must not fluctuate by more than 10%.: EU/AP
SM 2-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
Overview
The following Program/Change Administrator screen is displayed at the first power-up.
When the customers set the administrator/supervisor login password, the display disappears
and the home display will appear. The customers, however, can erase this screen with the
following procedure if they think there is no need to set the password.
1. On the Program/Change Administrator screen, press [Change] next to Supervisor and
then touch [OK] without inputting any password.
2. Touch [OK] again when the Confirm password display shows up.
3. For Administrator 1, do the same procedure as steps 1 and 2.
4. Press the [OK] button, then the home display appears.
SP5-755-002 allows you to skip this screen temporarily and continue the installation
procedure without setting an administrator password. However, the Program/Change
Administrator screen appears every time you turn the power OFF/ON, if the password is not
set.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-4 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
For more details about this security issue, see Notes on Using Multi-Function Printers
Safely supplied with the MFP.
When Supervisor / Administrator 1-4 passwords are configured via network, the Change
Supervisor login password window will not display.
The passwords for Supervisor or Administrator 1 to 4 can be set via System Settings.
But the Program/Change Administrator screen appears every time the power switch is
turned ON if the passwords are input this way. So we recommend the customers to set
the passwords via network or the Program/Change Administrator screen.
1. Install the MFP.
2. Turn the main power switch ON.
3. Change the Supervisor login password.
5. Press [OK].
SM 2-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
7. Press [OK].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-6 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
9. Input the password.
SM 2-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-8 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
D197/D198/D199
SM 2-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
D200/D201/D202
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-10 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories in the box against the following list:
SM 2-11 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
Unloading
When unloading the main machine from a pallet, hold the specified locations. Holding the
scanner unit may deform the main machine. Note that the grip at the front right is hidden
by the cushioning material [A]. Remove the material to grip it.
Lift the main machine slowly, using two people.
Unplug the machine power cord before you start the following procedure.
If the optional paper feed unit, the optional LCT or the caster table is going to be installed now, put
the copier on these options, and then install the copier and options.
Keep the shipping retainers after installing the machine. They will be reused if the
machine is moved to another location in the future.
1. Remove the tapes on the exterior of the copier.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-12 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
If the ADF is installed, remove the tapes and retainers on the ADF as well.
3. Pull out the 1st and 2nd paper feed trays and remove the tapes and accessories.
SM 2-13 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
5. Open the front cover and store the scanner support [A] in the storage location.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-14 SM
Main Machine Installation
Toner Bottle
Installation
This machine has toner bottle set detection and does not operate without the toner bottle.
D197, D198, and D199 toner bottles are compatible with D200, D201, and D202.
However, D200, D201, and D202 toner bottles are incompatible with D197, D198, and
D199.
1. Open the front cover.
2. Make sure that the black cap of the toner bottle is firmly tightened, then shake the
toner bottle up and down seven or eight times while the cap faces upward.
Shaking the bottle while the cap faces downward causes a possible toner blockage.
3. Remove the toner bottle protection cap [A].
5. Turn on the main power switch while the front cover is open to execute the initial toner
supply.
SM 2-15 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
If the front cover is closed when executing the initial toner supply, the machine starts
a normal toner supply.
6. Enter SP mode from the copy application window, and then press [System Sp].
Initializing messages do not show up if you enter SP mode from the home screen, so
please make sure that you enter SP mode from the copy window.
7. Set the setting of SP3-510-031(ImgQltyAdj :ExeFlag: Init Toner Replenish: K) to 1,
and then press # on the operation panel.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-16 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
9. Close the front cover.
10. The machine automatically starts the initial toner supply.
It takes about one to two minutes to finish the initial toner supply. If the toner has not
been shaken well, it may take up to about 10 minutes.
If a toner bottle has not been set, the machine does not work because there is a
toner bottle set detection mechanism.
If you turn on the machine without closing the front cover, the initial toner supply is
not performed at installation, and the machine goes to the toner end condition even if
the machine has plenty of toner in the toner bottle.
11. Enter SP mode again, and then press [System Sp].
12. Enter SP7-622-250 (PM Counter Reset: SCS), and then press [Execute].
SM 2-17 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
14. Enter SP3-011-001 (Manual ProCon :Exe), and then press [Execute].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-18 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
16. Press [EXIT] to end the SP mode.
SM 2-19 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
Before installing the stopper, move the bar inside the stopper in order to avoid
damaging the bar.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-20 SM
Main Machine Installation
Emblem, Decals
Installation
1. Paste the decals on the specified locations.
SM 2-21 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
Completion
1. If the optional bridge unit is not to be installed, swing the sensor feeler [A] out.
2. Install the optional ARDF or the optional platen cover (page 2-59, page 2-56).
3. Pull out trays, and then adjust the side fences and end fence to match the paper size.
To move the side fences, first pull out the tray fully, then push down the green lock at
the rear of the tray.
4. Connect the power cord to the inlet of the main machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-22 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
Loading Paper
When there are other options to be installed, install according to the procedure for each.
1. Connect the power plug to the wall socket.
2. Turn the main power ON.
3. Check that the operation panel shows the following display.
"Please supply the tray with paper."
4. Square the paper and load it print side up.
5. The paper size is basically detected automatically.
1. Pull out the paper feed tray slowly until it stops.
2. While pressing the release lever, adjust the side fence to the paper size to be set.
3. Set the end fence.
SP Settings
1. Go into the SP mode.
2. Do SP5-181 and SP1-007-001 to change automatic paper size selection for the upper
tray, lower tray, and by-pass tray if necessary.
5-181-003 Tray 1: 3 0: B4 or 1: LG
5-181-007 Tray 2: 3 0: B4 or 1: LG
SM 2-23 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Main Machine Installation
This step is for Basic models only. Enable these functions if you install the
Printer/Scanner option and/or @remote option; keep these functions disabled if
neither of these options are installed.
To enable the NIB function if you install a printer/scanner option, with or without
@Remote, enter the SP mode and set SP5-985-001 (On Board NIC) to "1"(Enable).
However, if @Remote is to be used for a basic model without printer/scanner option, this
SP must be set to "2".
To enable the USB function, enter the SP mode and set SP5-985-002 (On Board USB) to
"1"(Enable).
You must turn the machine off/on after changing these settings, because these settings
only take effect after the machine is restarted.
4. Exit SP mode.
5. Do some test copies to make sure that the machine operates correctly.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-24 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
1. Do SP4-806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents
dust from falling into the machine during transportation.
2. Remove the toner cartridges. This prevents toner leak, which is caused by vibration
during transport.
3. Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates
with a sheet of paper and tape.
4. Take out the scanner stay from inside the front cover and install the scanner stay.
5. Do one of the following steps:
Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors.
Shrink-wrap the machine tightly.
SM 2-25 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
3 Securing Bracket 2
The machine should be held at the correct locations and lifted gently.
If it is lifted without care, handled carelessly or dropped, it may result in an injury.
When installing this option, turn the machine power OFF, and unplug the power supply
cord from the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it may result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Be sure to join the machine to the paper feed unit so as to prevent equipment from falling
over.
If they are not connected, they may move and fall over, resulting in injury.
1. Remove the orange tape and retainers.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-26 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
2. Remove the items provided (fixing screws, etc.) from the package.
Installation
3. Holding the grips on the machine, align it with the locating pin [A], and place the
machine on the paper feed unit.
SM 2-27 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
6. Attach the securing brackets [A] to two positions on the left and right at the rear of the
machine (screws: 1 each).
If the anti-condensation heater for this optional tray is to be installed, connect its
heater harness prior to this step (step 6) (page 2-188).
If LCIT RT3030 is to be installed, connect its harness prior to this step (step 6)
(page 2-44).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-28 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
Installation
[A]: Tray number decal [B]: Paper size decal
The tray number decal and paper size decal are packaged together with the
machine.
10. Lock the casters of the paper feed unit.
Stabilizers are attached to the machine when it is shipped. Do not remove it.
SM 2-29 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
13. Set the paper, and check that the paper size set in the paper feed tray is displayed on
the operation panel.
Paper size for the paper feed unit can be changed with following SPs.
SP5-181-009 (0: A4 LEF or 1: LT LEF) for Tray 3
SP5-181-010 (0: A3 or 1: DLT) for Tray 3
SP5-181-011 (0: B4 or 1: LG) for Tray 3
SP5-181-012 (0: B5 LEF or 1: Exe LEF) for Tray 3
SP5-181-014 (0: A4 LEF or 1: LT LEF) for Tray 4
SP5-181-015 (0: A3 or 1: DLT) for Tray 4
SP5-181-016 (0: B4 or 1: LG) for Tray 4
SP5-181-017 (0: B5 LEF or 1: Exe LEF) for Tray 4
14. Adjust the registration for the paper feed unit.
For Tray 3
SP1-001-0xx (Leading Edge Registration Tray 3)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-30 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
Installation
-070 Tray4: Plain -077 Tray4: Plain:1200
Tray4:
-071 Tray4: Mid-thick -078
Mid-thick:1200
SM 2-31 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3150
1 Screws - M4 10 2
3 Securing Bracket 2
The machine should be held at the correct locations and lifted gently by two people.
If it is lifted without care, handled carelessly or dropped, it may result in injury.
When installing this option, turn the machine power OFF, and unplug the power supply
cord from the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it may result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Be sure to join the machine to the paper feed unit so as to prevent equipment from falling
over.
If they are not connected, they may move and fall over, resulting in injury.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-32 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB3150
Installation
2. Remove the items provided (fixing screws, etc.) from the package.
SM 2-33 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3150
7. Attach the securing brackets [A] to two positions on the left and right at the rear of the
machine (screws: 1 each).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-34 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB3150
Installation
[A]: Tray number decal
[B]: Paper size decal
The tray number decal and paper size decal are packaged together with the
machine.
11. Lock the casters of the paper feed unit.
Stabilizers are attached to the paper feed unit when it is shipped. Do not remove
them.
SM 2-35 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed Unit PB3150
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-36 SM
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
Installation
2.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Securing Bracket 2
2 Screw(M410) 2
3 Hexagonal Bolt 1
The machine should be held at the correct locations and lifted gently.
If it is lifted without care, handled carelessly or dropped, it may result in an injury.
When installing this option, turn the machine power OFF, and unplug the power supply
cord from the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it may result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Be sure to join the machine to the paper feed unit so as to prevent equipment from falling
over.
If they are not connected, they may move and fall over, resulting in injury.
SM 2-37 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
2. Remove the items provided (fixing screws, etc.) from the package.
3. Holding the grips on the machine, align it with the locating pin [A], and place the
machine on the paper feed unit.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-38 SM
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
When you lift the machine, be sure to hold the grips on the machine.
Installation
In particular, do not lift the machine by holding the scanner unit, etc., because this
may cause the machine to deform.
Do not put the machine down on the paper feed unit as a temporary resting place.
This may cause the paper feed unit to deform. Always connect the machine and
paper feed unit properly.
4. Pull out the 2nd paper feed tray of the machine.
5. Using a securing bracket as a screwdriver, secure the machine to the LCT unit (spring
washer: screw: M410: 1).
6. Attach the securing brackets [A] to two positions on the left and right at the rear of the
machine (screws: 1 each).
If the anti-condensation heater for this optional tray is to be installed, connect its
heater harness prior to this step (step 6) (page 2-192).
If LCIT RT3030 is to be installed, connect its harness prior to this step (step 6)
(page 2-44).
SM 2-39 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
The tray number decal and paper size decal are packaged together with the
machine.
10. Lock the casters of the paper feed unit.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-40 SM
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
Stabilizers are attached to the LCIT when it is shipped. Do not remove any of them.
Installation
12. Turn the power switch ON.
13. Set the paper, and check that the paper size set in the paper feed tray is displayed on
the operation panel.
14. Adjust the registration for the paper feed unit.
SP1-001-0xx (Leading Edge Registration Tray 3)
SM 2-41 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
Make sure that the spring [B] of end fence [A] is attached
4. Remove the left tray side fence (front) [A] and left tray side fence (rear) [B] ( 2).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-42 SM
LCIT PB3170/ PB3230
Installation
SP5-181-009 (0: A4 LEF or 1: LT LEF)
SM 2-43 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT RT3030
1 Rear Bracket 1
2 Front Bracket 1
3 Connecter Cover 1
4 Harness 1
5 Screws M3 6 1
5 Tapping Screw M3 6 1
5 Joint Pins 2
5 Stud screw 4
5 Joint Bracket 1
When installing this option, turn the power of the machine off, and unplug the power plug
from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-44 SM
LCIT RT3030
Before installing this option, first attach the Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220 or LCIT
Installation
PB3170/ PB3230.
1. Remove the orange tape and retainers.
2. Remove the enclosed items (stud screws, etc.).
3. Remove the eight covers on the right of the paper feed unit.
4. Attach the joint pins [A] to the front and rear on the right of the paper feed unit.
5. Attach the brackets [A], [B] at the positions of the joint pins ( 4).
SM 2-45 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT RT3030
7. Take off the securing brackets [A] from the two positions on the left and right at the
rear of the machine ( : 1 each).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-46 SM
LCIT RT3030
Installation
For the machine with Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220
SM 2-47 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT RT3030
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-48 SM
LCIT RT3030
14. Connect the cable [A] of the side LCT to the machine ( 1).
Installation
15. Attach the cable cover [A] ( 1).
SM 2-49 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
LCIT RT3030
Tray5(LCT):
-085 Tray5(LCT): Mid-thick -092
Mid-thick:1200
3. Also change the rear side fence to the same size position.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-50 SM
LCIT RT3030
Installation
4. Change the paper size according to the new side fence position.
SP5-181-024 (Size Adjust LCT)
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF
SM 2-51 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Caster Table Type M3
4 Securing Bracket 2
5 Locating pin 3
* Used only when the main machine is installed on this option directly.
The machine must be held at the correct locations, and must be lifted slowly.
If it is lifted with force, handled carelessly or dropped, it will result in an injury.
If installing this option, turn the power to the machine off, and unplug the power plug from
the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or
malfunction.
Be sure to join the machine and caster table to prevent equipment from falling over.
If it is not joined, the machine will move or fall over, which will result in an injury.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-52 SM
Caster Table Type M3
Installation
2. Holding the grips on the machine, align with the locating pin, and place the machine on
the caster table.
6. Attach the securing brackets [A] at 2 positions to left and right at the rear of the
machine or paper feed unit (screws: 1 each).
SM 2-53 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Caster Table Type M3
7. Attach the right lower cover provided with this option to the right lower side of the
main machine.
8. Return the paper feed tray to the machine or paper feed unit on the caster table.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-54 SM
Caster Table Type M3
Installation
Be sure to use the specified grips on the main machine. Using any other positions
may damage the machine.
Do not put the machine down on the PB3150 as a temporary resting place. This may
cause the PB3150 to deform.
8. Pull out the 2nd paper feed tray of the main machine.
9. Secure the main machine and PB3150 (M410: 1).
10. Attach the securing bracket [A] to the rear of the main machine ( 2).
12. Return the 2nd paper feed tray to the main machine.
SM 2-55 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Platen Cover PN2000 (D700)
1 Feeler Guide 1
2 Stepped Screw 2
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
1. Install the stepped screws ( 2).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-56 SM
Platen Cover PN2000 (D700)
Installation
3. Install the platen cover [A].
SM 2-57 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Platen Cover PN2000 (D700)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-58 SM
ARDF DF3090
Installation
2.9.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 ARDF 1
2 Screw 2
3 Knob Screw 2
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
1. Remove all tapes and shipping retainers.
2. Insert the two stud screws ([A] is the larger stud, [B] is the smaller stud).
SM 2-59 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
ARDF DF3090
3. Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over
the stud screws.
4. Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.
5. Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C].
6. Align the rear left corner of the platen sheet [A] with the corner [B] on the exposure
glass.
7. Close the ARDF.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-60 SM
ARDF DF3090
Installation
8. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.
9. Lift the ARDF original tray.
10. Slide the stamp holder [A] out and install the stamp cartridge in it, if necessary.
After the stamp installation, be sure to slide the holder in correctly. If not, jam
detection (J001) will occur.
SM 2-61 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
ARDF DF3090
11. Attach the decals [A] [B] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language that you
want.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-62 SM
ARDF DF3090
Installation
15. Fasten the grounding wire [A] ( 1).
SM 2-63 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
ARDF DF3090
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-64 SM
SPDF DF3080
Installation
2.10.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
Coin Screw 2
3
Stepped Screw 2
8 Clamp: LWS-0711A 2
11 IPU-sub Board 1
12 Spacer 1
SM 2-65 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SPDF DF3080
When you install this option, turn off the power supply to the machine, and unplug the
power plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is ON, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Do not turn the power on until you perform adjustment after installation. Otherwise, it
may not start normally.
The larger-stepped screw [A] is for the right side and the smaller-stepped screw [B] is
for the left side of the main machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-66 SM
SPDF DF3080
Installation
4. Align the hinges of the SPDF [A] with the hole [B] for stepped screws, and attach them
by sliding them in.
5. Fix the SPDF to the machine (coin screws [C] 2).
SM 2-67 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SPDF DF3080
7. Lower the SPDF slowly to attach the platen sheet to the SPDF.
8. Open the DF again and make sure that the platen sheet is firmly attached to the
exposure glass.
9. Paste the decal (CAUTION:ORIGINAL) to the point [A].
10. Paste the decal (SET:ORIGINAL TABLE) to the point [B] as shown in the following
picture.
This decal must be pasted without projecting over the gap in the original table.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-68 SM
SPDF DF3080
Installation
3. Remove the controller rear cover [A] ( 5).
5. Disconnect the scanner cable [A] and SIO harness [B] from the IPU board.
SM 2-69 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SPDF DF3080
7. Connect CN593 [A] on the IPU-sub board [C] with CN529 [B] on the IPU board to attach
the IPU-sub board ( x3).
8. Attach the DF cable bracket [A] on the scanner rear frame ( x1).
9. Attach the ground wire [B] ( x1).
10. Attach the DF harness [C] to CN312 on the SIO.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-70 SM
SPDF DF3080
Installation
11. Attach the CIS cable [A] to the bracket ( x1).
12. Clamp the CIS cable [A] under the bracket and the upper side of the controller box [B].
13. Attach the CIS cable clamp [A] to the bracket in the controller box ( x1).
14. Attach the scanner cable [B] to CN590 on the IPU-sub board ( x1), CIS cable [C] to
CN592 on the IPU-sub board ( x1), and the SIO harness [D] to CN531 on the IPU board
( x1).
SM 2-71 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SPDF DF3080
15. Attach the ferrite cores to the DF cable and the CIS cable.
Ferrite core: K3 NF-70-A (N) BK0 is for the DF cable
Ferrite core: K3 NF-75 (N) BK0 is for the CIS cable.
16. Remove the scanner cable gap cover from the scanner rear cover.
DF cable gap [A], CIS cable gap [B]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-72 SM
SPDF DF3080
Installation
Adjust SP Settings
1. Turn the power ON.
2. Enter the SP values marked on the paper provided, in the following SP.
1. SP4-712-001: CIS GB Adj. Value: R
2. SP4-713-001: CIS GB Adj. Value: G
3. SP4-714-001: CIS GB Adj. Value: B
3. Adjust the registration for the SPDF.
SP6-006-010: ADF Adjustment L-Edge Regist (1-Pass): Front
SP6-006-011: ADF Adjustment L-Edge Regist (1-Pass): Rear
SP6-006-001: ADF Adjustment Side-to-Side Regist: Front
SP6-006-002: ADF Adjustment Side-to-Side Regist: Rear
4. If there is skew, loosen the fixing screw [A] and swivel the SPDF slightly to the left or
right. Then tighten coin screw [A] and make a test copy to check that there is no skew.
SM 2-73 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bridge Unit BU3070
1 Tapping screw- M3 8 1
2 Screw - M4 1
3 Knob Screw - M4 1
When installing this option, turn the power of the machine off, and unplug the power plug
from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-74 SM
Bridge Unit BU3070
The bridge unit cannot be used together with Internal Shift Tray SH3070, Side Tray
Installation
Type M3, Internal Finisher SR3180 or Internal Finisher SR3130.
To use together with the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, attach the 1 Bin Tray BN3110 first before
installing the bridge unit.
1. Remove the orange tape and shipping retainers.
2. Remove the enclosed items (fixing screws, etc.).
SM 2-75 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bridge Unit BU3070
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
10. Attach the main power switch cover, and close the right cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-76 SM
Bridge Unit BU3070
11. Open the bridge unit right cover, and then attach the bridge unit to the machine ( 2,
knob screw [A]).
Installation
12. Close the bridge unit right cover.
13. Attach the upper left cover provided with the bridge unit.
14. Referring to the finisher's installation procedure, attach the L type connecting bracket
[A], but do not tighten the screws yet.
15. After the finisher is installed, turn the main power switch ON.
16. Check that the finisher can be selected at the operation panel.
SM 2-77 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
1 Bin Tray BN3110
2 Harness cover 1
3 Tray 1
4 Screw: M3 x 8 2
5 Gear 1
When installing this option, turn the machine power off, and unplug the power plug from
the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
If you install this option together with Bridge Unit BU3070, Internal Shift Tray SH3070
or Side Tray Type M3, install this option first.
1. Remove the orange tapes and shipping retainers.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-78 SM
1 Bin Tray BN3110
Installation
2. Remove the enclosed items (fixing screws, etc.).
3. Open the right cover.
4. Remove the main power switch cover [A] ( 1).
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
SM 2-79 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
1 Bin Tray BN3110
10. Remove the inverter tray [A] and tray support rod cover [B] ( 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-80 SM
1 Bin Tray BN3110
Installation
11. Remove the paper output cover [A] ( 1).
Take care that the harness is not trapped between the 1 bin tray unit and the
machine frame.
SM 2-81 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
1 Bin Tray BN3110
14. Open the harness cover [A], then remove the harness [B].
Slowly and carefully lift up the harness cover to remove. Removing the harness
cover while moving it round can break the harness because the inner hook catches
the harness.
15. Attach the harness removed in the previous step.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-82 SM
1 Bin Tray BN3110
Pass the harness attached in the previous step through the position in the blue circle.
Installation
17. Hook the 1 bin tray [A] onto the 1 bin tray unit, aligning the positions in the blue
circles.
18. Connect the harness to the 1 bin tray, and bring it around ( 1).
SM 2-83 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
1 Bin Tray BN3110
19. Insert the tray support bar firmly in the 1 bin tray, and attach the harness cover [A].
20. Attach the left rear cover, left upper cover and main power switch cover, and then close
the right cover.
21. Turn the main power switch ON.
22. Check that output to this tray can be selected on the operation panel, and check
operation.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-84 SM
Internal Shift Tray SH3070
Installation
2.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Tray Cover 1
2 Sheet 2
3 Feeler 1
When installing this option, turn the power to the machine off, and unplug the power plug
from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Cannot be used together with Bridge Unit BU3070, Side Tray Type M3, Internal
Finisher SR3130, or Internal Finisher SR3180.
For using this option together with 1 Bin Tray BN3110, attach the bottom plate of this
option at the beginning, then install the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, followed by installing this
option.
SM 2-85 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Shift Tray SH3070
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-86 SM
Internal Shift Tray SH3070
Installation
7. Open the right cover.
8. Remove the main power switch cover [A] ( 1).
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
SM 2-87 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Shift Tray SH3070
12. Attach the sheets [A] at the edge of the paper exit cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-88 SM
Internal Shift Tray SH3070
13. Attach the paper exit cover and main power switch cover, and then close the right
Installation
cover.
14. Turn the main power switch ON.
15. Check that paper output to the shift tray can be selected at the operation panel, and
check the operation.
SM 2-89 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Side Tray Type M3
3 Fixing Plate 1
4 Knob Screw 1
5 Tapping screw - M4 x 14 1
6 Tapping screw - M3 x 8 1
7 Bracket 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-90 SM
Side Tray Type M3
Installation
When installing this option, turn the power to the machine off, and unplug the power plug
from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
The side tray cannot be used together with Bridge Unit BU3070, Internal Shift Tray
SH3070, Internal Finisher SR3180 or Internal Finisher SR3130.
To use together with the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, attach the 1 Bin Tray BN3110 first before
installing the side tray.
1. Remove the orange tape and shipping retainers.
2. Remove the enclosed items (fixing screws, etc.).
3. Remove the paper exit tray [A].
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
SM 2-91 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Side Tray Type M3
8. Attach the main power switch cover, and then close the right cover.
9. Attach the side tray unit [A] to the machine, and fix with a knob screw ( 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-92 SM
Side Tray Type M3
Installation
11. Attach the upper extension tray [A] and the left extension tray [B].
SM 2-93 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
1 Guide Plate 1
2 Shift Tray 1
3 Ground Plate 1
Screws: M4x12 4
4
Rivets 2
5 Cushion 1
7 Joint Bracket 1
D688: 2
8 Tapping Screw: M3x8
D689: 1
10 Tray Holder 1
- EMC Address 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-94 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
Installation
2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
When you install this option, turn off the power to the machine, and unplug the power
plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Before installing this option, attach the Bridge Unit BU3070 first.
Attach the LCIT PB3170/ PB3230 or Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220 first before
installing this option.
SM 2-95 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
2. Open the front cover [A], and remove the orange tapes, shipping retainers and fixing
bracket [B] ( x2)
Additional Step only for D688: Pull out the saddle stitch unit [A] to remove the
orange tapes, shipping retainer and fixing bracket [B] attached on the bottom frame
( x1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-96 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
Installation
3. For D688 only, install the hopper cover.
If optional punch unit PU3050 is to be installed, attach the hopper packed with the
punch unit. See the Installation Procedure for PU3050 (page 2-121).
4. Remove the items in the package (fixing screws, etc.).
5. Clean the right side of the upper cover with an alcohol cloth, and then attach the
cushion to the finisher.
Make sure that the cushion is aligned with the rear-lower edge [A] of the upper cover.
SM 2-97 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
As the default setting, the screw head is placed at the center of the scale of the rear
side.
The joint bracket [A] must be placed under the bridge unit bracket [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-98 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
Installation
When adjusting registration, change the screw hole of the adjusting bracket [A] from
the upper position [B] to the rear (left) position [C] so that the adjusting bracket can
be adjusted horizontally.
SM 2-99 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-100 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
Installation
After installing a finisher, make sure that the Side-to-Side registration of the finisher matches that
of the main machine.
SM 2-101 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3170 / Finisher SR3160
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-102 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
2.16.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Hopper 1
2 Punch Unit 1
8 Clip Ring 1
10 Hopper Bracket 1
SM 2-103 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3060
When installing this option, turn the power source of the machine off, and unplug the
power plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-104 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
5. Attach the punch unit stay [A] ( 4).
Rear-----------------------------------------------Front
SM 2-105 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3060
First insert the front tab of the paper chip guide into the frame [B] of the finisher, and
then insert the rear tab into the frame [C].
7. Attach the hopper bracket [A], inserting from the outside frame of the finisher ( 2, 2
hooks).
Hook the hooks of the hopper bracket onto the back side of the frame.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-106 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
Hook the upper frame of the hopper bracket onto the outside frame of the finisher.
SM 2-107 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3060
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-108 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
Insert the front pins of the registration mobile unit into the holes of the frame.
After inserting the pins [B] of the punch unit stay [A] into the front and rear holes of
the punch unit, fix the punch unit with two screws.
SM 2-109 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3060
Rear
Front
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-110 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
Engage the gear [B] of the punch stepping motor unit with the rack [C] of the punch
unit.
13. Connect the harness of the hopper sensor to the connector of the finisher.
14. Connect the harness of the punch unit to the connector of the registration drive unit.
SM 2-111 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3060
15. Connect the harness of the punch unit to the connector of the main board, and then fix
it ( 2, 2).
16. Connect the harness [B] of the punch stepping motor unit and the harness [C] of the
registration mobile unit to the connector of the punch unit board [A].
17. Clamp all the harnesses of the punch unit PU3060 ( 8).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-112 SM
Punch Unit PU3060
Installation
19. Attach the rear upper cover, the rear lower cover, the inner cover, and the punch guide
plate.
SM 2-113 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
5 Shift Tray 1
6 Connecting Bracket 1
- EMC Address 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-114 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
Installation
Only for SR3140, two stabilizers are included as accessories.
They must be attached to the finisher just after it is taken out of the shipping box.
When you install this option, turn off the power to the machine, and unplug the power
plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Before installing this option, attach the Bridge Unit BU3050 first.
Attach the LCIT PB3170/ PB3230 or Paper Feed Unit PB3210/ PB3220 first before
installing this option.
1. For SR3140 only, install the stabilizer [A] ( 1).
SM 2-115 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
3. Open the front cover [A], and remove the filament tape and packing materials.
4. For SR3150 only, remove the bracket [B] ( 1).
5. Pull out the booklet stitching unit [A] or stapling unit, and remove the filament tape and
packing materials.
6. Wipe the surface of the top cover with alcohol, and then attach the cushion [A]
(supplied with the finisher adapter) to the top cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-116 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
Installation
8. For SR3150 only, attach the booklet tray [A].
9. Attach the relay guide plate [A] supplied with the finisher adapter to the finisher ( x2
(M3 x 6)).
There are two screw holes at each edge of the frame. Use the screw holes which are
the front side on each edge when attaching the relay guide plate [A].
SM 2-117 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
SR3150
SR3140
11. Attach the connecting bracket [A] that comes with the finisher adapter to the finisher
( x4).
Secure the connecting bracket [A] together with the bridge unit bracket [B]. Also note
that the connecting bracket [A] must be placed under the bridge unit bracket [B].
Make sure that the screw head is placed at the center of the scale as shown by the
blue arrow below.
When adjusting registration, reattach the adjusting bracket [A], so that the inscribed
line turns upside down. The screw is to be secured with the elongated screw slot.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-118 SM
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
Installation
12. Connect the finisher to the machine with the lock lever [A] ( x1).
SM 2-119 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Booklet Finisher SR3150 / Finisher SR3140
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-120 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Installation
2.18.1 COMPONENT CHECK
1 Punch unit 1
6 Hopper 1
SM 2-121 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
When installing this option, turn the power source of the machine off, and unplug the
power plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-122 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Remove the knobs with the lock mechanism using a knob screwdriver or similar tool
Installation
while releasing the lock.
SM 2-123 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
9. Open the upper cover [A] and remove the arm of the guide plate [B] from the finisher
upper cover ( x1).
The removed guide plate is not used. Please check with the customer when you
discard it.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-124 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
11. Insert the hopper guide plate [A] from the front.
Installation
12. Secure the hopper guide plate [A] ( x4, x1).
13. Insert the punch unit stay [A] from the front.
Set the shaft [B] of the punch unit stay in the U-shaped gutter [A].
SM 2-125 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
15. Insert the registration guide plate [A] from the rear.
17. Insert the registration sensor unit [A] from the rear.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-126 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Installation
Insert the shafts [C] of the registration sensor unit [B] into the bearings [A].
19. Connect the hopper guide plate harness [A] to the registration sensor unit relay
connector [B] ( x1).
SM 2-127 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
The bracket [A] must be in the right position as shown when inserting.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-128 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Installation
22. Insert the punch drive motor from the rear of the finisher.
Put the shaft of the stay [A] through the hole of the motor bracket [B].
Make sure that the rack of the punch unit [A] and the pinion of the bracket [B] are
correctly engaged with each other.
SM 2-129 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
24. Connect the harness [B], provided as an accessory, to the main board of the punch
unit [A] ( x3).
25. Connect the harness [B] provided as an accessory, to the main board [A] of the finisher
( x3).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-130 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Installation
26. Connect the harness [B], provided as an accessory, to the harness of the registration
sensor unit [A] ( x1).
27. Remove the harness [A] from the clamp [B], and connect it to the main board of the
punch unit [C] ( x1).
SM 2-131 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3050
28. Connect the harness of the punch drive motor [A] to the main board [B] of the punch
unit.
31. Cut off the part [A] of the finisher inner cover, then attach the inner cover [B] ( x1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-132 SM
Punch Unit PU3050
Installation
32. Attach the inner cover ( x3).
33. Attach three knobs( x1).
34. Attach the finisher rear cover ( x2).
35. Close the front cover.
36. Close the top cover.
37. Attach the finisher to the machine, and connect the interface cable.
38. Connect the power cord of the machine, and turn the main power on.
39. Check that the punch can be selected at the operation panel, and check the operation.
SM 2-133 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
1 Bottom Plate 1
7 Screw: M3X6 3
10 Slide Rail 1
11 Nylon Clamp 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-134 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
Installation
When you install this option, turn off the power to the machine, and unplug the power
plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
Cannot be used together with Bridge Unit BU3070, Internal Shift Tray SH3070, Side
Tray Type M3 or Internal Finisher SR3130.
For using this option together with 1 Bin Tray BN3110, attach the bottom plate of this
option at the beginning, then install the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, followed by installing this
option.
1. Remove the orange tape and shipping retainers.
3. Remove the shaft [B] from the slide rail [A] ( x 1).
SM 2-135 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
5. Place the slide rail [A] under the internal finisher [B].
6. Insert the shaft [A] into the holes located in the slide rail and internal finisher, and then
fasten with the screw ( x 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-136 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
Installation
8. Remove the Paper exit tray [A].
SM 2-137 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-138 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
Installation
16. Remove the connector cover [A].
The lower inside cover can be removed together with the paper exit lower cover,
since the inside cover is secured on the paper exit lower cover with two screws.
18. Remove the lower inside cover [B] from the paper exit lower cover [A] ( x 2).
SM 2-139 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
19. While pressing the bottom plate [A] into the area [B] shown by the red-dashed line,
insert the tabs of the bottom plate into the slots [C] [D] shown by the blue circles.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-140 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
Install the lower inside cover (removed in step 18) [A] in the finisher ( x 2, Accessory
No.5).
Installation
21. Attach the paper exit cover [A] and the connector cover [B] (removed in step 15 and
step 16).
22. Attach the main power switch cover [A], and then close right cover.
23. Attach the finisher [B].
SM 2-141 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
25. Attach the left upper cover [A] and the left rear cover [B] (removed in step 10 and step
11).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-142 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
Installation
28. Reattach the Inverter tray [A] removed in step 12.
SM 2-143 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3180
31. Attach the nylon clamp [A] as shown below (tapping screw 4x8: x1).
To adjust the strength of crimp between sheets of paper stapled, there is a setting which
makes single/ double staple changeable into each other.
The power of crimp is weakened when there is an image (toner) on the point where is to
be stapled. There also is a setting to mask the image on the point for staple, in order to
avoid the strength of crimp to be weakened.
Depending on users demands, explain the settings/ methods of the settings by checking
the following instruction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-144 SM
Internal Finisher SR3180
<How to change the setting of Staple Method (Single/ Double) for Stapleless Stapler>
1. [User Mode/ counter]
Installation
2. [System Setting]
3. [General Setting] and [next]
4. [Stapling Method for Stapleless Stapler]
SM 2-145 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3130
1 Staple Cartridge 1
3 Caster Stand 2
4 Bottom Plate 1
- Screw: M3 6 6
- Tapping Screw: M4 x 6 1
When you install this option, turn off the power to the machine, and unplug the power
plug from the wall socket.
If this option is installed with the power on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-146 SM
Internal Finisher SR3130
Cannot be used together with Internal Shift Tray SH3070, Side Tray Type M3, Bridge
Unit BU3070, Finisher SR3140, Booklet Finisher SR3150, Finisher SR3160, or
Installation
Booklet Finisher SR3170.
To use together with the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, after attaching the bottom plate of this
option, attach the 1 Bin Tray BN3110, and then install this option.
To use together with the Punch Unit PU3040, first attach the Punch Unit PU3040
before installing this option.
1. Remove the orange tape and shipping retainers.
SM 2-147 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3130
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-148 SM
Internal Finisher SR3130
Installation
11. Remove the connector cover [A].
After removing the screws, slide the paper exit lower cover toward the left side, then
pull the cover up.
SM 2-149 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3130
13. While pressing the bottom plate [A] into the area [B] shown by the red-dashed line,
insert the tabs of the bottom plate into the slots [C][D] shown by the blue circles.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-150 SM
Internal Finisher SR3130
Installation
14. Secure the bottom plate [A] ( 3).
15. Attach the paper exit cover [A] and the connector cover [B].
Up to this point, the procedure is the same as punch unit installation. If the Punch
Unit PU3040 is to be installed, refer to the Step 3 and later of the installation
procedure (page 2-155).
16. Attach the main power switch cover and close the right cover ( 1).
17. Slide the finisher front right cover [A] from left to right, and then attach it ( 1).
SM 2-151 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3130
The entrance guide plate has one or more tabs underneath. Fit the tabs when
fastening the entrance guide plate.
20. Keep the paper exit feeler [A] in the cover.
If this step is not done, the feeler may be damaged when closing the finisher from left to
right.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-152 SM
Internal Finisher SR3130
21. Slide the finisher [A] along the rail of the bottom plate from the left side of the machine,
and then attach it ( 1).
Installation
Hold the front side [A] of the inner finisher as shown below to check if the inner
finisher is correctly set in the rail of the bottom plate.
SM 2-153 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Internal Finisher SR3130
This step is required only for machines that have Paper Feed Tray PB3210/
PB3220 or LCIT PB3170/ PB3230.
26. Open the stapler unit [A], and then set the staple cartridge [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-154 SM
Punch Unit PU3040
Installation
2.21.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Hopper 1
5 Holder 1
- Knob Screw - M4 1
SM 2-155 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3040
When installing this option, turn the power to the machine off, and unplug the power plug
from the wall socket.
If this option is installed when the power is on, it will result in an electric shock or a
malfunction.
When installing this option together with the Internal Finisher SR3130, attach this option
first before installing the Internal Finisher SR3130
1. Take out from the box, and remove the filament tape and packing material.
2. Perform steps 1 to 15 of the installation procedure for the "Internal finisher SR3130".
3. Change the position of the bracket [A] on the bottom plate ( 1).
4. Replace the lock holder of the bottom plate with the lock holder [A] provided ( 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-156 SM
Punch Unit PU3040
Installation
6. Attach the main power switch cover.
7. Pass the shafts [B] of the punch unit [A] through the bearings [C] of the bottom plate,
and attach the punch unit to the machine ( 1, knob screw).
SM 2-157 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3040
8. Attach the front right cover [A] provided, inserting the claws ( 2).
10. Slide the finisher [A] along the rail of the bottom plate from the left of the machine, and
then attach it ( 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-158 SM
Punch Unit PU3040
Before fastening the screw, make sure that the finisher is correctly set in the rail of
Installation
the bottom plate.
When installing the punch unit in the finisher which is already installed, remove the
entrance guide plate [A] ( 2).
Note that this step is unnecessary when installing the finisher and punch unit at the
same time.
11. Attach the lower rear cover [A] and lower front cover [B] to the finisher ( 2).
SM 2-159 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Punch Unit PU3040
13. Insert the upper left cover [A] from the front, and then attach it ( x1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-160 SM
Smart Operation Panel Type M3
Installation
2.22.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Brand Logo 1
When changing the screen in the field (standard panel smart operation panel),
perform the following steps.
Smart Operation Panel Type M3 is not the option for EU region. (Standard model)
1. Change the SP modes below before changing the operation panel.
Change the setting of bit 0 in SP5-748-101 to 1.
Change the setting of SP5-748-201 to 1.
2. Turn the main power OFF.
3. Open the ARDF or platen cover.
4. Scanner front cover [A] ( 2)
There are two tabs [A] inside this cover: the left side and the right upper side.
Release these tabs after removing the two screws of the scanner front cover. First,
carefully and slightly pull the left side of the cover towards the outside and release
the left side tab, then pull up the right upper side tab and release it.
SM 2-161 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Operation Panel Type M3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-162 SM
Smart Operation Panel Type M3
7. Attach the brand logo to the place [A] on the smart operation panel if necessary.
Installation
8. Attach the Smart Operation Panel Type M3 [A] ( 5, 3, 2).
SM 2-163 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Operation Panel Type M3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-164 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord when installing this option.
Description Qty
Clamp: LWSM-0306A 7
Clamp: LWSM-0511A 8
Clamp: LWS-1211A 1
Heater Board 1
BCU Harness 1
PSU Harness 1
Thermostat unit 1
SM 2-165 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-166 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
4. Remove the controller cover [A] ( 4).
SM 2-167 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-168 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
10. Remove the rear lower cover [A] ( 5).
SM 2-169 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
14. Connect the harness [A] to CN904 of the PSU and CN920 of the heater board.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-170 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
16. Connect the harness [A] to CN121 of the BCU and CN930 of the heater board.
Installation
17. Clamp the harness [A] which is connected in step 16 ( 7).
18. Connect the heater cable [A] to CN922 of the heater board [B].
SM 2-171 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
19. Route the heater cable to the rear of the main unit ( 6).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-172 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
24. Remove the left scale and exposure glass [A].
The exposure glass and the left scale are attached with double-sided tape.
SM 2-173 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
28. Route the harness on the hook which is indicated with the blue circle in the picture
below.
29. Pass the harness out through the hole of the frame.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-174 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
31. Attach the heater cover [A] ( x1).
32. Remove the DF harness with the bracket [A] if the DF is installed ( x1).
33. Remove the SIO board [A] if the DF is installed ( x4, x6, flat cable x1).
SM 2-175 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
34. Connect the heater cable [B] which is shown in step 29 to another harness [A] which is
shown in step 19.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-176 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
Installation
6. Take off the heater bracket [A].
7. Attach the anti-condensation heater (PCU) [A] to the heater bracket [B].
Fit the anti-condensation heater (PCU) [A] into the tab [C] on the heater bracket [B].
8. Attach the thermostat [A] to the Anti-condensation heater (PCU) [B] ( x1).
Fit the thermostat [A] into the tab [C] on the heater bracket [B].
SM 2-177 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
9. Put back the anti-condensation heater (PCU) [A], and then pass the heater harnesses
out through the opening [B] at the inner rear side of the main unit.
10. For D200/D201/D202 only, remove the development bearing cooling fan [A] ( x2,
x1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-178 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater Type M12
11. Connect the harnesses of the thermostat [A] and of the anti-condensation heater (PCU)
[B] to the harnesses [C] which is routed in step 19 of the procedure for the
Installation
Anti-Condensation Heater (Scanner).
You can connect the harnesses [C] up to either the harness [A] or [B].
12. Reattach the development bearing cooling fan, PCDU, waste toner bottle and covers
which have been removed.
SM 2-179 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power supply cord when installing this
option.
Description Qty
Clamp: LWSM-0306A 7
Clamp: LWS-1211A 1
Heater Board 1
BCU Harness 1
PSU Harness 1
PFU Harness 1
Description Qty
PFU Harness 1
Heater Board 1
Clamp: LWSM-0306A 4
Screw: M4x10 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-180 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
Installation
Anti-Condensation Heater for Paper Feed Tray (Main Unit)
1. Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
2. Open the front cover.
3. Remove the paper exit tray [A].
SM 2-181 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-182 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
Installation
9. Remove the rear lower gap cover [A] (hook2).
SM 2-183 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
12. Connect the harness [A] to CN904 of the PSU and CN920 of the heater board.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-184 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
14. Connect the harness [A] to CN121 of the BCU and CN930 of the heater board.
Installation
15. Clamp the harness [A] which is connected in step 7 ( x7).
SM 2-185 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
16. Connect the heater harness [A] to CN921 of the heater board, and then attach the
plug-in of the heater harness to the rear frame of the main unit.
18. Pull out the first and second paper feed trays.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-186 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
19. Connect the harness of the tray heater [A] for the main unit to the plug-in at the inner
rear frame of the main unit.
Installation
20. Insert the tabs of the tray heater for the main unit in the cutouts in the inner rear frame
of the main unit, and then attach it ( x1).
21. Reattach all the paper feed trays, covers, etc. which have been taken off.
Do the following two steps to set the Anti-Condensation Heater to be constantly ON.
1. Set the setting of SP5-805-001 (Anti-Condensation Heater ON/OFF setting) to [1].
2. Manually disconnect the PCU and scanner heaters.
The PCU and scanner heaters must be disabled because the temperature in the machine
could become too high, causing problems with toner clogging, or damage to the scanner
lamp stabilizer.
SM 2-187 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
4. Remove the securing brackets [A] of the optional paper feed unit ( x2).
5. Remove the rear cover [A] of the optional paper feed unit ( x2).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-188 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
6. Remove the bracket [A] on the bottom of the main unit ( x1).
Installation
7. Connect the PFU harness [A] of the optional paper feed unit to the relay harness [B] of
the main unit and the heater harness [C] ( x4).
Put the PFU harness through the hole which is revealed when the bracket is
removed in step 7.
8. Reattach the rear cover of the optional paper feed unit, securing brackets, and rear
lower cover of the main unit.
9. Connect the power supply cord and turn ON the main power.
Do the following two steps to set the anti-condensation heater to be constantly ON.
1. Set the setting of SP5-805-001 (Anti-Condensation Heater ON/OFF setting) to [1].
2. Manually disconnect the PCU and scanner heaters.
SM 2-189 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
The PCU and scanner heaters must be disabled because the temperature in the machine
could become too high, causing problems with toner clogging, or damage to the scanner
lamp stabilizer.
4. Remove the securing brackets [A] of Paper Feed Unit PB3150 ( x2).
5. Remove the rear cover [A] of Paper Feed Unit PB3150 ( x4).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-190 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
6. Remove the bracket [A] on the bottom of the main unit ( x1)
Installation
7. Connect the PFU harness [A] of the optional paper feed unit to the relay harness [B] of
the main unit and the heater harness [C] ( x4).
Put the PFU harness through the hole which is revealed when the bracket is
removed in step 7.
8. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit PB3150, securing brackets, and rear
lower cover of the main unit.
9. Connect the power supply code and turn ON the main power.
Do the following two steps to set the anti-condensation heater to be constantly ON.
1. Set the setting of SP5-805-001 (Anti-Condensation Heater ON/OFF setting) to [1].
2. Manually disconnect the PCU and scanner heaters.
SM 2-191 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
The PCU and scanner heaters must be disabled because the temperature in the machine
could become too high, causing problems with toner clogging, or damage to the scanner
lamp stabilizer.
4. Remove the securing brackets [A] of the optional LCT unit ( x2).
5. Remove the rear cover [A] of the optional LCT unit ( x2).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-192 SM
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
6. Remove the bracket [A] on the bottom of the main unit ( x1).
Installation
7. Connect the PFU harness [A] of the optional LCT unit to the relay harness [B] of the
main unit and the heater harness [C] ( x3).
Put the PFU harness through the hole which is revealed when the bracket is
removed in step 6.
8. Reattach the rear cover of the optional LCT unit, securing brackets, and rear lower
cover of the main unit.
9. Connect the power supply cord and turn ON the main power.
Do the following two steps to set the anti-condensation heater to be constantly ON.
1. Set the setting of SP5-805-001 (Anti-Condensation Heater ON/OFF setting) to [1].
2. Manually disconnect the PCU and scanner heaters.
SM 2-193 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Anti-Condensation Heater for Trays
The PCU and scanner heaters must be disabled because the temperature in the machine
could become too high, causing problems with toner clogging, or damage to the scanner
lamp stabilizer.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-194 SM
Card Reader Bracket Type 3352
Installation
2.25.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
1 Screw: M3 x 8 2 Yes
3 Screw: M4 x 25 1 Yes
8 Clamp 5 Yes
SM 2-195 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Card Reader Bracket Type 3352
3. Make two screw holes in the removed scanner right cover with a screwdriver or drill.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-196 SM
Card Reader Bracket Type 3352
5. Attach the tray bracket [A] to the scanner right cover ( x2: M3x10 tapping screw).
For this model, use the screw holes marked "3" on the table bracket.
Installation
6. Attach the lower tray [A] to the tray bracket ( x2: M3 x 8).
7. Attach the upper tray [B] to the tray bracket ( x1: M3 x 10).
8. Attach the clamps ([1] to [5]) and route the harness around the machine as shown.
SM 2-197 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Card Reader Bracket Type 3352
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-198 SM
Key Counter Bracket Type M3
Installation
2.26.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
Description Qty
Screw: M3X8 1
Clamp:LWS-1211Z 2
Clamp:NK-3N 1
4. Attach the harness that comes from the key counter to the right side of the main
machine with the two clamps provided (CLAMP:LWS-1211Z).
SM 2-199 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Key Counter Bracket Type M3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-200 SM
Key Counter Bracket Type M3
Installation
9. Remove the rear lower cover [A] ( 5).
10. Remove the connector on CN133 [A] of the BCU, and then connect the key counter
harness to CN133.
11. Secure the harness to the inside of the main frame with a clamp.
SM 2-201 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Key Counter Bracket Type M3
12. Remove the cut off part [A] of the rear right cover.
13. Pass the harness from the key counter through the cut off part [A] of the right rear
cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-202 SM
Optional Counter Interface Unit Type M12
Installation
2.27.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
Description Qty
MKB Board 1
Harness Band 1
Stud 4
Harness 1
SM 2-203 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Optional Counter Interface Unit Type M12
3. Install the optional counter interface board [A] on the four stud stays.
4. Connect the supplied harness (13 pins) to CN3 [A] on the optional counter interface
board and CN132 [A] on the BCU.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-204 SM
Optional Counter Interface Unit Type M12
6. Remove the cable cover [A] and pass the harness from the optional counter device.
Installation
7. Reassemble the machine.
SM 2-205 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
1 IC Card Cover 1
2 Clamp:LWSM-0605A 4
3 Decal 1
4 Sponge:20X20 2
5 Upper Cover 1
- Operating Instructions 1
- Operation Manual 1
IC card reader and USB cable are not provided with this option.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-206 SM
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
Installation
1. Open the right cover.
2. Remove the main power switch cover ( 1).
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
SM 2-207 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-208 SM
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
Installation
9. Put an IC card reader [A] on the upper cover, and connect the USB cable.
10. Attach the IC card cover [A] provided, to cover the IC card reader (Tab 4).
SM 2-209 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-210 SM
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
13. Remove the screws on the main power switch cover [A] removed in step 2 ( 2).
Installation
14. Attach the upper cover [A] assembled in step 8 through step 12 to the main power
switch cover ( 2).
15. Attach the clamps provided along from the right side to the rear side of the main frame
( 3).
SM 2-211 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
16. Attach the main power switch cover with IC card reader [A].
17. Tighten the screw to secure the main power switch cover ( 1).
Lead the USB cable into the right side of the main frame as shown below.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-212 SM
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
Installation
18. Clamp the USB cable at the four positions ( 4).
If the USB cable is too long, loop and clamp the cable to adjust the length as shown
below.
SM 2-213 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Smart Card Reader Built-in Unit Type M12
20. Cut out the hole cover [A] and insert the harness.
23. Install the IC card cover provided with this option on the IC card reader ( 4).
24. Turn the main power switch ON, and make sure that the value of SP5-985-002 is set to
1.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-214 SM
Internal Options
Installation
2.29.1 LIST OF SLOTS
Slot Option
SM 2-215 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer/Scanner Unit Type M12
1 HDD Unit 1
2 Cable 1
3 Cable 1
- SD-Card 1
- Screw - M3x6 3
- PDF Decal 1
- CD-ROM 1
- EULA Sheet 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-216 SM
Printer/Scanner Unit Type M12
Installation
2.30.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Remove the controller rear cover (page 4-15).
2. Connect the cables [A] [B] to the HDD [C], and then attach the HDD to the bracket [D] of
the HDD ( x4).
3. Connect the cables of the HDD to the controller board [A], and then hang the HDD [B]
on the hook of the controller box ( x2).
SM 2-217 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer/Scanner Unit Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-218 SM
Printer/Scanner Unit Type M12
Installation
15. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 1 [A] or Slot 2 [B].
Be sure that you have set the On-board Device settings (SP5-985-001 and -002, as
explained above) before inserting the SD card..
16. Do SP5-853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the hard disk.
SM 2-219 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer/Scanner Unit Type M12
17. Attach the PDF decal [A] to the bottom right of the front door.
If there is another decal already attached, attach the PDF decal to the left of the decal.
When adding the Printer/Scanner Unit to a machine with the Fax Unit installed,
additional procedures are required.
1. Turn on the main power.
2. Do SP5-846-040 to copy the address book to the hard disk from the controller
board.
3. Turn off the main power after the power indicator is unlit.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-220 SM
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A
Installation
2.31.1 COMPONENT CHECK
- UL Sheet 1
- FCC Sheet 1
- ROHS Sheet 1
- Caution Sheet 1
SM 2-221 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A
2.31.2 INSTALLATION
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Remove the I/F slot cover [A] ( x2).
2. Install the IEEE 1284 Interface Board in the I/F slot [A] ( x2).
Use a screwdriver to tighten the knob-screws. Do not tighten manually, because this
can disconnect the board.
4. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-222 SM
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
Installation
2.32.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
2 Velcro Fasteners 2
3 Antenna Clamps 8
- FCC Sheet 1
- Setup Sheet 1
SM 2-223 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
2.32.2 INSTALLATION
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Remove the I/F slot cover [A] ( x2).
2. Install the IEEE 802.11 interface board in the I/F slot [A] ( x2).
Use a screwdriver to tighten the knob-screws. Do not tighten manually, because this
can disconnect the board.
3. Look at the markings on the antenna bracket.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-224 SM
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
Installation
ANT1. Antenna 1 [A] transmits and receives. It must be installed on the left rear corner of
the main machine. (The core on the Antenna 1 cable is black.)
ANT2. Antenna 2 [B] only receives. It is installed on the right rear corner of the machine.
(The core on the Antenna 2 cable is white.)
5. Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners, and then attach them to the
right rear [A] and left rear [A] of the machine.
6. Attach Antenna 1 [B] to the left rear of the machine. (The core on the Antenna 1 cable is
black.)
7. Attach Antenna 2 [A] to the right rear of the machine. (The core on the Antenna 2 cable
is white.)
8. Attach the clamps as shown below.
SM 2-225 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
9. Set the cables of Antenna 1 and Antenna 2 in the clamps and close them.
10. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
Select Interface Settings> Network > LAN Type. The LAN Type (default:
Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.
3. Select Interface Settings> Wireless LAN. Only the wireless LAN options show.
4. Set the Communication Mode.
5. Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)
6. Set the Ad-hoc Channel. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected.
Range: 1-13, 36, 40, 44 and 48 channels (default: 11)
7. Set the Security Method to specify the encryption of the Wireless LAN.
The WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless data
transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock
encoded data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys.
Range of Allowed Settings:
64 bit: 10 characters
128 bit: 26 characters
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-226 SM
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
Specify WPA2 when Communication Mode is set to Infrastructure Mode. Set the
WPA2 Encryption Method and WPA2 Authent. Method.
Installation
WPA2 Encryption Method:
CCMP (AES) is fixed.
WPA2 Authent. Method:
Select either WPA2-PSK" or WPA2.
If you select WPA2-PSK, enter the pre-shared key (PSK) of 8 - 63 characters in ASCII
code.
When WPA2 are selected, authentication settings and certificate installation settings
are required.
8. Press Wireless LAN Signal to check the machine's radio wave status using the
operation panel.
9. Press Restore Factory Defaults to initialize the wireless LAN settings. Press Yes to
initialize the following settings:
Transmission mode
Channel
Transmission Speed
WEP
SSID
WEP Key
SM 2-227 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IEEE 802.11a/g/n Interface Unit Type M2
SP5-840-011 WEP Key Select Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).
Name Function
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-228 SM
Bluetooth Interface Unit Type D
Installation
2.33.1 COMPONENT CHECK
- CD-ROM 1
- Caution Sheet 2
- FCC Sheet 2
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Insert the Bluetooth unit [A] into one of the USB slots.
SM 2-229 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
File Format Converter Type E
- FCC Sheet 1
2.34.2 INSTALLATION
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Remove the I/F slot cover [A] ( x2).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-230 SM
File Format Converter Type E
2. Install the board of the file format converter in the I/F slot [A] ( x2).
Installation
3. Turn on the main power of the machine.
4. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
SM 2-231 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
USB Device Server Option Type M12
No Items Qty
1 Interface Board 1
2 USB Cable 1
3 Ferrite Core 4
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-232 SM
USB Device Server Option Type M12
Installation
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
When you install this option on the main machine for the first time, the interface board
must be connected directly to your PC to set up the IP address and other network
settings.
1. Turn off the main power of the machine, and unplug the power cord from the wall
socket.
2. Remove the interface slot cover [A] ( x 2).
SM 2-233 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
USB Device Server Option Type M12
4. Insert the USB cable into the USB port on this option.
5. Insert the other side of the USB cable into the USB port B on the main machine.
The machine shape and/or USB port location differs depending on the machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-234 SM
USB Device Server Option Type M12
6. Attach the ferrite cores to the Ethernet cable, while looping the cable at 3 cm (approx.
1.2 inch) [A] from the each end of the cable.
Installation
7. Insert the Ethernet cable into the Ethernet port on this option.
8. Insert the other end of the Ethernet cable to a PC for network setting.
9. Plug the power cord into the wall socket and turn on the main power of the machine.
Do not unplug the USB cable while the machine is recognizing this option. It may
take between 30 seconds to 1 minute to finish recognizing it (the LEDs on the
Ethernet port of this option light up after recognizing this option; see below). If
unplugged, connect the cable again.
SM 2-235 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
USB Device Server Option Type M12
10. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-236 SM
USB Device Server Option Type M12
Installation
This section describes how to set an IP address on this option manually. Note that you can set an
IP address which is not only on the same network segment but also on a different network
segment to share a single printer with devices in multiple networks.
You cannot change the IP address for this option from the operation panel of the main
machine. The setting must be done from a web browser on your PC.
The network setting of this option is initially assigned as follows:
IP address: 192.168.100.100 / Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0
The network setting of your PC must be in the same network segment to change the
network setting of this option.
1. Make a note of the current network settings of your PC.
2. Change the IP address on your PC to [192.168.100.xxx (*0 - 255)].
3. Change the subnet mask on your PC to [255.255.255.0].
4. Open a web browser.
5. Type [http://192.168.100.100/] in the address bar.
6. Press the Enter key.
SM 2-237 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
USB Device Server Option Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-238 SM
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
Installation
2.36.1 COMPONENT CHECK
1 ICIB-3 1 Yes
2 Bracket 1 Yes
2.36.2 INSTALLATION
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Attach the bracket [A] to the ICIB-3 [B] ( x2; M3 x 4).
SM 2-239 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-240 SM
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
Installation
3. Attach the ICIB-3 bracket [A] to the IPU ( x2; M3 x 6).
The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the ICIB-3
removed and the Data Security for Copying feature set to ON.
The machine will issue an uncertain SC165 error if ICIB-3 is defective when the
machine is powered on and the Data Security for Copying feature is set to OFF.
When you remove this option from the machine, first set this feature to OFF with
the user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, Data Security for
Copying feature cannot appear in the user tool setting. Also, SC165 will appear
every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used.
5. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option.
SM 2-241 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M12
1 HDD Unit 1
2 Cable 1
3 Cable 1
- Screw 3
- ROHS Label 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-242 SM
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M12
2.37.2 INSTALLATION
Installation
Turn off the main power and disconnect the power supply cord.
1. Remove the controller cover (page 4-11).
2. Remove the controller rear cover (page 4-15).
3. Connect the cables [A] [B] to the HDD [C], and then attach the HDD [C] to the bracket
[D] ( x4).
4. Connect the cables of the HDD to the controller board [A], and then hang the HDD [B]
on the hook of the controller box ( x2).
5. Secure the HDD [B] ( x3).
SM 2-243 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M12
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-244 SM
SD Card Option
Installation
2.38.1 SD CARD SLOTS
SM 2-245 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SD Card Option
In this machine, it is possible to transfer data from a "Postscript3 Unit" SD card, unlike in
earlier models, due to a change in the software licensing (the part of the Postscript
software that requires licensing is now built into the controller, so the portion on the SD
card can be moved to another SD card).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-246 SM
SD Card Appli Move
Installation
2.39.1 OVERVIEW
The service program "SD Card Appli Move" (SP5-873) lets you move application programs from
one SD card to another SD card.
If more than one application is required, the applications must be moved to one SD card with
SP5873-1 (PostScript 3, IPDS unit, etc.).
Be very careful when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure:
The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD
card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you move the
application program from one card to another card.
Do not use the SD card if it has been used before for other purposes. Normal operation is not
guaranteed when such an SD card is used.
Store the vacant SD card in the storage space inside the main power switch cover as shown
below.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on
the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44)
occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
If the printer/scanner unit or the printer unit has been installed, the destination card
should be those SD cards.
SM 2-247 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SD Card Appli Move
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on
the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44)
occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn off the main power.
2. Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back
into this card.
3. Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application
program is copied back from this SD card.
4. Turn on the main power.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-002 "Undo Exec."
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn off the main power.
9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn on the main power.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-248 SM
OCR Unit Type M2
Installation
This option adds a searchable PDF function to the scanning function.
1 SD Card 1
3. Insert the OCR module SD card in SD card slot 1 [A] or slot 2 [B].
SM 2-249 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
OCR Unit Type M2
On the first run, SP5-878-004 links the SD card, and on the second run, copies
dictionary data.
9. Turn the main power OFF, and remove the SD card from the SD card slot.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-250 SM
OCR Unit Type M2
Keep the SD card in the SD card storage location of the MFP. The original SD card is
Installation
needed in the event of a HDD malfunction.
10. Return the SD card slot cover to the original position.
11. Turn the main power ON.
12. Press [Send File Type / Name] on the [Scanner] screen.
13. Check if [OCR Settings] is displayed on the [Send File Type / Name] screen.
After installation, the OCR setting can be changed on the "OCR setting" screen.
When setting OCR, set [OCR setting] to [Yes]. (Default setting: [No])
SM 2-251 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
OCR Unit Type M2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-252 SM
Browser Unit Type M12
Installation
2.41.1 COMPONENT CHECK
1 SD Card 1
In addition to link-up with the conventional Scan Router and MFP, the browser unit has
the following functions.
For scanning, arbitrary distribution types and preset values are selected/set and delivered.
Mail is delivered (login transmission) to an address previously set in the profile of the user
who logged in.
SM 2-253 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Browser Unit Type M12
3. Insert the browser unit SD card in SD card slot 1 [A] or slot 2 [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-254 SM
Browser Unit Type M12
Installation
17. Check that the [Browser] icon has been added to the Home screen.
To update EXJS
1. Put the SD card containing the firmware of the browser application to update with in
SD card slot 2 [B], and then turn on the main power.
SM 2-255 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Browser Unit Type M12
17. Press [SD card], and select "Extended JS" from the list of extension functions.
18. Select [MFP hard disk] as the installation location, and press [Next].
19. After checking extension function information on the Installation preparation
complete screen, press the [Enter] button.
20. "The following extension functions are already installed. The message Overwrite
extension function? is displayed. Press the [Continue] button.
21. When installation is complete, the message Extension function has been installed" is
displayed. Press the [OK] button.
22. On the Startup settings tab, set [Extended JS] to the startup standby state, and turn
the main power OFF.
23. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2, and return the SD slot cover.
24. Turn the main power ON.
25. Press the [Default setting/counter] key.
26. Press the [Extension function default setting] button.
27. Press the [Extension function default setting] button on the [Extension function default
menu setting] screen.
28. Check the version of [Extended JS] on the Startup settings tab is the latest version.
If the power is ON before starting Step 1, turn the main power OFF after first performing
Steps 5-9, and perform Step 1 and subsequent steps. In that case, skip Steps 5-10. (This
saves time.)
If you do not plan to update Extension JavaScript, return the SD slot cover to the original
position after performing Step 5.
If checked apart from the above procedure (firmware version displayed in system default
settings), a different version from the actual version may be displayed.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-256 SM
Browser Unit Type M12
Installation
EXJS uninstallation procedure
1. Turn the main power ON.
2. Press the [Default settings/counter] key.
3. Press the [Login/Logout] key, and log in with an administrator account (login user
name, login password).
4. Press [Extension function default setting], and when the screen changes, press
[Extension function default setting] again.
5. Press the [Uninstall] tab.
6. When Browser is pressed, a message screen is displayed, press [Continue].
7. When a message reconfirming uninstallation is displayed, press [Continue].
8. When the message "Extended functions have been uninstalled", press [Confirm] and
the display returns to the setting screen.
9. Close [Default settings/counter] settings, and turn OFF the main power.
Uninstall is not completed before removing the SD card. This is because the SD card has
the browser application data.
2.41.3 SETTINGS
SM 2-257 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SD card for NetWare printing Type M12
1 SD Card 1
- ROHS Label 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-258 SM
SD card for NetWare printing Type M12
3. Insert the Netware printing SD card in SD card slot 1 [A] or slot 2 [B].
Installation
4. Perform the merge operation if necessary (page 2-247).
5. Attach the SD card slot cover ( 1).
6. Turn ON the main power.
7. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
SM 2-259 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PostScript3 Unit Type M12
1 SD Card 1
- PS3 Decal 1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-260 SM
PostScript3 Unit Type M12
Installation
4. If necessary, perform the merge operation. (page 2-247)
5. Reattach the SD card slot cover ( 1).
6. Stick the "Adobe PostScript3" decal on the front face of the MFP.
7. Turn ON the main power.
8. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
The PDF firmware installed as standard contains a program required to print PS3 data as
default. However, this PS3 program is normally disabled.
The PS3 firmware is a dongle (key) which enables PS3 data printing functions. When the
PS3 firmware is installed, the PS3 program in the PDF firmware is enabled. Due to this
specification, the self-diagnosis result report shows the ROM part number/software
version of the PDF firmware contained in the PS3 program.
SM 2-261 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
XPS Direct Print Option Type M12
3. Slowly, insert the XPS SD card in Slot 1 with its label face towards the front of the
machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-262 SM
XPS Direct Print Option Type M12
Installation
4. Perform the merge operation if necessary (page 2-247).
5. Attach the SD card slot cover ( x 1).
6. Turn on the machine.
7. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
SM 2-263 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IPDS Unit Type M12
2.45.1 ACCESSORIES
Check the accessories and their quantities against the table below.
- Decal 1
- EULA Sheet 1
- Caution Sheet 1
- CD-ROM 1
2.45.2 INSTALLATION
1. Turn the main power OFF.
2. Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( 1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-264 SM
IPDS Unit Type M12
Installation
4. Turn the main power ON.
5. Perform the merge operation if necessary (page 2-247).
1. Switch the power OFF after completing the merge operation.
2. Remove the empty SD card from SD card slot 2.
6. Reattach the cover.
7. Do one of the following ("A" or "B") to enable the IPDS function.
A. [Enable the IPDS function via telnet]
1. Connect the machine via telnet.
2. Execute the following commands:
msh> set ipds up
***If you want to stop the function.
msh> set ipds down
B. [Enable the IPDS option via WebImageMonitor]
1. Log in to WebImageMonitor.
2. Change the setting to enable IPDS.
SM 2-265 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
IPDS Unit Type M12
9. Print out the Configuration Page, and then check if this option is correctly
recognized.
User Tools/Counter > Printer Features > List/Test Page > Configuration Page
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-266 SM
External Keyboard Bracket Type M3 (D739-10)
Installation
2.46.1 COMPONENT CHECK
Description Qty
Keyboard Stand 1
Screw: M4 x 12 2
Screw: M3 x 8 4
Screw: M3 x 12 1
ROHS Label 1
SM 2-267 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
External Keyboard Bracket Type M3 (D739-10)
4. Make 3 screw holes [A] in the main power switch cover, and then reattach it to the
machine ( 1, hooks).
5. Attach the keyboard stand bracket [A] on the main power switch cover ( x3).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-268 SM
External Keyboard Bracket Type M3 (D739-10)
6. Attach the keyboard stand [A] on the keyboard stand bracket ( x4).
Installation
7. Place a keyboard [A] on the keyboard stand, and then pass the keyboard cable through
the hole [B] in the keyboard stand.
8. Scanner rear cover [A] ( 3)
10. Route the keyboard cable along the right side of the scanner unit as shown below.
SM 2-269 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
External Keyboard Bracket Type M3 (D739-10)
11. Route the keyboard cable along the rear side of the scanner unit ( x1).
12. Adjust the keyboard cable by making loops if the keyboard cable has too much slack.
13. Remove the cutout [A] in the left rear cover to make a cable hole, and then pass the
keyboard cable [B] through it.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-270 SM
External Keyboard Bracket Type M3 (D739-10)
Installation
15. Reattach the scanner right cover [A] ( 1).
16. Reattach the scanner rear cover [A] ( 3).
17. Close the right cover.
SM 2-271 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I (D362)
2.47.1 OVERVIEW
This option should be installed only for the customer who requires the CC certified Data
Overwrite Security function.
The function of this option is completely the same as the Data Overwrite Security in Security
Functions, which is standard on this machine.
1. SD Card 1
If you install any version other than "Type I", you have to replace the NVRAM and do
this installation procedure again.
2. Make sure that the following settings are not at their factory default values:
Supervisor login password
Administrator login name
Administrator login password
If any of these settings is at a factory default value, tell the customer these settings must be
changed before you do the installation procedure.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-272 SM
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I (D362)
Installation
[Admin. Authentication]
If this setting is OFF, tell the customer this setting must be ON before you do the installation
procedure.
4. Make sure that Administrator Tools is enabled (selected).
[System Settings] [Administrator Tools] [Administrator Authentication Management] -
[Available Settings]
If this setting is disabled (not selected), tell the customer this setting must be enabled
(selected) before you do the installation procedure.
You must check the box seals to make sure that they are not removed after the items
have been sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.
1. Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box.
Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.
The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see VOID on the tapes, do not install the
components in the box.
2. If the surfaces of the tapes do not show VOID, remove them from the corners of the
box.
3. You can see the VOID marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they
cannot be attached to the box again.
SM 2-273 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I (D362)
3. Insert the SD card (DataOverwriteSecurity Unit) in SD slot 1 (upper) [A] with its label
face towards the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into SD slot 1 (upper) until
you hear a click.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-274 SM
Security Setting
Installation
2.48.1 SECURITY FUNCTION INSTALLATION
The machine contains the Security functions (Data Overwrite Security and HDD Encryption unit)
in the controller board.
If you are installing a new machine, it is recommended to activate the Data Overwrite Security and
HDD Encryption by selecting "Format All Data" from System Settings on the operation panel.
This method is recommended because there is no user data on the hard drive yet
(Address Book data, image data, etc.).
If the customer wishes to activate the Data Overwrite Security and HDD Encryption unit on a
machine that is already running, it is recommended to activate the unit by selecting "All Data" from
System Settings on the operation panel.
Selecting "All Data" will preserve the data that has already been saved to the HDD. (If
"Format All Data" is selected, all user data saved to the HDD up to that point will be
erased).
Immediately after encryption is enabled, the encryption setting process will take several minutes
to complete before you can begin using the machine.
If encryption is enabled after data has been stored on the HDD, or of the encryption key is
changed, this process can take up to three and a half hours or more.
The machine cannot be operated while data is being encrypted.
Once the encryption process begins, it cannot be stopped.
Make sure that the machine's main power is not turned off while the encryption process is in
progress.
If the machine's main power is turned off while the encryption process is in progress, the HDD will
be damaged and all data on it will be unusable.
Print the encryption key and keep the encryption key (which is printed as a paper sheet).
Keep the encryption key in a safe place. If the encryption key is lost and is needed, the controller
board, HDD and NVRAM must all be replaced at the same time.
SM 2-275 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Security Setting
6. Press [On].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-276 SM
Security Setting
Installation
If you select [Random Numbers], proceed to step 8.
8. Press [Change].
9. Enter the number of times that you want to overwrite using the number keys, and then
press [#].
10. Press [OK]. Auto Erase Memory is set.
11. Log out.
12. Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon appears.
13. Check the overwrite erase icon.
The icon [1] is lit when there is temporary data to be overwritten, and blinks during
overwriting.
The icon [2] is lit when there is no temporary data to be overwritten.
SM 2-277 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Security Setting
When setting up encryption, specify whether to start encryption after deleting data
(initialize) or encrypt and retain existing data. If data is retained, it may take some time to
encrypt it.
1. Turn on the main power.
2. Log in as the machine administrator from the control panel.
3. Press [System Settings].
4. Press [Administrator Tools].
5. Press [Next] three times.
6. Press [Machine Data Encryption Settings].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-278 SM
Security Setting
Installation
7. Press [Encrypt].
8. Select the data to be carried over to the HDD and not be reset.
To carry all of the data over to the HDD, select [All Data].
To carry over only the machine settings data, select [File System Data Only].
To reset all of the data, select [Format All Data].
9. Select the backup method.
If you have selected [Save to SD Card], load an SD card into the media slot on the side of the
control panel and press [OK] to back up the machine's data encryption key.
If you have selected [Print on Paper], press the [Start] key. Print out the machine's data
encryption key.
10. Press [OK].
11. Press [Exit].
12. Press [Exit].
13. Log out.
14. Turn off the main power, and then turn the main power back on.
The machine will start to convert the data on the memory after you turn on the machine. Wait
until the message "Memory conversion complete. Turn the main power switch off." appears,
and then turn the main power off again.
SM 2-279 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Security Setting
The encryption key is required for data recovery if the machine malfunctions. Be sure to
store the encryption key safely for retrieving backup data.
1. Log in as the machine administrator from the control panel.
2. Press [System Settings].
3. Press [Administrator Tools].
4. Press [Next] three times.
5. Press [Machine Data Encryption Settings].
6. Press [Print Encryption Key].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-280 SM
Security Setting
Installation
control panel and press [OK]; once the machine's data encryption key is backed up, press
[Exit].
If you have selected [Print on Paper], press the [Start] key. Print out the machine's data
encryption key.
8. Press [Exit].
9. Log out.
Ask an Administrator to enter the encryption key. The key has already been printed
out by the user and may have been saved in the "key_xxxxxxxxxxx.txt" file. (The
function of back-up the encryption key to the SD card directly is provided 11A
products or later.)
5. Turn on the machines main power.
6. Confirm that a message is displayed on the LCD telling to insert the SD card that
contains the encryption key.
7. Turn off the main power.
8. Insert the SD card that contains the encryption key into SD card slot 2 (the lower slot).
9. Turn on the main power.
SM 2-281 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Security Setting
The machine will automatically restore the encryption key to the flash memory on the
controller board.
10. Turn off the main power when the machine has returned to normal status.
11. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2.
How to do a forced start up with no encryption key
If the encryption key back-up has been lost, follow the procedure below to do a forced start-up.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-282 SM
@Remote Settings
Installation
Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For
details, ask the @Remote key person.
Check points before making @Remote settings
1. The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".
2. Print the SMC with SP5990-002 and then check if a device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be
correctly programmed.
6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number (e.g.
xxx______xxxxxxxx).
ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2:
A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)
3. The following settings must be correctly programmed.
Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)
Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)
Proxy User ID (SP5816-065)
Proxy Password (SP5816-066)
4. Get a Request Number
Execute the @Remote Settings
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Input the Request number which you have obtained from @Remote Center GUI, and
then enter [OK] with SP5816-202.
3. Confirm the Request number, and then click [EXECUTE] with SP5816-203.
SM 2-283 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
@Remote Settings
0 Succeeded -
5 Proxy error (authentication error) Check Proxy user name and password.
11 Already registered -
12 Parameter error -
25 unplugged modem
26 Busy line
5. Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only
when it has been input at the Center GUI.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-284 SM
@Remote Settings
Installation
Value Meaning Solution/ Workaround
0 Succeeded -
5 Proxy error (Authentication error) Check Proxy user name and password.
11 Already registered -
12 Parameter error -
25 unplugged modem
26 Busy line
SM 2-285 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
@Remote Settings
-12010 The certification area is not initialized. Initialize the certification area.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-286 SM
@Remote Settings
Installation
Code Meaning Solution/ Workaround
SM 2-287 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Operation Guidance for Users
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 2-288 SM
Operation Guidance for Users
Installation
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SM 2-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Preventive Maintenance Tables
3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
Maintenance
Preventive
3.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES
SM 3-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Image Quality Standards
3.2.1 RESOLUTION
Copy Ave 5.0 lines/mm or Book: S-5 Copy onto plain paper
(100%/Enlargement), more (revised) using Auto Image
Black and White (1C) Min 4.5lines/mm or Density/5 notches and
more then determine resolution.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 3-2 SM
Image Quality Standards
Maintenance
Preventive
Item Specification Chart Measuring method
Engine, Main Scan, 0.50% or less Mono_CCD Copy the scale and
Black and White compare it with the scale
(1C) at 100 mm to see if it is
within specification.
Engine, Sub Scan, 0.50% or less Scale chart
Leave the sheet for 3
Black and White
minutes or more after it
(1C)
has been output before
Copy (100%), Main 0.80% or less measuring.
Scan, Black and
White (1C)
SM 3-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Image Quality Standards
Copy (100% / 1.00% or less Scale chart Leave the sheet for 3
Enlargement / minutes or more after it
Reduction), Black has been output before
and White (1C) measuring.
Engine, Black and 1.50% or less For a line of about 1/2 inch
Mono_CCD
White(1C) in length.
3.2.5 PERPENDICULARITY
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 3-4 SM
Image Quality Standards
3.2.6 LINEARITY
Maintenance
Preventive
Item Specification Chart Measuring method
Scale chart
3.2.7 PARALLELISM
SM 3-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Image Quality Standards
Engine/Copy
(leading edge), 4.21.5%
Black and White(1C)
Since there is a variability
Engine/Copy of about 1 mm in the sizes
(left/right), Black and 0.5 to 4.0mm Trim of sheets of paper, correct
White(1C) the size of the sheet before
measuring.
Engine/Copy 0.5 to 6.0mm
(trailing edge), Black (Duplex: 3.0 to
and White(1C) 6.0mm)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 3-6 SM
Paper Transfer Quality Standards
Maintenance
Preventive
3.3.1 REGISTRATION
3.3.2 SKEW
Exposure glass
SM 3-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Transfer Quality Standards
ADF
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 3-8 SM
PM Parts Settings
Maintenance
Preventive
3.4.1 PM PARTS REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
Since the machine detects a new PCDU and fusing unit automatically, you do not need to
set Manual New Unit Set with an SP.
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004.
3. Set the following SPs to "1".
Item SP
PCU: SP3-701-002
Cleaning Blade: SP3-701-009
Charge Roller: SP3-701-018
Cleaner: Charge Roller (Cleaning
PCU
Roller): SP3-701-019
OPC: SP3-701-021
Separation Pawl (Pick-off Pawls):
SP3-701-022
SM 3-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PM Parts Settings
After the PM counter for the Fusing Belt (heating sleeve belt unit) reaches its PM cycle,
the machine stops the operation automatically. Replace the heating sleeve belt unit
before the machine stops its operation (stop warning: 240K pages, stop: 260K pages for
D197/D198/D199, stop warning: 320K pages, stop: 350K pages for D200/D201/D202).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 3-10 SM
PM Parts Settings
Maintenance
Preventive
REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SM 3-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Notes on the Main Power Switch
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.1 NOTES ON THE MAIN POWER SWITCH
SM 4-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Notes on the Main Power Switch
When you reconnect the AC power cord into an AC wall outlet, the machine will start
automatically.
In order to remove the residual charge, push the main power switch while you disconnect the
AC power cord. At that time, the power ON flag inside the machine is set. Therefore, after you
finish work on the machine and reconnect the power cord to the AC, even if you do not press
the main power switch, the machine will start automatically and the moving parts will begin to
move. When working on moving parts, be careful that fingers or clothes do not get
caught.
Automatic restart deals with cases when you accidentally unplugged the AC power
cord or unexpected power outages. By keeping the power flag ON, after the
resumption of power, the machine will start up automatically.
In rare cases, when you reconnect the AC power cord to a power outlet, the machine does
not start automatically. In this case, the machine has not failed. The cause is due to the timing
of releasing the residual charge. If you press the main power switch while the residual charge
was already released, the power ON flag will not be set. At this time, start the machine
manually by pressing the main power switch.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-2 SM
Notes on the Main Power Switch
Shutdown Method
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Press the main power switch [A] on the front of the machine.
2. Take out the power cord
3. Wait 3 minutes (this is the time required if you will remove the rear cover and access the
interior of the machine, to take out the controller board for example).
Note: If some LEDs on any of the boards are blinking or lit, current is still flowing.
After the shutdown process, the main power is turned off automatically.
Forced Shutdown
In case normal shutdown does not complete for some reason, the machine has a forced shutdown
function.
To make a forced shutdown, press and hold the main power switch for 6 seconds.
In general, do not use the forced shutdown.
Forced shutdown may damage the hard disk and memory, and can cause damage to the
machine. Use a forced shutdown only if it is unavoidable.
SM 4-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Beforehand
4.2 BEFOREHAND
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord.
After replacing, make sure that all removed harnesses are connected up again and
secured in their clamps.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-4 SM
Special Tools and Lubricants
and Adjustment
Replacement
The following special tools should be prepared for maintenance of this model in the field.
Unique or Common:
U: Unique for this model
C: Common with listed model
A PC (Personal Computer) is required for creating the Encryption key file to an SD card
when replacing the controller board for a model in which HDD encryption has been
enabled.
4.3.2 LUBRICANTS
Unique or
No. Part No. Description Q'ty
Common
SM 4-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Cover Removal Order
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-6 SM
Cover Removal Order
and Adjustment
Replacement
8 1st Paper Feed Tray 22 Right Lower Cover
SM 4-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Cover Removal Order
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-8 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
The Aim of Anti-tip Components and Precautions
The anti-tip components [A] are necessary for meeting the requirements of IEC60950-1, the
international standard for safety.
The aim of these components is to prevent the products, which are heavy, from toppling as a
result of people running into or leaning onto the products, which can lead to serious accidents
such as persons becoming trapped under the product. (U.S.: UL60950-1, Europe:
EN60950-1)
SM 4-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
The front cover can be removed by sliding it in the direction of the blue arrow.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-10 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Controller cover [A] ( 4)
SM 4-11 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
Each part enclosed by a blue circle has a tab. Be careful not to damage it when attaching
and detaching.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-12 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Left upper cover (page 4-12)
2. Rear lower gap cover (page 4-17)
3. Left Rear Cover [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 4-13 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
Each part enclosed by a blue circle has a tab. Be careful not to damage it when attaching
and detaching.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-14 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
There are some claws on the back face of the controller rear cover. When fitting or
removing the cover, take care not to damage them.
SM 4-15 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-16 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Rear lower gap cover [A] (hook2)
SM 4-17 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
When installing, insert the projections [A] in the holes [B], taking care not to trap the
harness inside.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-18 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Main Power Switch Cover (page 4-22)
2. Right upper cover [A] ( 2)
SM 4-19 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-20 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
7. Slide to the left and remove right cover [A] ( 1).
SM 4-21 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-22 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Paper Exit Tray [A]
SM 4-23 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-24 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Left upper cover (page 4-12)
2. Paper exit cover (page 4-23)
3. Paper exit lower cover (page 4-24)
4. Tray support rod cover [A] ( 1)
SM 4-25 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-26 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Pull out the toner bottle
2. Paper exit lower cover (page 4-24)
3. Upper inner cover (page 4-25)
4. Development exhaust fan (page 4-182)
5. Fan [A] with duct ( 2)
SM 4-27 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Exterior Covers
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-28 SM
Operation Panel
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.6.1 OPERATION PANEL
1. Scanner front cover (page 4-37)
2. Operation panel upper cover [A]
SM 4-29 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Operation Panel
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-30 SM
Operation Panel
and Adjustment
Replacement
6. Key control board [A] ( 8, 1, x2)
SM 4-31 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Operation Panel
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-32 SM
Operation Panel
4.6.5 LCD
and Adjustment
Replacement
Notes when replacing the LCD
Since LCD panels from 2 vendors are used, the replacement parts are different. When replacing,
check the vendor used, and ensure that you use the correct part.
Distinguishing method
Of the 3 labels on the rear of the operation panel, the center label shows the LCD model
number.
Operation panel rear surface
SM 4-33 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Operation Panel
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-34 SM
Operation Panel
Replacement procedure
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Operation panel (page 4-29)
2. Operation panel lower cover (page 4-30 "Key Control Board")
3. Harness guide (page 4-30 "Key Control Board")
4. Bracket covers (page 4-30 "Key Control Board")
5. Operation panel arm bracket (page 4-30 "Key Control Board")
6. LCD Panel (page 4-32)
7. LCD [A]
SM 4-35 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
When you replace the scanner wire, use the standard positioning pins.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-36 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Open the ARDF or platen cover.
2. Scanner front cover [A] ( 2)
There is a tab [A] inside this cover at the left side. Release the left tab after removing
the two screws of the scanner front cover. First, carefully and slightly pull the left side
of the cover towards the outside and release the left side tab, then pull up the right
upper side tab and release it.
SM 4-37 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-38 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. Left scale and exposure glass [A]
The exposure glass and the left scale are attached with double-sided tape.
SM 4-39 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-40 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Scanner upper cover (page 4-36)
2. Scanner motor frame [A] ( 4, 3)
To remove the inner two screws, insert your screwdriver as shown by the blue arrows
below.
3. Spring [A]
SM 4-41 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-42 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Exposure Glass (page 4-38)
2. Lens block cover [A] ( 2)
SM 4-43 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
4.7.7 SIO
1. Scanner rear cover (page 4-18)
2. Scanner upper cover (page 4-36)
3. SIO [A] ( 4, 6)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-44 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Scanner upper cover (page 4-36)
2. Exposure glass (page 4-38)
3. Slide the exposure lamp (1st scanner carriage) [A] in the direction of the arrow a little.
SM 4-45 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
Be sure to use the special tool for scanner wire adjustment. (page 4-5)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-46 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
7. Move the 1st scanner carriage to the set position of the scanner fixing pin.
SM 4-47 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-48 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Pass the ball-shaped end of the wire through the boss of the pulley [A].
2. Fit the ball at the middle of the wire into the cutout in the pulley [A].
3. Coil up the ball-shaped end of the wire counter clockwise (when looking at the boss of
the pulley) four and half times, next to the rim at the rear side of the pulley.
SM 4-49 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
4. Coil up the ball-shaped end of the wire clockwise (when looking at the boss of the
pulley) three and half times, next to the rim at the front side of the pulley.
5. Make sure that blue markings of the wire are aligned, and then fix the wire temporarily
with tape.
6. Set the pulley [A] on the drive shaft [B] ( 1, 1, bearing 1).
7. Set the ball-shaped end of the wire with the following procedure.
1. Route the wire from under side of the pulley [A] of the left frame toward the upside and
hook the wire on the outer edge of the pulley [A].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-50 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
2. Route the wire over the 2nd carriage pulley [A] in the direction of the blue arrow.
3. Hook the ball-shaped end of the wire in the slit [A] in the left frame.
8. Set the ring-shaped end of the wire with the following procedure.
1. Route the wire from the underside of the pulley [A] of the right frame toward upside and
hook the wire on the outer edge of the pulley [A].
SM 4-51 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
2. Route the wire over the 2nd carriage pulley [A] in the direction of the blue arrow.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-52 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
Fasten the screw temporarily for the wire clamp.
SM 4-53 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
After replacing the wire, make a test copy, and check skew, magnification, and whether
there is a registration gap. If there is a gap, adjust the scanner wire position again, or
perform Scan Registration Adjustment (SP4010 - SP4011).
4. Bracket [A] ( 4)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-54 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. SIO with bracket ( 2, 5).
SM 4-55 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
7. Move the 1st scanner carriage to the set position of the scanner fixing pin.
9. Loosen the belt tension [A] ( 2, spring 1) and remove the scanner drive gear [B]
( 1).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-56 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
11. Pull out the scanner drive shaft [B] and remove the pulley [A].
SM 4-57 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
2. Fit the ball of the middle of wire in the cutout of the pulley [A].
3. Coil up the ball-shaped end of the wire counter clockwise (when looking at the boss of
the pulley) four and half times, next to the rim at the rear side of the pulley.
4. Coil up the ball-shaped end of the wire clockwise (when looking at the boss of the
pulley) three and half times, next to the rim at the front side of the pulley.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-58 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
6. Fix the wire temporarily with tape.
8. Attach the scanner drive gear [A], and then tighten the scanner motor bracket ( 3,
spring 1, belt 1).
SM 4-59 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
9. Reassemble the rear scanner wire with the same procedure as the front.
10. Reassemble the scanner wire (front).
11. Do the scanner adjustment.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-60 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
3. Replace the contactless guide plate (front) [A] with the contact guide plate (front) [B]
( 1).
There is a hole in the contact guide plate (front).
4. Replace the contactless guide plate (rear) [A] with the contact guide plate (rear) [B].
There is a hole in the contact guide plate (rear).
SM 4-61 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
5. Attach the document reader guide plate. Be careful not to scratch the sheet [A].
6. Attach the ADF front cover, and return the ADF to its original position.
7. Enter SP mode, and then change the DF density setting (SP4-688-001) from [102%] to
[97%].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-62 SM
Scanner Unit
2. Wipe the exposure glass with alcohols so that no glue remains from the double-sided
and Adjustment
tape.
Replacement
Remember that if any glue remains, it will cause a paper jam in the ADF.
The part below the contactless lower entrance guide unit is black [A].
The part below the contact lower entrance guide unit is colorless and transparent [B].
SM 4-63 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner Unit
The part below the contactless document reader guide plate is black [A].
The part below the contact document reader guide plate is white [B].
6. Enter SP mode, and then change the Scan Image Density Adjustment (SP4-688-002)
from [103] to [98].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-64 SM
Scanner Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Exposure glass (page 4-38)
2. Peel off the gap sheet (black) [A] from the sheet-through glass [B].
3. Wipe the exposure glass with alcohol, etc., so that no glue remains from the
double-sided tape.
Remember that if any glue remains, it will cause a paper jam in the ADF.
SM 4-65 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Laser Unit
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the
procedures in this section. Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.
Be sure to turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power plug from the power
outlet before beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses
a class IIIb laser beam with a wavelength of 660 nm and an output of 17 mW. The laser
can cause serious eye injury.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-66 SM
Laser Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
Removing the Laser Unit
1. Open the front cover.
2. Laser unit cover [A] ( x 1)
SM 4-67 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Laser Unit
4. Insert the new laser unit along the guide frame [A].
Make sure that the new laser unit claws fit into two mainframe claws as shown below.
Mainframe Claws
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-68 SM
Laser Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. Set the laser unit with the stopper [A].
Use a screw driver to pry in the stopper.
SM 4-69 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Laser Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-70 SM
Laser Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. PCDU (page 4-72)
2. Fusing Unit (page 4-114)
3. PCL [A] ( x3, x3, x1).
SM 4-71 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
4.9 PCDU
To prevent damage from toner spillage during the PCDU removal, be sure to place a
ground cloth on the floor.
To prevent damage from excess light, wrap the OPC drum with protective paper and
store the OPC drum in a cool dark place.
Do not touch the OPC drum, cleaning blade, or any seals or tapes.
Do not use any alcohols or solvents to clean the OPC drum; Be sure to wipe with a dry
cloth. If excess dirt exists, first wipe with a damp cloth, and next wipe off completely with
a dry cloth.
Do not rotate the OPC drum clockwise after the PCDU has been installed.
4.9.2 PCDU
If you replace the PCDU, you do not need to perform SP 3-701. This is because the
machine detects a new unit automatically when you cycle the main power off/on, and
performs the initial adjustment automatically.
1. Open the front cover
2. Open the right cover
3. Tilt the transfer unit [A].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-72 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Carefully and slowly pull out the PCDU without tilting, to prevent toner spillage.
When installing the PCDU, push the PCDU into the machine while screwing it in, as
shown below, and then secure the PCDU. If the PCDU is not installed straight, the
transfer roller contact and release mechanism does not work properly and dirt may
appear on the 2nd side of outputs.
SM 4-73 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
3. Split the assembly into the PCU [A] and development unit [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-74 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Face plate for rear side
Installing a PCU
Before replacing the PCU, set the setting of SP3-701-002 to 1 and turn off the main
power switch.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the PCU, turn on the main power on.
1. Disassemble the PCDU into PCU and development unit (page 4-74).
2. Replace the used PCU with a new one.
3. Reassemble the PCDU.
Before replacing the development unit, set the setting of SP3-701-023 to 1 and turn off
the main power switch.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the development unit, turn on the main power on.
1. Disassemble the PCDU into PCU and development unit (page 4-74).
SM 4-75 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-76 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the OPC drum, set the setting of SP3-701-021 to 1 and turn off the
main power switch.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the OPC drum, turn on the main power on.
1. PCU (page 4-74)
2. Stopper [A] for the PCU
SM 4-77 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
Before replacing these rollers, set the setting of SP3-701-018 for the charge roller and/or
SP3-701-019 for the cleaning roller to 1 and turn the main power switch OFF.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the rollers, turn the main power switch ON.
1. PCU (page 4-74)
2. OPC drum (page 4-77)
3. Charge roller and cleaning roller [A] with its bearing
4. Split the assembly into the charge roller [A] and cleaning roller [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-78 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the pick-off pawls, set the setting of SP3-701-022 to 1 and turn off the
main power switch.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the pick-off pawls, turn on the main power on.
1. PCU (page 4-74)
2. Pick-off pawls [A]
Use a screw driver to pry away the tabs of the pick-off pawl. If the pick-off pawl has
marked the drum with a line, the pick-off pawl position can be adjusted.
SM 4-79 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
Before replacing the cleaning blade, set the setting of SP3-701-009 to 1 and turn the
main power switch OFF.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the cleaning blade, turn the main power switch ON.
1. PCU (page 4-74)
2. OPC drum (page 4-77)
3. Charge roller and cleaning roller (page 4-78)
4. Cleaning blade [A] ( x2)
The cleaning blade [A] has two different types of holes: a circle ( ), and an oval
( ). Remove the screw on the circle side first, and then, remove the oval side.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-80 SM
PCDU
4.9.8 DEVELOPER
and Adjustment
Replacement
These sheets used in steps 6, 11, and 12 are not provided as accessories; please do not
forget to order with the developer.
Before replacing the developer, set the setting of SP3-701-024 to 1 and turn the main
power switch OFF.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the developer, turn the main power switch ON.
If you replace developer together with the development filter, firstly replace the developer,
next replace the filter.
1. Development unit (page 4-74)
2. Bearing (front) [A] (E-ring x1)
SM 4-81 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
3. Pull the shaft toward the blue arrow shown below, then remove the pin [A] and gear
[B].
6. Development side seal and development case entrance seal [A] at each end.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-82 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
7. Lift up the development sleeve unit [A].
Do not touch or hold the development sleeve edge [A] when holding the sleeve unit.
Otherwise, it may cause an injury.
8. Remove the developer after turning the development unit upside down in the reverse
direction of the development filter.
SM 4-83 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
9. Stand the development unit up, and add new developer evenly across the width of the
development unit while rotating the gear.
The sheets for the development sleeve unit [A] must be under the sheets [B] for the
development unit.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-84 SM
PCDU
Correct Wrong
and Adjustment
Replacement
11. Wipe off the areas [A] indicated by the red-dashed line and paste new development
case entrance seals to cover the blue-circled position.
These seals are part of the development seal set, which must be ordered together with
the new developer.
The seal [A] for the front side is not the same shape as the one [B] for the rear side
as shown below. Be careful when you paste them.
12. Paste the new development side seals [A] on the face of the development sleeve unit
as shown below.
These seals are part of the development seal set, which must be ordered together with
the new developer.
SM 4-85 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-86 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the development filter, set the setting of SP3-701-025 to 1 and turn the
main power switch OFF.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the development filter, turn the main power switch ON.
If you replace the development filter together with developer, firstly replace the developer,
next replace the filter.
1. Development unit (page 4-74)
2. Development filter [A]
SM 4-87 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
4.9.10 TD SENSOR
1. Development unit (page 4-74)
2. TD sensor cover [A].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-88 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the development mixing auger bearings, set the setting of SP3-701-028
to 1 and turn the main power switch OFF.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the development mixing auger bearings, turn the main power switch ON.
1. Development unit (page 4-74)
2. Pull the shaft toward you, and then pull out the pin [A] and remove the gear [B].
SM 4-89 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
The development mixing auger bearings are D-shaped. Make sure that you install them
in the orientation exactly as shown above.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-90 SM
PCDU
and Adjustment
Replacement
[A]: Development Mixing Auger (L)
[B]: Development Mixing Auger (R)
SM 4-91 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCDU
Each auger is different; please make sure that the augers are attached correctly.
[A]: Development Mixing Auger (L)
[B]: Development Mixing Auger (R)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-92 SM
Waste Toner
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.10.1 WASTE TONER BOTTLE
1. Open the front cover.
2. Pull out the waste toner bottle [A] ( x1, 1).
There is no waste toner bottle set switch. If you remove the waste toner bottle, be
sure to replace it before you finish work on the machine.
SM 4-93 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Waste Toner
6. 3.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-94 SM
Waste Toner
and Adjustment
Replacement
8. Bracket [A] ( 4, washer 1).
SM 4-95 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Waste Toner
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-96 SM
Waste Toner
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Recycling shutter solenoid (page 4-94).
2. Bracket [A] ( 4).
Place a sheet of paper underneath the bracket, and then put the bracket on the sheet.
Otherwise, the grease applied to the gear in the bracket may adhere to the floor.
SM 4-97 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Waste Toner
Place a sheet of paper underneath the recycling shutter unit, and then put the
recycling shutter unit on the sheet. Otherwise, the grease applied to the gear in the
unit may adhere to the floor.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-98 SM
Transfer Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.11.1 TRANSFER UNIT
1. Open the right cover.
2. Close the transfer unit [A]
3. Remove the clip of the transfer unit [A] and disconnect the connector.
4. Slide the bearing in the blue arrow direction to release it from the frame of the main
machine
SM 4-99 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Transfer Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-100 SM
Transfer Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the Transfer roller unit, set the setting of SP3-701-108 to 1 and turn off
the main power switch.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the Transfer roller unit, turn on the main power on.
1. Open the right cover.
2. Release the claws of the transfer roller unit [A].
SM 4-101 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Transfer Unit
4.11.3 ID SENSOR
You must take note of the original value of SP3-331-061 to prepare for the possibility that
the process control after replacement will not be done properly.
A QR-code is pasted on the sensor head of an ID sensor, which includes the characteristic value
for the sensor. This characteristic value must be input to SP3-331-061 before replacing the ID
sensor.
1. Take a note of the characteristic value in the following red-dashed part on the new ID
sensor.
Replacement Procedure
1. Open the right cover.
2. ID sensor [A] ( 1, 1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-102 SM
Transfer Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Open the right cover.
2. Guide plate [A] ( 2)
SM 4-103 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Transfer Unit
3. Inserting a driver from the frame hole, remove the screw of the temperature/humidity
sensor [A] ( 1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-104 SM
Transfer Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Open the right cover.
2. Fusing entrance sensor [A] with bracket ( 1)
SM 4-105 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Transfer Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-106 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.12.1 DRUM/WASTE TONER MOTOR
1. Rear right cover (page 4-16)
2. Drum/Waste Toner Motor [A] ( 4, 1)
SM 4-107 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Drive Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-108 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Rear lower cover (page 4-17)
2. Paper feed motor ( 2, 1)
SM 4-109 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Drive Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-110 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
Toner remains in the toner hopper [A]. Be sure to place the toner hopper on a sheet
of paper to protect against toner spillage.
Attach the toner supply pipe [A] before installing the gear box and toner hopper.
Fit the hole of the supply pipe to the pin [B] and then stabilize the pipe ( x1).
SM 4-111 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Drive Unit
3. Remove the gear [A] and part [B] from the gear box cover [C].
Make sure that the angle of the part [B] is as shown below when attaching the part
[B] to the gear box cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-112 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. Remove the Toner supply motor [B] with its spacer from the gear box cover [A] ( 2).
SM 4-113 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
Replacement
In 100 V models, only one of the AC lines for the fusing unit is shut off when you turn off
the main power; the other line carries current even when you turn off the main power
switch. Thus, not only turn off the main power switch, but also always pull out the AC
power cord from the wall socket before doing replacement.
Because there is a danger of burns on contact with hot parts of the fusing unit, start work
when the temperature drops to a low enough temperature.
To clear SC544-02 or SC554-02, replacing the fusing unit or installing a fuse (provided in
the heating sleeve belt unit) in the fusing unit must be required. Follow the procedure
below to clear SC544-02 or SC554-02.
1. Installing a new fusing unit.
2. Clear SC544-02 or SC554-02 with SP5-810-002
3. Turn off and on the machine.
D197/D198/D199
When the fusing unit is used past its PM cycle, the fusing unit may break, causing a
service call. Therefore, the machine displays a warning on the operation panel at 240K
pages and stops at 260K pages.
D200/D201/D202
When the fusing unit is used past its PM cycle, the fusing unit may break, causing a
service call. Therefore, the machine displays a warning on the operation panel at 320K
pages and stops at 350K pages.
If you replace a whole fusing unit, you do not need to perform SP 3-701. This is because
the machine detects a new unit automatically. If you replace only a part of the fusing unit,
however, such as the pressure roller, you must set the setting of SP3-701 for that part.
1. Open the right cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-114 SM
Fusing Unit
2. Remove the screws on the Fusing unit [A] and disconnect the connectors ( x2,
and Adjustment
x2).
Replacement
Do not pull out the fusing unit now. The fusing unit is still connected to the machine.
When disconnecting the harness, hold the connector as shown below in order to
avoid breaking the connector pins.
SM 4-115 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
Attach the fusing unit connector cover by fitting the space on the connector cover [A]
(surrounded by red dashes in the diagram) and the frame of the fusing unit [B]
together when installing.
The connector cover must be attached before screwing in the fusing unit.
4. Connector [A] ( x1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-116 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
When installing the fusing unit, attach the rear screw first, then attach the front screw.
Replacement
4.13.2 FUSING ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE
1. Fusing unit (page 4-114)
2. Fusing entrance guide plate [A] ( x3)
SM 4-117 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
Wipe clean with a dry cloth. Then wipe clean with a cloth dampened with alcohol.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-118 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Fusing unit (page 4-114)
2. Release the two harnesses [A].
You must route the harnesses for the pressure roller temperature sensor and the
fusing roller temperature sensor correctly when reassembling the fusing unit. See the
notes when reassembling the fusing unit. (Notes When Reassembling the Fusing
Unit)
SM 4-119 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
The earth plate [A] is uncovered after the fusing lower cover removal. Be careful not
to damage it.
You must route the harnesses for the pressure roller temperature sensor and the fusing
roller temperature sensor correctly when reassembling the fusing unit. See the notes
when reassembling the fusing unit. (Notes When Reassembling the Fusing Unit)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-120 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
Set the setting of SP3-701-116 to 1 and turn the main power OFF before replacing.
If you have to turn the power on again before replacing the part, execute the SP again
before replacing the part.
After replacing the unit, turn the main power ON.
To clear SC544-02 or SC554-02, replacing the fusing unit or installing a fuse (provided in
the heating sleeve belt unit) in the fusing unit must be required.
When clearing SC544-02 or SC554-02 by installing a fuse (provided in the heating sleeve
belt unit) in the fusing unit, follow the procedure below for replacing the heating sleeve
belt unit.
1. Installing a new fusing unit.
2. Clear SC544-02 or SC554-02 with SP5-810-002
3. Turn off and on the machine.
When replacing the heating sleeve belt unit at EM replacement, installing a fuse is not
necessary. Do not use the fuse for EM replacement.
The new unit detection fuse packed with the heating sleeve belt unit is used to cancel
SC544-02/554-02. Discard the fuse if these SCs did not occur.
SM 4-121 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
Replacement
1. Fusing upper cover (page 4-119)
2. Fusing lower cover (page 4-120)
3. Two pressure springs ( x2)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-122 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
To Clear SC544-02 or SC554-02
To clear SC544-02 or SC554-02, attach the new unit detection fuse provided with the
heating sleeve belt unit or replace the fusing unit.
1. Prepare a new fuse provided with the heating sleeve belt unit.
SM 4-123 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
Replacement
1. Heating sleeve belt unit (page 4-121)
2. Pressure roller gear [A] (C-ring x1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-124 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. Pressure roller front bearing [A] (C-ring x1)
SM 4-125 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-126 SM
Fusing Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Fusing unit (page 4-114)
2. Fusing thermopile unit [A] ( x2)
SM 4-127 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fusing Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-128 SM
Paper Exit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.14.1 PAPER EXIT UNIT
1. Open the right cover.
2. Fusing unit (page 4-114)
3. Paper exit cover (page 4-23)
4. Inner cover [A] ( 2)
SM 4-129 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Exit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-130 SM
Paper Exit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Paper exit unit (page 4-129)
2. Feeler [A]
SM 4-131 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Exit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-132 SM
Paper Exit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Paper exit unit (page 4-129)
2. Paper exit full sensor with bracket [A] ( 1, 1)
SM 4-133 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Exit
4. Bearings[A] ( 1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-134 SM
Paper Exit
and Adjustment
Replacement
6. Reverse motor [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 4-135 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
The 1st paper feed unit can be removed without removing the duplex unit (just open the
right cover), and you can remove the paper feed unit after pulling out the paper tray.
Note that the 1st paper feed unit and 2nd paper feed unit are not interchangeable.
4. Pull out the 1st paper feed unit [A] slightly toward the front, and then take off the paper
feed guide plate [B].
Release the rear side of the shaft first to remove the paper feed guide plate.
The following picture shows the rear side shape of the shaft.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-136 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. 1st paper feed unit [A] ( x1)
Depending on the model, remove the right lower cover or open the paper transport
cover.
3. Bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 4-137 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
The harness guide has a claw, so make sure that you do not break it when removing.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-138 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.15.2 PAPER DUST COLLECTION UNIT
1. Open the right cover.
2. Screw on the paper dust collection unit [A] ( 1)
3. Release the tab on the paper dust collection unit [A] ( 1).
SM 4-139 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
4. While slightly opening and holding the transfer unit [A] with your hand, remove the
paper dust collection unit [B] in the order shown in the picture below ( 1).
The right side of the paper dust collection unit has a C-shaped cutout. Do not pull the
unit by force during removal. When installing, open the transfer unit [A] to prevent the
sheet [B] from breaking.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-140 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
ROLLER, TORQUE LIMITER
1. Roller holder [A] ( 1)
SM 4-141 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-142 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. HVPS (page 4-174)
2. 1st paper feed tray lift motor [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 4-143 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
There is no difference in removal procedure between 1st paper feed sensor and 2nd
paper feed sensor.
1. Paper feed unit (page 4-136)
2. Paper feed sensor bracket [A] ( 1, 1)
Make sure that the end of the spring on the sensor unit is in the hole.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-144 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.15.6 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR
1. Paper feed unit (page 4-136)
2. Vertical transport sensor unit [A] ( 1, 1)
SM 4-145 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
There are two limit sensors in this model but the removal procedure is the same.
1. Paper feed unit (page 4-136)
2. Limit sensor [A] ( 1)
There is no difference in removal procedure between 1st paper end sensor and 2nd
paper end sensor.
1. Paper feed unit (page 4-136)
2. Feeler [A] ( 1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-146 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. After reinstalling the paper end sensor, check the operation of the actuator [A].
SM 4-147 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Feed
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-148 SM
Duplex Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.16.1 DUPLEX/BY-PASS MOTOR
1. Right Cover (page 4-20)
2. Duplex inner cover [A] ( 4)
SM 4-149 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Duplex Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-150 SM
Duplex Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Right Cover (page 4-20)
2. Screws and stoppers for the paper transfer guide plate [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 4-151 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Duplex Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-152 SM
Duplex Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Open the right cover.
2. Duplex exit sensor bracket [A] ( 1, 1)
SM 4-153 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bypass Tray Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-154 SM
Bypass Tray Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
5. Paper transport guide [A] ( 2)
6. Harness ( 1, 1, 1)
SM 4-155 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bypass Tray Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-156 SM
Bypass Tray Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.17.3 BYPASS PICK-UP ROLLER
1. Open the bypass tray (page 4-154).
2. Bypass pick-up roller [A] ( 1)
SM 4-157 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bypass Tray Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-158 SM
Bypass Tray Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Bypass tray (page 4-154)
2. Six screws on the bypass tray [A] ( 6).
There is a hook in the tray cover. Be careful not to damage it during removal or
installation.
SM 4-159 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Bypass Tray Unit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-160 SM
Bypass Tray Unit
and Adjustment
When installing, the holes must align as shown below.
Replacement
4.17.8 BYPASS LENGTH SENSOR
1. Bypass tray upper cover (page 4-159).
2. Bypass length sensor [A] ( 1, hooks)
SM 4-161 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.1 OVERVIEW
[A] IPU
[C] HDD
[D] BCU
[E] HVPS
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-162 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
Replacement
[A] PSU
SM 4-163 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.2 IPU
The FFC connector has a lock mechanism. Do not use force to pull it out.
1. Controller rear cover (page 4-15)
2. IPU Sub if SPDF is installed.
3. IPU [A] ( 4, 9, 1, USB1)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-164 SM
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.3 BCU
and Adjustment
Replacement
The FFC connector has a lock mechanism. Do not use force to pull it out.
1. Rear lower cover (page 4-17)
2. BCU [A] ( 8, ALL, FFC1)
Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before
you replace the NVRAM (EEPROM).
Keep NVRAMs (EEPROM) away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static
electricity can damage NVRAM data.
Make sure the serial number is input in the machine for the NVRAM data with
SP5-811-004, if not, SC995-001 occurs
SM 4-165 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
Install a new NVRAM [C] so that the indentation [B] on the NVRAM corresponds with
the mark [A] on the BCU. Incorrect installation of the NVRAM will damage both the
BCU and NVRAM.
When the power is turned ON, SC195-00 appears, but continue with the following
steps.
9. Select the destination setting. (SP5-131-001) (JPN: 0, NA: 1, EU/AA/TWN/CHN: 2)
10. Check the machine serial number with SP5-811-004, and then set the machine serial
number of SP5-811-001.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-166 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
For information on how to configure SP5-811-001, contact the supervisor in your
Replacement
branch office.
11. Set the area selection with SP5-807-001.
After changing the EEPROM, Some SPs do not have appropriate initial values.
Because of this, steps 10 to 12 must be done.
14. Turn off the machine, and then turn it back on.
15. From the SD card where you saved the NV-RAM data in step 5, download the NV-RAM
data with SP5-824-002.
16. Turn off the machine, and then remove the SD card from SD slot 2.
17. Turn on the main switch.
18. Check the factory setting sheet and the SMC data printout from step 2, and set the user
tool and SP settings so they are the same as before.
Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can
damage NVRAM data.
Special Procedure for Machines that have a Self Encrypting Drive (SED) Installed
The machine holds data, linking the controller board and SED, created automatically
during SED installation. The data, however, will not be deleted automatically at controller
board replacement. Therefore, before replacing a controller board, you must delete the
link data manually so that the machine can create new link data.
Do the following steps when doing the replacement.
1. Execute [Erase All Memory] on the operation panel
[System Settings] [Administrator Tools] [Erase All Memory]
2. Turn OFF the main power switch
3. Replace the controller board
4. Turn ON the main power switch
Do not turn the main power ON after step 2, until after you replaced the board.
1. Controller rear cover (page 4-15)
2. HDD bracket (page 4-173)
SM 4-167 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
4. Controller board ( 4)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-168 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
Replacement
6. Remove the NVRAM on the controller board.
When installing a new controller board, Install a removed or a new NVRAM [C] so
that the indentation [B] on the NVRAM corresponds with the mark [A] on the
controller board. Incorrect installation of the NVRAM will damage both the controller
board and NVRAM.
SM 4-169 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
Referring to the previous procedure, be sure that there are no mistakes in the mounting
position and orientation of the NVRAM.
SC195 (Machine serial number error) will be displayed if you forget to attach the NVRAM.
If you mounted the NVRAM in the wrong direction, each component needs to be replaced
because a short circuit was caused in the controller board and the NVRAM.
1. Make sure you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the
machine.
2. Output all the SMC data using SP5-990-001 (SP Print Mode: All (Data List)).
3. Turn off the main power switch.
4. Insert a blank SD card in the SD slot 2, and then turn on the main power switch.
5. Use SP5-824-001 to upload the NVRAM data from the controller board.
6. Make sure the customer has a backup of their address book data. If not, obtain the
backup by referring to the following procedure.
1. Insert an SD card into SD slot 2, and then turn the main power ON.
2. Save the address book data in the SD card using SP5-846-051.
The address data stored in the machine will be discarded later during this procedure.
So be sure to obtain a backup of the customers address book data.
Note that the counters for the user will be reset when doing the backup/restore of the
address book data.
If they have a backup of the address book data, use their own backup data for
restoring. This is because there is a risk that the data cannot be backed up properly
depending on the NVRAM condition.
7. Do the following steps if the machine has the fax unit. If not, skip this step.
1. Print the Box List by with the User Tools/Counter.
[User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [General Settings] - [Box Setting: Print
List]
2. Print the Special Sender List by pressing these buttons in the following order.
[User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception Settings] - [Program Special
Sender: Print List]
3. Write down the following fax settings.
[Receiver] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception Settings] -
[Reception File Settings] - [Forwarding].
[Notify Destination] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception
Settings] - [Reception File Settings] - [Store].
[Specify User] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception Settings] -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-170 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
[Notify Destination] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception
Replacement
Settings] - [Folder Transfer Result Report].
Specified folder in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Send Settings] -
[Backup File TX Setting].
[Receiver] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception Settings] -
[Reception File Settings] - [Output Mode Switch Timer].
[Store: Notify Destination] in [User Tools/Counter] - [Facsimile Features] - [Reception
Settings] - [Output Mode Switch Timer].
All the destination information shown on the display.
In the fax settings, address book data is stored with entry IDs, which the system
internally assigns to each data. The entry IDs may be changed due to
re-assigning in backup/restore operations.
4. Make sure that there is no transmission standby file. If any standby file exists, ask the
customer to delete it or complete the transmission.
8. Turn the main power OFF and unplug the power supply cord.
9. Push the main power switch ON again to discharge the residual charge.
10. Replace the NV-RAM with a brand-new one.
11. Turn the power ON.
After turning the power ON, SC995 will be displayed except for machines that have a
smart operation panel.
For machines that have a smart operation panel, SC673 will occur and SC995 might
be internally issued after turning the power ON.
After turning the power ON, SC870 will occur and the address book data will be
cleared.
<Additional procedure only for machines that have the Smart Operation Panel
installed>
SC673 will be displayed at start-up, but this is normal behavior. This is because the
controller and the smart operation panel cannot communicate with each other due to
changing the SP settings for the operation panel.
1. Change the SP settings for the operation panel.
SP5-748-101: (OpePanel Setting: Op Type Action Setting): Change bit 0 from 0 to
1.
SP5-748-201: (OpePanel Setting: Cheetah Panel Connect Setting): Change the
value from 0 to 1.
SM 4-171 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
SP5-825-001 does not download the following SP data to the new NV-RAM. So you
must set them manually.
a. SP5-985-001 (Device Setting: On Board NIC)
b. SP5-985-002 (Device Setting: On Board USB)
17. If the security functions (HDD Encryption and HDD Data Overwrite Security) were
applied, set the functions again.
18. Ask the customer to restore their address book. Or restore the address book data
using SP5-846-052 (UCS Setting: Restore All Addr Book), and ask the customer to
ensure the address book data has been restored properly.
If you have obtained the backup of the customers address book data, delete the
backup immediately after the NV-RAM replacement to avoid accidentally taking out
the customers data.
19. Output all the SMC data with SP5-990-001 and make sure all the SP/UP settings except
for counter information are properly restored, by checking the SMC data obtained.
If a message tells you need an SD card to restore displays after the NV-RAM
replacement, create a SD card for restoration and restore with the SD card.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-172 SM
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.5 HDD
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the HDD, copy the address book data to an SD card with SP5-846-051 if
possible.
If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security, the Data Encryption feature or OCR
Scanned PDF, these applications must be installed again.
1. Controller rear cover (page 4-15)
2. HDD with bracket [A] ( 3, 2)
3. HDD [A] ( 4, 2)
SM 4-173 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.6 HVPS
1. Rear lower cover (page 4-17)
2. HVPS [A] ( 4, 5)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-174 SM
PCBs and Other Items
4.18.7 PSU
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Left cover (page 4-14)
2. Bracket [A] ( 8)
SM 4-175 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-176 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Upper inner cover (page 4-25)
2. Rear left cover (page 4-16)
3. Left cover (page 4-14)
4. Rear right cover (page 4-16)
5. Rear lower cover (page 4-17)
6. Release the clamps on the upper side of the controller box ( 8).
SM 4-177 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
PCBs and Other Items
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-178 SM
PCBs and Other Items
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.18.10 TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Open the transfer unit (page 4-99).
2. Fusing unit (page 4-114).
3. Temperature sensor ( 1, 2, 1).
SM 4-179 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fans/Filters
4.19 FANS/FILTERS
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-180 SM
Fans/Filters
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. PCDU (page 4-72)
2. Mount the dust filter on the duct.[A]
Attach the right side of the filter first when you mount it.
SM 4-181 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fans/Filters
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-182 SM
Fans/Filters
and Adjustment
Replacement
Pay attention to the direction of the fan when installing. The decal pasted on the fan must
face the outside.
Pay attention to the direction of the fan when installing. The decal pasted on the fan
must face the inside.
SM 4-183 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fans/Filters
Pay attention to the direction of the fan when installing. The decal pasted on the fan must
face the outside.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-184 SM
Fans/Filters
and Adjustment
ONLY)
Replacement
1. Rear lower cover (page 4-17)
2. Development bearing cooling fan with duct [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 4-185 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Fans/Filters
Pay attention to the direction of the fan when installing. The decal pasted on the fan must
face the outside.
Pay attention to the direction of the fan when installing. The decal pasted on the fan
must face the inside.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-186 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.20.1 PRINTING
Make sure the paper is installed correctly in each paper tray before you start these
adjustments.
Use the Trimming Area Pattern (SP2-109-003, No.14) to print the test pattern for the
following procedures.
Set the setting of SP 2-109-003 to 0 again after completing these printing adjustments.
SM 4-187 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-188 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
Tray1: Thick1: SP1-001-031
1200
SM 4-189 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-190 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
2. Check the side-to-side registration [B] for each paper feed station, and adjust them
and Adjustment
using SP1-002.
Replacement
Tray SP No. Threshold
Tray 2 SP1-002-003
Tray 3 (Optional
SP1-002-004
PFU tray 1 or LCT)
Tray 4 (Optional
SP1-002-005
PFU tray 2)
LCT SP1-002-007
Blank Margin
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-192 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
Lead Edge Width:Thin SP2-103-019
0.0 9.9 mm
Trail. Edge Width:Thin SP2-103-020
If the laser unit causes a parallelogram image, there is a slanted line in the
main-scan direction, and there is a straight line in the sub-scan direction.
3. Remove the laser unit (page 4-66).
4. Paste the adjustment sheet(s) on the reference points located on the back side of the
laser unit (two points on the inside and/or one point on the front side).
A set of four sheets is provided as service parts. The number of sheets to be pasted
depends on the condition of the image.
If lines slant down to the left [A], paste one or two sheets on the front side.
If lines slant down to the right [B], paste one or two sheets at each position on
the rear side.
Adjustable amount: 0.5mm 0.6mm/sheet
SM 4-193 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-194 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
4.20.2 SCANNING
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before doing the following scanner adjustments, perform or check the printing registration
/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment.
Use an S5S test chart to perform the following adjustments.
SM 4-195 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
Magnification
A: Sub-scan magnification
1. Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed
stations.
2. Check the magnification ratio and adjust using the following SP mode if necessary.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-196 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
See the Adjusting the Scanner Wire. (page 4-46)
Registration
SM 4-197 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-198 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
After clearing the memory, or if the touch panel detection function is not working correctly, follow
this procedure to calibrate the touch screen.
Do not attempt to use items [2] to [5] and [7] to [9] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These
items are for design use only.
1. Plug in the AC power cord, and then turn on the main power switch.
2. When Home or Copy screen appears, press the [Energy Saver] key.
3. Press [1], [9], [9], and [3] at the ten-key pad, and then press [C] (Clear) 5 times to open
the Self Diagnostics Menu.
4. Press [[1] Touch Screen Adjust] (or press [1] on the ten-key pad).
5. Use a pointed (not sharp!) tool to press the mark (+) at the upper left of the screen.
6. Press in order the lower right, lower left, middle, and upper right of the screen (+).
7. Press [[#] OK] on the screen (or press [#] on the ten-key pad) to save.
SM 4-199 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Adjustment after Replacement
9. Press the points (upper left, lower left, upper right and lower right) and confirm that
each value is within 5 dots.
10. Press [[#] Exit] on the screen (or press [#] on the ten-key pad) to close the Self
Diagnostic Menu.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 4-200 SM
Adjustment after Replacement
and Adjustment
Replacement
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SM 4-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Service Program Mode
5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Maintenance
System
5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE
Make sure that the data-in LED ( ) is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED
indicates that some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the
copier to process the data.
The Service Program Mode is for use by service representatives only. If this mode is
used by anyone other than service representatives for any reason, data might be deleted
or settings might be changed. In such case, product quality cannot be guaranteed any
more.
Entering SP Mode
For details, ask your supervisor.
Exiting SP Mode
Press "Exit" on the LCD twice to return to the copy window.
SM 5-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Service Program Mode
2 Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.
Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP
3
Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen,
Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then
4 press [#]. The required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing [#]. If
not, just press the required SP Mode number.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-2 SM
Service Program Mode
Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume
5
Maintenance
normal operation.
System
6 Press any Class 1 number to open a list of Class 2 SP modes.
Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen
8
display (page).
9 Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).
10 Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.
SM 5-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Service Program Mode
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-4 SM
Service Program Mode
Maintenance
System
Turn the machine power switch off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed
servicing the machine.
The Administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON.
SM 5-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Service Program Mode
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-6 SM
Service Program Mode
5.1.3 REMARKS
Maintenance
System
The maximum number of characters which can show on the control panel screen is limited to 30
characters. For this reason, some of the SP modes shown on the screen need to be abbreviated.
The following are abbreviations used for the SP modes for which the full description is over 20
characters.
Item Description
N: Normal paper
Paper Type MTH: Middle thick paper
TH: Thick paper
P: Paper tray
Paper Feed Station
B: By-pass table
S: Simplex
Print Mode
D: Duplex
SM 5-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Service Program Mode
Others
The settings of each SP mode are explained in the right-hand column of the SP table in the
following way.
[Adjustable range / Default setting / Step] Alphanumeric
If "Alphanumeric" is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the
SP mode shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers.
However, the settings in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the
numbers.
ENG Engine SP
CTL Controller SP
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-8 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
System
5.2.1 SP1-XXX (FEED)
SM 5-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-10 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
1-001-039 Tray2: Thick 2:1200 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
System
1-001-040 Tray2: Thick 3:1200 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
SM 5-11 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-12 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
1-001-073 Tray4: Thick 2 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
System
1-001-074 Tray4: Thick 3 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Tray5(LCT):
1-001-092 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Mid-thick:1200
SM 5-13 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Tray5(LCT): Thick
1-001-093 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
1:1200
Tray5(LCT): Thick
1-001-094 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
2:1200
Tray5(LCT): Thick
1-001-095 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
3:1200
Tray5(LCT): Thick
1-001-096 ENG [-9.0 to 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
4:1200
[Side-to-Side Registration]
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start
1002 position for each mode and tray.
Increasing a value: an image is moved to the rear edge of paper.
Decreasing a value: an image is moved to the front edge of paper.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-14 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
[Paper Buckle]
System
1003 Adjusts the amount of paper buckle at the registration roller by changing
the paper feed timing.
(A "+" setting causes more buckling.)
Tray 2/3/4/5/LCT:
1-003-007 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Mid-thick
Paper Tray 1:
1-003-019 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Mid-thick:1200
Paper Tray1:
1-003-020 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / -2.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Thick1:1200
SM 5-15 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Tray2/3/4/5/LCT:
1-003-021 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Thin:1200
Tray2/3/4/5/LCT:
1-003-022 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Plain:1200
Tray2/3/4/5/LCT:
1-003-023 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Mid:1200
Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Thick
1-003-024 ENG [-4.0 to 5.0 / -2.0 / 0.1mm/step]
1:1200
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-16 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
1007 [By-Pass Size Detection]
System
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Switch LT SEF/LG SEF *ENG 0: 0.5x11SEF
1-007-001 1: 8.5x14SEF
Selects either LT SEF or LG SEF to detect 8.5 inches paper size when
using the bypass tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
By-Pass Jam Detection
*ENG 0: Normal
Set
1: Simple Detect
Selects the paper jam detection when receiving long length FAX. Enter
1-007-002 the maximum value for the custom paper size if 1: Simple Detection is to
be activated.
0: Normal: Paper jam is detected when paper size fed from the tray is
different form selected paper size.
1: Simple Detect: Paper jam is detected only when paper size fed from the
tray is longer than selected paper size.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Registration Gear
1-009-001 *ENG 0:OFF
Backlash Cut
1:ON
SM 5-17 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
1009 usual, and this may cause banding on the sheet that is fed first.
If you set this SP to ON, the pick-up solenoid is energized after the
paper tray is loaded and the bottom plate rises. By making this setting,
you can prevent the banding caused by the vibration of the solenoid when
feeding the first sheet.
As the default, it is set to OFF to minimize the noise.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Control ON/OFF
1-009-002 *ENG 0:OFF
0:OFF/1:ON
1:ON
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-18 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
1105 [Print Target Temp.]
System
[100 to 180 / * / 1deg/step]
* The default is different with
models.
Plain1:BW:Center *ENG
D197/D198: 123
D199/D200: 130
1-105-003 D201/D202: 147
SM 5-19 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-20 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
System
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
Special1:BW:Center:Middle
*ENG [100 to 180 / 140 / 1deg/step]
Speed
Special2:BW:Center:Middle
*ENG [100 to 180 / 145 / 1deg/step]
Speed
SM 5-21 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Special3:BW:Center:Middle
*ENG [100 to 180 / 150 / 1deg/step]
Speed
Plain1:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 110 / 1deg/step]
Speed
1-105-103 Paper through target temperature: Standard 1: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
Plain2:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 110 / 1deg/step]
Speed
1-105-107 Paper through target temperature: Standard 2: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
M-thick:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 115 / 1deg/step]
Speed
Paper through target temperature: middle thick paper: BW: center: low
1-105-111 speed
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-22 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
Thick1:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 120 / 1deg/step]
System
Speed
1-105-115 Paper through target temperature: Thick paper 1: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
Special1:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 110 / 1deg/step]
Speed
1-105-119 Paper through target temperature: special paper 1: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
Special2:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 180 / 120 / 1deg/step]
Speed
1-105-123 Paper through target temperature: special paper 2: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
SM 5-23 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Paper through target temperature: thin paper: BW: center: low speed
1-105-137 Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-24 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
Postcard:Center *ENG [100 to 180 / 118 / 1deg/step]
System
Paper through target temperature post card: center
1-105-143 Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Special3:BW:Center:Middle
*ENG [100 to 180 / 130 / 1deg/step]
Speed
1-105-147 Paper through target temperature: special paper 1: BW: center: low speed
Fusing malfunction might improve by setting value larger.
Paper curl might improve by setting value smaller.
Adjusting range is +/- 5 deg. celsius.
SM 5-25 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Temp.:Plain:Center:Energy
*ENG [-30 to 20 / * / 1deg/step]
1-112-002 Saving
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF
Execute Pattern *ENG
1: ON(No Decurl)
1-113-001 2: ON
[0 to 200 / * / 1/step]
* The default is different with
Correction Formula
1-116-002 *ENG models.
Judge Temp
D197: 102
D198/D199/D200/D201/D202: 97
[0 to 500 / * / 1 sec/step]
* The default is different with
Time Out:Energy models.
1-116-012 *ENG
Saving D197/D198/D199/D200
(NA/TWN)/D201/ D202: 3
D200 (EU/AS/ CHN/KOR): 15
Delay:Middle
1-116-024 *ENG [0 to 20000 / 1320 / 1msec/step]
Speed:BW:1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-26 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Delay:Middle
1-116-034 *ENG [0 to 20000 / 1320 / 1msec/step]
Maintenance
Speed:BW:2
System
1-116-036 Delay:Low Speed:BW:2 *ENG [0 to 20000 / 2640 / 1msec/step]
Press Reference
1-116-044 *ENG [0 to 200 / 75 / 1 deg /step]
Temp.:Energy Saving
Paper Thickness
1-116-053 *ENG [-100 to 100 / -50 / 1/step]
Coefficient:Thin
Paper Thickness
1-116-054 *ENG [-100 to 100 / 0 / 1/step]
Coefficient:M-thick
Paper Thickness
1-116-073 *ENG [-100 to 100 / 0 / 1/step]
Coefficient:Low Speed
Displays the voltage of the connected power source applied to turn the
heater on.
SM 5-27 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Inrush Control *ENG 0: Normal (Default)
1: Inrush Control mode
If the heater's surge current flows into the UPS or power circuit breaker,
1-135-001 the power may be cut. Is you set this to "1", the heater's surge current on
startup is controlled, allowing continual use even if the current flows into
the UPS or power circuit breaker.
However, setting this to ON will extend the initialization time by
approximately one second.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-28 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
Htg Roller:Ctr Det2 *ENG [-5 to 300 / 0 / 1deg/step]
System
1-141-151 Display detailed conditions when an SC occurs. Displayed content is
SM 5-29 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
SC Display *ENG 0: OFF
1-142-001 1: ON
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Std Speed
1-153-003 Operation Line Speed ENG
1: Mid Speed
2: Low Speed
1-153-006 Heat End Target Temp ENG [100 to 180 / 130 / 1deg/step]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-30 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
Maintenance
[Switch:Rotation Start/Stop] DFU
System
1154
For design use. Do not change.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
1-154-001 Judging Method Change *ENG 0: ON
1: OFF
[0 to 250 / * / 1deg/step]
* The default is different with
models.
D197: 185
Overshoot Prevent
1-154-006 *ENG D198: 185
Temp.:SC
D199: 185
D200: 195
D201: 200
D202: 200
Adjusts waiting time till fix a size from size detector's output when paper is
1-907-029 set with standard bypass or one action bypass function is OFF. Will have
more time till start button to turn green when setting waiting time longer,
but time for setting paper will also be loner. Side effect might occur such
as paper feed starts before finish setting paper if waiting time is set shot.
SM 5-31 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP1000
[0 to 1/ 0 / 1/step ]
Front Development *ENG 0: Off (Stop)
1-955-021 1: On (Rotation)
[0 to 1/ 0 / 1 /step]
Toner Bottle *ENG 0: Off (Stop)
1-955-022 1: On (Rotation)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-32 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Maintenance
System
5.3.1 SP2-XXX (DRUM)
[LSU Adjustment]
2-103-001 Adjusts trimming margine at the leading edge for the sub scan.
Value increase: Trim becomes wider.
Value decrease: Trim becomes narrower.
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge for the sub scan.
SM 5-33 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
2103 Sets trimming margine for the second side of the paper.
Value increase: Trim becomes wider.
Value decrease: Trim becomes narrower.
2-103-006 Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
2-103-007 Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
2-103-008 Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-34 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Maintenance
Duplex Left Edge ENG [0.0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm/step]
System
2-103-009
Adjusts trimming margine at the left edge on the 2nd side for main scan.
Duplex Trail. L
ENG [-4.0 to 4.0 / 1.0 / 0.1mm/step]
Size:Thick
2-103-011
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
when using large thick size paper.
Duplex Trail. M
ENG [-4.0 to 4.0 / 0.8 / 0.1mm/step]
Size:Thick
2-103-012
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
when using middle thick size paper.
Duplex Trail. S
ENG [-4.0 to 4.0 / 0.6 / 0.1mm/step]
Size:Thick
2-103-013
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
when using small thick size paper.
2-103-014 Adjusts trimming margine at the left edge on the 2nd side for main scan
Duplex Right
ENG [0.0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1mm/step]
Edge:Thick
2-103-015
Adjusts trimming margine at the right edge on the 2nd side for main scan
when using thick paper.
2-103-016 Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
SM 5-35 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Duplex Trail. M
ENG [-4.0 to 4.0 / 0.8 / 0.1mm/step]
Size:Thin
2-103-017
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
when using middle thin paper.
Duplex Trail. S
ENG [-4.0 to 4.0 / 0.6 / 0.1mm/step]
Size:Thin
2-103-018
Adjusts trimming margine at the trailing edge on the 2nd side for sub scan
when using small thin paper.
2-103-019 Adjusts trimming margin at the left edge on the 2nd side for main scan
2-103-020 Adjusts trimming margin at the right edge on the 2nd side for main scan
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-36 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Maintenance
2109 [Test Pattern]
System
Pattern Selection ENG [0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step]
Select patterns.
SM 5-37 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
2-110-005 Execution flag to download the adjustment values of the laser unit to the
machine.
Executes when replacing the laser unit or assembling main machine.
2-115-001 Sets gamma correction value of valid pixel for the edge process in the low
CPP condition.
Value increase: Density becomes darker.
Value decrease: Density becomes lighter.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-38 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Maintenance
[Vertical Line Width] DFU
System
2160
For design use. Do not change.
If the transfer roller remains in contact with the OPC drum for a long time,
2-400-002 the deformation of the transfer roller occurs, causing black streaks. To
2970 Enables or disables the interruption cleaning for the transfer roller during
the multiple outputs.
Low-temperature, [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / -]
2-970-004 ENG
low-humidity 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Moderate temperature [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / -]
2-970-005 ENG
and humidity 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
High-temperature and [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / -]
2-970-006 ENG
high-humidity 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
SM 5-39 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
2-990-004 Control: MM
Sets the threshold for the CPM down in MM condition when the imaging
duty is not restricted.
Sets the threshold for the CPM down when the imaging duty is restricted.
Down-time_BW: Duty
*ENG [0 to 240000 / 25000 / 10msec/step]
Control
2-990-008
Sets the down-time for the BW mode printing when the imaging duty is
restricted.
Execution Temp.
*ENG [20 to 70 / 45.5 / 0.1deg/step]
2-990-011 Threshold
2-990-101 Control: LL
Sets the threshold for the CPM down in LL condition when the imaging
duty is not restricted.
2-990-102 Control: ML
Sets the threshold for the CPM down in ML condition when the imaging
duty is not restricted.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-40 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP2000
Maintenance
Forced CPM Down
System
Thresh: No Duty *ENG [0 to 5000 / 0 / 1page/step]
2-990-103 Control: HH
Sets the threshold for the CPM down in HH condition when imaging duty
is not restricted.
SM 5-41 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[ProCon OK?]
3012
Displays the result of the process control for each SP number.
3-012-003 Displays the result before the last 2 result of the process control
execution.
3-012-004 Displays the result before the last 3 result of the process control
execution.
3-012-005 Displays the result before the last 4 result of the process control
execution.
3-012-006 Displays the result before the last 5 result of the process control
execution.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-42 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Displays the result before the last 6 result of the process control
Maintenance
execution.
System
History:Last 8 *ENG [0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]
3-012-008 Displays the result before the last 7 result of the process control
execution.
3-012-009 Displays the result before the last 8 result of the process control
execution.
3-012-010 Displays the result before the last 9 result of the process control
execution.
10 or more
11 Succeed -
Result (Normal)
SM 5-43 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
DFU
3-030-081 Init Rel Hum: K *ENG [0 to 100.0 / 50.0 / 0.1%RH/step]
For design use. Do not change.
DFU
[0 to 100.00 / 10.30 / 0.01g/m 3
3-030-091 Init Abs Hum: K *ENG
/step]
For design use. Do not change.
DFU
3-030-101 Init Coverage: K DFU *ENG [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1%/ step]
For design use. Do not change.
DFU
3-030-111 Total DC: Dev: K *ENG [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1%/step]
For design use. Do not change.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-44 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
3031 [TD Sens Init OK?]
System
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No execution
1: Success
K ENG
3-031-001 2: No developer error
3: Out of target range
9: Forced termination
3-050-021 Sets the supply quantity (K) for the forced toner supply by [wt%] step.
[T Sensor: Check]
3072 Executes testing mode to test TD sensor's output (Vt) without starting up
the engine.
SM 5-45 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
ON/OFF *ENG 0: Enable
3-100-001 1: Disable
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0:Page & Vt
TE Detection *ENG
3-100-003 1:Vt Only
2:Page Counter Only
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
2: Full
3-101-001 K *ENG
1: Near end
0: Toner end
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-46 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
3133 [TE Detect :Set]
System
Set Sheets *ENG [0 to 5000 / 90 / 1sheet/step]
3-133-001 Sets the number of sheets to display toner end after toner near end is
detected.
[TnrDensity]
3200
Displays toner density (wt%).
[TnrDensity] DFU
3201
For design use. Do not change.
[TDSensSensitivity] DFU
3205
For design use. Do not change.
SM 5-47 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[TD.Sens:Vt :Disp]
3210
Displays latest T sensor output.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
3-212-101 TC Cor.(ON/OFF) *ENG 0:OFF
1:ON
3-230-001 Displays / Sets current target value of TD sensor's output voltage: Vtref
(K).
[ImgArea :Disp]
3250
Displays image area (K) for the latest page.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-48 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[AccumImgArea :Disp]
System
3252
Displays accumulated image area (K).
[ID.Sens :Voffset]
3310 Displays the regular reflection output of ID sensor when the LED of the ID
sensor is off.
Normal condition: Approximately 0.1V or less.
3-310-021 Displays the regular reflection output of ID sensor when the LED of the ID
sensor is off.
Normal condition: Approximately 0.1V or less.
SM 5-49 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[Adjusted Vsg]
3321 Displays regular reflection output of the bare ITB area at the Vsg
adjustment.
Normal condition: 3.5 to 4.5V
[Adjusted Ifsg]
Displays the LED current of the ID sensor. If it differs greatly from the
3322 value in SP3-322-011, the ID sensor may be stained, the OPC drum may
have deteriorated, the ID sensor may be out of alignment, or there may be
some other problem.
[Adjusted Ifsg]
3322 Displays the minimum LED current of the ID sensor for the Vsg
adjustment.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-50 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[Vsg Adj OK?]
System
Displays Vsg adjustment result (SP assign for compatibility with unification
model sires).
1 Succeed -
SM 5-51 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
3331 This is the coefficient used for adjusting Vsp/Vsg in accordance with the
ID sensor test data. Input this coefficient, supplied with the sensor, to
correct the variation of each sensor.
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
3-400-001 K *ENG 0: Fixed
2: PID
3411 Displays latest value of supply amount calculated from toner supply
amount computation formula.
[DeveloperWeight] DFU
3420
For design use. Do not change.
[TnrSplyAbility] DFU
3421
For design use. Do not change.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-52 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[Tnr Supply Limits :Set] DFU
System
3422
For design use. Do not change.
3440 Sets toner supplying rate for fixed amount supplying mode.
Increasing value: Increases the toner supply rate.
Decreasing value: Decreases the toner supply rate.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
ALL DFU *ENG 0: OFF
3-500-001 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
ProCon *ENG 0: OFF
3-500-002 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Init TD Sensor DFU *ENG 0: OFF
3-500-004 1: ON
SM 5-53 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[ImgQltyAdj :ExeFlag]
3510
Sets the execution flag for the initial toner supply.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
3-510-031 Init Toner Replenish: K *ENG
0: No execution, 1: Execution flag
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
3-529-001 Gamma Corr *ENG 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
3-529-002 Environ Corr *ENG 0: OFF
1: ON
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-54 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[PowerON ProCon :Set] DFU
System
3530
For design use. Do not change.
Relative Humidity
3-530-003 *ENG [0 to 99 / 50 / 1%RH/step]
Range
Absolute Humidity
3-530-004 *ENG [0 to 99 / 6 / 1g/m 3/step]
Range
Relative Humidity
3-531-003 *ENG [0 to 99 / 50 / 1%RH/step]
Range
Absolute Humidity
3-531-004 *ENG [0 to 99 / 6 / 1g/m 3/step]
Range
Maximum Execution
3-531-005 *ENG [0 to 99 / 10 / 1times/step]
Number
SM 5-55 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Sets number of sheets interval for the interrupt process control (BW).
3-533-001 Increasing value: Increases the number of sheets printed for the
interval between executing each interrupt process control.
Decreasing value: Decreases the number of sheets printed for the
interval between executing each interrupt process control.
Sets number of sheets interval for the job end process control (BW).
3-534-001 Increasing value: Increases the number of sheets printed for the
interval between executing each job end process control.
Decreasing value: Decreases the number of sheets printed for the
interval between executing each job end process control.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-56 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[Dev Agitating Time :Set] DFU
System
3539
For design use. Do not change.
Refresh Threshold:
3-550-031 *ENG [0 to 255 / 51 / 1cm^2]
BK:MM
Refresh Threshold:
3-550-101 *ENG [0 to 255 / 51 / 1cm^2]
BK:LL
Refresh Threshold:
3-550-102 *ENG [0 to 255 / 51 / 1cm^2]
BK:ML
Refresh Threshold:
3-550-103 *ENG [0 to 255 / 51 / 1cm^2]
BK:HH
SM 5-57 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
1: Sw Auto
Select Control *ENG
3-551-009 2: Dispose All
3: Recycle All
DFU
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Select Status *ENG 0: Recycle
3-551-010 1: Waste
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
3-600-001 Potential Control *ENG 0: OFF
1: ON
[Chrg DC Control]
3611
Displays the DC bias decided by the process control for the chare unit.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-58 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
[LD Power Control] DFU
System
3613
For design use. Do not change.
3-623-101 Increasing value: Increases the value of upper limit for LD power.
Decreasing value: Decreases the value of upper limit for LD power.
3-623-111 Increasing value: Increases the value of lower limit for LD power.
Decreasing value: Decreases the value of lower limit for LD power.
SM 5-59 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
[Vsdp :Disp]
3631
Displays latest Vsdp value.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
3-700-001 ON/OFF Setting *ENG 1: Enable
0: Disable
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-60 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Maintenance
Set the new unit detection for each unit manually.
System
3701
0: Disables the new unit detection for specified unit.
1: Enables the new unit detection for specified unit.
Bearing:Development
3-701-028 *ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Screw
Pressure Roller
3-701-119 *ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bearings
SM 5-61 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP3000
Threshold : Remainder
*ENG [1 to 255 / 15 / 1 /step]
days
3-800-014 (SP7-951-142) falls below this threshold value, the message appears.
Increasing value: Decreases the number of days before displaying
the message once the machine detects that the waste toner bottle is
nearly full.
Decreasing value: Increases the number of days before displaying
the message once the machine detects that the waste toner bottle is
nearly full.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-62 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
System
5.5.1 SP4-XXX (SCANNER)
Adjusts scanning margins for the leading and trailing edges (sub scan)
and right and left edge (main scan).
4012
Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin
greater than the printer margin. These settings are adjusted to
erase shadows caused by the gap between the original and the
scale of the scanner unit.
SM 5-63 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
4-012-001 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of sub scan leading edge (left side
4-012-002 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of sub scan trailing edge (right
4-012-003 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of main scan leading edge (rear
4-012-004 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of main scan trailing edge (front
4-012-005 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of sub scan leading edge when
4-012-007 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of main scan leading edge when
4-012-008 Sets mask area to erase scale shadow of main scan trailing edge when
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-64 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
4020 [Dust Check]
System
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Dust Detect:On/Off ENG
4-020-001 0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1/step]
Dust Detect:Lvl ENG 0: lowest detection level
4-020-002 8: highest detection level
4-020-003 Sets ON/OFF and switches level of Vertical stripes correction. 0=OFF,
sets level to 1 from 4. The correction for the vertical stripes is stronger as
value increases.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Dust Detect Level:Rear ENG
4-020-011 0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1/step]
Correction Level:Rear ENG 0:Lowest level
Sets DF: Rear (2nd side) dust detection level. As the value enlarges, it is
easier to detect.
SM 5-65 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
1200dpi 1bit edge12 *ENG
0: Off, 1: On
4-201-011
ON/OFF for smaller edge: 1200dpi 1bit
Select ON/OFF for low CPP edge correction with 1200dpi 1bit.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
1200dpi 1bit edge345 *ENG
0: Off, 1: On
4-201-012
ON/OFF for larger edge: 1200dpi 1bit
Select ON/OFF for low CPP edge correction with 1200dpi 1bit.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Operation Check APS
ENG 0: Not detected
4-301-001 Sensor 1: Detected
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-66 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
4303 [Min Size for APS]
System
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
- *ENG 0 : No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise
4-303-001
Sets display when non-standard (small size) size original is
detected.
When 2:EU is selected at SP5-131-001 and 3:8K 16K is
selected at SP4-305-001, 1 of SP4-303-001 will be 1:16K
Vertical.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Normal Detect
- *ENG 1: LT-LEF LT-SEF
2: LT-LEF A4-SEF
3: 8K 16K
paper size according to the region of use when detecting A4/LT size
paper, regardless of whether the paper is loaded in portrait or landscape
orientation.
SM 5-67 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0: OFF
Detection ON/OFF *ENG
1: ON
2: APS
4-308-001
Switch Original size detection ON/OFF.
0: Not detect original size
1: Detect original size by the CCD unit
2: APS is used for detecting original size.
Sets the scanned image density threshold for the scan size detection.
Increasing value: Detects originals with higher brightness. (Detection
4-309-001 error for the non originals decreases, but detection error for the
darker original increases.)
Decreasing value: Detects originals with lower brightness. (Detection
error for the darker originals decreases, but detection error for the
non originals increases.)
4-309-002 Sets the time to end detection after ADF/Platen cover closing.
Increasing value: Detects originals with longer time.
Decreasing value: Detects originals with shorter time.
4-309-003 Sets the time to start LED lamp on after ADF/Platen cover closing.
Increasing value: LED lamp lights later.
Decreasing value: LED lamp lights earlier.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-68 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
Checks the density of scanning data for the scan size detection.
System
4310
The machine detects the original if the value in this SP is greater than that
specified in SP4-309-00x.
4-310-001 Displays the Red density of the image (Rear side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S1: Original width is within 182 mm to 210 mm.
4-310-002 Displays the Green density of the image (Rear side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S1: Original width is within 182 mm to 210 mm.
4-310-003 Displays the Blue density of the image (Rear side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S1: Original width is within 182 mm to 210 mm.
4-310-004 Displays the Red density of the image (Center) previously scanned using
original size detection.
S2: Original width is within 215.9 mm to 254mm.
4-310-005 Displays the Green density of the image (Center) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S2: Original width is within 215.9 mm to 254mm.
4-310-006 Displays the Blue density of the image (Center) previously scanned using
original size detection.
S2: Original width is within 215.9 mm to 254mm.
SM 5-69 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
4-310-007 Displays the Red density of the image (Front side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S3: Original width is within 257 mm to 279.4 mm.
4-310-008 Displays the Green density of the image (Front side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S3: Original width is within 257 mm to 279.4 mm.
4-310-009 Displays the Blue density of the image (Front side) previously scanned
using original size detection.
S3: Original width is within 257 mm to 279.4 mm.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Switch On/Off ENG 0: Every time shading
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Switch On/Off ENG 0: Every time shading
4-351-001 1: Interval shading
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-70 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
[Org Edge Mask]
System
Compared with SP4-012 (Set Scale Mask), which is used to adjust the
4400 scanning margin regardless of the original paper size, this SP can be
used to adjust the scanning margin according to the original paper size.
(This SP can be used to adjust the trim margin from the original paper
edge.)
4-400-001 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of sub scan leading edge (left
4-400-002 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of sub scan trailing edge (right
4-400-003 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of main scan leading edge (rear
4-400-004 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of main scan trailing edge (front
4-400-005 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of sub scan leading edge when
4-400-007 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of main scan leading edge when
4-400-008 Sets mask area to erase original shadow of main scan trailing edge when
SM 5-71 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
[0 to 8 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Scanned image
1: Gradation main A
2: Patch 16C
3: Grid pattern A
Test Pattern ENG
4: Slant grid pattern B
4-417-001 5: Argyle P:C
6: Argyle P:D
7: Scanned+Argyle P:D
8: Scanned+ArgyleP:D
4-429-001 Switches unjust copy output pattern density for copy. As the value
4-429-002 Switches unjust copy output pattern density for scan. As the value
4-429-003 Switches unjust copy output pattern density for fax. As the value enlarges,
gets deeper.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-72 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
[SBU Version Display] DFU
System
4600
For design use. Do not change.
SM 5-73 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-74 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
4611 [Gray Balance Set: B]
System
Book Scan *ENG [-384 to 255 / -100 / 1digit/step]
SM 5-75 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Do not noise correct SSCG.
Mode Selection *ENG 1: Only adjust analog (initial value)
2: Only adjust digital
3: Adjust both analog/digital
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-76 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
[Scan Adjust Error]
System
4646
Displays error value of scanning adjustment.
Shows cause of error when an error occurs during the white level
adjustment when scanner turns on. When an error, SC142-00 (F
side/white level adjustment error) will be given.
Bit15:Unused, Bit14: Unused
Bit13:White level abnormal (F side/RED/EVEN pixel)
Bit12: White level abnormal (F side /RED/ODD pixel)
Bit11: White level abnormal (F side /GREEN/EVEN pixel)
Bit10: White level abnormal (F side /GREEN/ODD pixel)
Bit9: White level abnormal (F side /BLUE/EVEN pixel)
4-646-001 Bit8:White level abnormal (F side /BLUE/ODD pixel)
SM 5-77 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Shows cause of error when an error occurs With the Black level check
when scanner turns on. When an error, SC141-00 (F side/Black level
adjustment error) will be given.
Bit7: Unused, Bit6: Unused
Bit5: Black level abnormal (F side/RED/EVEN Pixel)
4-646-002 Bit4: Black level abnormal (F side /RED/ODD Pixel)
Shows cause of error when an error occurs With the SSCG Noise
correction when scanner turns on. When an error, Correction turns off.
Bit7: Unused, Bit6: Unused
Bit5: SSCG correction error (Fside/RED/EVEN Pixel)
Bit4: SSCG correction error (Fside/RED/ODD Pixel)
4-646-003 Bit3: SSCG correction error (Fside/GREEN/EVEN Pixel)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-78 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
[Scanner Hard Error]
System
4647
Displays result of SBU connection check.
Shows cause of error when an error occurs with the SBU connection
detect when Scanner turns on. When an error, SC144-00 (SBU
Communication error) will be given.
Bit15: Unused
Bit14:SBU hardware error (Power ON/un-reset error)
Bit13:SBU hardware error (Serial communication error: F side)
Bit12:SBU hardware error (Reset error: F side)
4-647-001 Bit11: Unused, Bit10: Unused
4-688-001 For the ARDF only. Adjusts density difference between Book and ADF.
Value increase: ADF density deeper.
Value decrease: ADF density thinner.
SM 5-79 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
4-700-001 When CISs ID is not normal, an error flag is set to SP4-747-001 and the
Sets background level to decide output value for background erase when
4-797-002 scanning the rear side (2nd side) of an original in DF scanning mode.
When scanning a darker original in DF scanning mode, the background of
the original may appear on the copy. In such a case, increase this value to
make the background disappear.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-80 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
For design use. Do not change.
System
4-798-001 CIS LED Duty *ENG [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Normal Scan
1: Fix Value Output
4-799-001 Select ENG 2: EO Fix Value Output
3: Main Scan Gradation
4: Sub Scan Gradation
5: Grid Pattern
4-860-001 Displays shading date for original size detection with CCD at the first
scaning after main power switch on.
Every scan job renews the value of shading data.
SM 5-81 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Sets the threshold value for independent dot erase using Copier Text
mode.
4-903-001 The "0" setting disables independent dot erase.
A higher setting detects more spurious dots for erasing. However, this
could cause dots to erase in images that contain areas filled by
dithering.
Sets the threshold value for independent dot erase using Copier
- *ENG [ -2 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Adjust the tone (color gamut) for determining whether the original is full
color or black and white in 5 adjustment levels. (-2 to +2. As the default, it
4-939-001 is set to 0.)
Adjusting this toward "-" prompts the machine to determine the original
more as black and white. Adjusting this toward "+" prompts the machine to
determine the original more as full color.
4-994-001 Adjusts the guide for recognizing the text area or image area.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-82 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP4000
Maintenance
4996 [White Paper Detection Level]
System
- ENG [0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
For example, increasing this value allows the machine to determine the
colored background of originals scanned as a white background.
SM 5-83 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 1 (USA), 0 (Europe/Asia) /
1/step]
5-024-001 0:mm 1:inch *CTL
0: mm
1: inch
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-84 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Accounting counter]
System
5045 Selects the counting method.
[0 or 1 / 0 / step]
5-045-001 Counter Method *CTL 0: 1 count
1: 2 counts
[Paper Display]
5047
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-047-001 Backing Paper *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[Display IP Address]
5055
Display or does not display the IP address on the operation panel.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-055-001 - *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-061-001 - *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
SM 5-85 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-002 #PCU *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-009 Cleaning Blade *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-018 Charge Roller *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-019 Cleaner: Charge Roller *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-021 OPC *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-022 Stripper *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-023 #Dev Unit *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-024 Developer *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-025 Development Filter *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bearing: Development
5-062-028 *CTL 0: No display
Screw
1: Display
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-86 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Transfer Roller
Maintenance
5-062-108 *CTL 0: No display
Unit
System
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-115 Fusing Unit *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-116 Fusing Belt *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-118 Pressure Roller *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bearing: Pressure
5-062-119 *CTL 0: No display
Roller
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-206 ADF Pick-up Roller *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-207 ADF Paper Supply Belt *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-062-208 ADF Reverse Roller *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-066-001 - *CTL 0: No display
1: Display
SM 5-87 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
5067 Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts. If
the user service is selected, PM alert is displayed on the LCD
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-002 #PCU *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-009 Cleaning Blade *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-018 Charge Roller *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-019 Cleaner: Charge Roller *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-021 OPC *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-022 Stripper *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-023 #Dev Unit *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-024 Developer *CTL 0: Service
1: User
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-88 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
5-067-025 Development Filter *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bearing: Development
5-067-028 *CTL 0: Service
Screw
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Transfer Roller
5-067-108 *CTL 0: Service
Unit
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-115 Fusing Unit *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-116 Fusing Belt *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-118 Pressure Roller *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bearing: Pressure
5-067-119 *CTL 0: Service
Roller
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-206 ADF Pick-up Roller *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-207 ADF Paper Supply Belt *CTL 0: Service
1: User
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-067-208 ADF Reverse Roller *CTL 0: Service
1: User
SM 5-89 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
5071 Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up
prevents mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation
panel and an actual paper size on the by-pass tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-071-001 - CTL 0: Off
1: On
5074 Sets applications that appear on the operation panel when home key is
pressed.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Auto
5-074-050 Show Home Edit Menu CTL
1: Displayed
2: Not displayed
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Function disable
5-074-091 Function Setting *CTL
1: SDK application
2: Browser application
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
5-074-093 Application Screen ID *CTL Sets the display category of the
extended application.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-90 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[ServiceSP Entry Code Setting] DFU
System
5081
-
5083 Turns LED lighting ON and OFF at Toner Near End or Waste Toner Near
End.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-083-001 Toner Near End *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-083-002 Waste Toner Near End *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[Timer Set]
5101
Enables or disables the low power mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-101-104 Low Power Set *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
SM 5-91 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 to 12 / 0 / 1/step]
0: None,
1: Key Card(RK3,4)
2: Key Card(down),
3: PrepaidCard
Default Optional
5-113-001 *CTL 4: Coin Rack
Counter Type
5: MFKeyCard
11: Exp.KeyCard(Add)
12: Exp.KeyCard(Deduct)
This program specifies the counter
type.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
0: None
1: Expansion Device 1
External Optional
5-113-002 *CTL 1: Expansion Device 2
Counter Type
1: Expansion Device 3
This program specifies the external
counter type.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-114-001 MF Key Card Extension *CTL 0: Not installed
1: Installed (scanning accounting)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-92 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Disable Copying]
System
5118
This program disables copying.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-118-001 - *CTL 0: Not disabled
1: Disabled
5120 This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you
install or remove an optional counter, check the settings.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Yes (removed)
5-120-001 - *CTL
1: Standby (installed but not used)
2: No (not removed)
[Counter Up Timing]
5121 This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to
paper feed and paper exit respectively.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-121-001 0:Feed 1:Exit *CTL 0: Feed
1: Exit
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 8 1/2 x 13
5-126-001 - ENG
1: 8 1/4 x 13
2: 8 x 13
SM 5-93 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-127-001 - *CTL 0: Not disabled
1: Disabled
5131 The region setting of SP5-181-xxx (Size Adjust) is all specified by using this
SP.
[0 to 2 / @ / 1/step]
"@" depens on the destination area.
5-131-001 - *ENG 0: JP (Japan)
1: NA
2: EU
Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is
5150 limited to 600 mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
Image quality is not assured for the length over 600mm.
When printing/feeding over 600mm length paper, customization request is
required for a customized printer driver.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-150-001 0: OFF 1: ON CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-162-001 - *CTL 0: Soft Key Set
1: Hard Key Set
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-94 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device.
System
5167
This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted by an external
accounting device.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-167-001 - *CTL 0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169
Continues login status by service after SP mode end.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-169-001 CE Login *CTL 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Sets tray 1 detection size (A4 LEF or LT LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 1 detection size (A3 or DLT) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
SM 5-95 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Sets tray 1 detection size (B4 or GL SEF) when Auto Detect is seletected
in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 1 detection size (B5 LEF or Exe LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 2 detection size (A4 LEF or TL LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 2 detection size (A3 or DLT) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 2 detection size (B4 or GL SEF) when Auto Detect is seletected
in the [Tray Paper Settings].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-96 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
KOR) / 1/step]
TRAY 2: 4 *ENG
System
0: B5 LEF
5-181-008 1: 7 1/4x10 1/2 LEF
Sets tray 2 detection size (B5 LEF or Exe LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 3 (LCT) detection size (A4 LEF or LT LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 3 detection size (A3 or DLT) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 3 detection size (B4 or LG) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 3 detection size (B5 LEF or Exe LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
SM 5-97 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Sets tray 4 detection size (A4 LEF or LT LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 4 detection size (A3 or DLT) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 4 detection size (B4 or LG) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 4 detection size (B5 LEF or Exe LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-98 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
KOR) / 1/step]
TRAY 4: 5 *ENG
System
0: 12.6x17.7
5-181-018 1: 12x18
Sets tray 5 detection size (A4 LEF or LT LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 5 detection size (A3 or DLT) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 5 detection size (B4 or LG) when Auto Detect is seletected in
the [Tray Paper Settings].
Sets tray 5 detection size (B5 LEF or Exe LEF) when Auto Detect is
seletected in the [Tray Paper Settings].
SM 5-99 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
5-181-024 1: LT LEF
2: B5 LEF
Sets LCT detection size when Auto Detect is seletected in the [Tray
Paper Settings].
[RK4]
[Copy Nv Version]
5188
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
5-188-001 - *CTL [- / - / -]
[Mode Set]
5191
Shifts to the power save mode or not.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-191-001 Power Str Set *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-100 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Limitless SW]
System
Selects the paper feed mode.
Productivity priority:
This changes the feeding tray as soon as the machine detects the priority
5195 tray even the paper still remains in the feeding tray.
Tray priority:
This changes the feeding tray after the paper in the tray where the machine
has been feeding paper has been run out of.
This SP is activated only when a customer selects the "Auto Paper Select".
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-195-001 - *CTL 0: Productivity Precede
1: Use paper up
Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the
5199 maximum number of the finisher stapling when the machine gets a
multiple printing job (over maximum number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum
number of the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple
printing job (over maximum number).
[ 0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-199-001 0: OFF 1: ON CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[Page Numbering]
This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers in the
duplex mode with two in one.
5212 "- value" moves the page number positions to the right edge or leading
edge.
"+ value" moves the page number positions to the left edge or trailing
edge.
SM 5-101 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[2 to 9 / 9 / 1/step]
Specifies input available figure length
5-227-201 Allow Page No. Entry *CTL of "Job serial numbers page print out
starts number that specified by
optional text print out.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0:OFF
1:ON
5-227-202 Zero Surplus Setting *CTL Specifies zero suppression of "Job
serial numbers page print out starts
number" that specified by optional text
print out.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-102 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Set Time]
System
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-305-101 Auto Off Limit Set *CTL 0: Limitation off
1: Limitation on
SM 5-103 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
(Default)
1: NA and EUR
0: ASIA and others
Enables or disables the summer time
5-307-001 Setting *CTL
mode.
5-307-003 the first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit
setting.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5]
4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step]
8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-104 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[- / - / -]
Rule Set (End) *CTL
System
* See the detail below
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Read Only
1: Edit
2: Edit/Delete
3: Full control
5-401-103 Default Document ACL *CTL Whenever a new login user is added to
the address book in external
certification mode (for Windows,
LDAP, RDH), the default document
ACL is updated according to this SP
setting.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1sec/step]
5-401-104 Authentication Time *CTL Specifies the timeout of the
authentication.
SM 5-105 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1/step]
"SDK" is the "Software Development
5-401-200 SDK1 UniqueID *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]
"SDK" is the "Software Development
SDK1 Certification
5-401-201 *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
Method
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1/step]
"SDK" is the "Software Development
5-401-210 SDK2 UniqueID *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-106 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
"SDK" is the "Software Development
SDK2 Certification
System
5-401-211 *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
Method
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1/step]
"SDK" is the "Software Development
5-401-220 SDK3 UniqueID *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1/step]
"SDK" is the "Software Development
SDK3 Certification
5-401-221 *CTL Kit". This data can be converted from
Method
SAS (VAS) when installed or
uninstalled.
SDK Certification
5-401-230 *CTL [- / 00000000 / 1 /-]
Device
SM 5-107 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
5-402-101
SDKJ1 Limit Setting -
to *CTL [0 to 0xFF / 00000000 / 1/step]
SDKJ30 Limit Setting
5-402-130
5-402-141
SDKJ1 ProductID -
to *CTL [0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1/step]
SDKJ30 ProductID
5-402-170
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-108 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
Clears all counters for users.
System
5-404-004 - *CTL [Execute]
[LDAP-Certification]
5411
Sets description of LDAP certification.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Simplified
5-411-004 *CTL 0: OFF
Authentication
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Password NULL permitted.
Password Null Not
5-411-005 *CTL 1: Password NULL not permitted.
Permit
This SP is referenced only when
SP5411-4 is set to "1" (On).
[0 or 1 / 00000000 / 1/step]
5-411-006 Detail Option *CTL 0: Anonymous authentication OFF
1: Anonymous authentication ON
5412 [Krb-Certification]
[- / 11111111 / 1/step]
0x01:AES256-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96
0x02:AES128-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96
0x04:DES3-CBC-SHA1
0x08:RC4-HMAC
5-412-100 Encrypt Mode *CTL
0x10:DES-CBC-MD5
0xFF(0x1F):ALL
Executes kerberos certification
according to certified encryption
strength.
SM 5-109 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[Lockout Setting]
5413
Switches on/off the lock on the local address book account.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-413-001 Lockout On/Off *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-413-003 Cancelation On/Off *CTL
0:OFF, 1:ON
[1 to 9999 / 60 / 1minute/step]
5-413-004 Cancelation Time *CTL Sets release time of lockout release
function.
[Access Mitigation]
5414
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
5-414-001 Mitigation On/Off *CTL Switches on/off masking of
continuously used IDs and passwords
that are identical.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1minute/step]
Sets the length of time for excluding
5-414-002 Mitigation Time *CTL
continuous access for identical user
IDs and passwords.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-110 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Password Attack]
5415
System
-
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1time/step]
Sets the number of attempts to attack
5-415-001 Permissible Number *CTL
the system with random passwords to
gain illegal access to the system.
[0 to 10 / 5 / 1second/step]
Sets the time limit to stop a password
5-415-002 Detect Time *CTL
attack once such an attack has been
detected.
[Access Information]
5416
-
[1 to 10 / 3 / 1second/step]
Sets the processing time interval for
5-416-003 Monitor Interval *CTL
referencing user ID and password
information.
SM 5-111 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[Access Attack]
5417
-
[10 to 30 / 10 / 1second/step]
Sets the length of time for monitoring
5-417-002 Attack Detect Time *CTL
the frequency of access to MFP
features.
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1second/step]
Sets the wait time to slow down the
5-417-003 Productivity Fall Waite *CTL speed of certification when an
excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-112 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[User Authentication]
System
5420 These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been
enabled.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-001 Copy *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-011 DocumentServer *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-021 Fax *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-031 Scanner *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-041 Printer *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-420-081 Browser *CTL 0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
SM 5-113 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Function OFF
1: Function ON
5-430-001 Message Change On/Off *CTL
Turns on or off the displayed
message change for the
authentication.
[Execute]
5-430-002 Message Text Download CTL Executes the message download for
the authentication.
[Char:Up to 16 bytes / - / -]
5-430-003 Message Text ID CTL Inputs message text for the
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-010 Tag *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-011 Entry *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-012 Group *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-020 Mail *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-030 FAX *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-031 FAXSub *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-032 Folder *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-114 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-033 ProtectCode *CTL
Maintenance
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
System
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-034 SmtpAuth *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-035 LdapAuth *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-036 Smb Ftp Fldr Auth *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-037 AcntAcl *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-038 DocumentAcl *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-431-040 CertCrypt *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-431-050 UserLimitCount *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-481-001 System Log Disp *CTL 0: Display OFF
1: Display ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-481-002 Panel Disp *CTL 0: Display OFF
1: Display ON
SM 5-115 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[MF KeyCard]
5490
Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard (Japan only).
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disabled. Cancels operation without
5-490-001 Job Permit Setting *CTL a user code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a
user code.
[Optional Counter]
5491
-
[0 or 1 / 00000000 / 1/step]
Bit0:
5-491-001 Detail Option *CTL 0: Forced Job Canceling OFF
1: Forced Job Canceling ON
Bit1 to Bit7: Not used
[PM Alarm]
5501
Sets PM count level that emits PM alarm call.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Alarm off
5-501-001 PM Alarm Level *CTL
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value
(1 to 9999) x 1000 > PM counter
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-116 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[Jam Alarm]
System
5504 Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document miss feeds
are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
0(Z): Jam alarm prohibited
1(L): level H 1/4
5-504-001 - *CTL 2(M): level H 1/2
3(H): Jam occurrence interval sheets of
indicated paper that indicated product
proposal.
[Error Alarm]
SM 5-117 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[Supply/CC Alarm]
5507
Enables or disables the notifying a supply call via the @Remote.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-507-001 Paper Supply Alarm *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-507-002 Staple Supply Alarm *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-507-003 Toner Supply Alarm *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-507-080 Toner Call Timing *CTL 0: At replacement
1: AtLessThanThresh
[10 to 90 / 10 / 10%/step]
5-507-081 Toner Call Threshold *CTL This program enables only if
SP5-507-080 is "1"
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-118 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1/step]
System
5-507-141 Interval :B4 *CTL Sets report level of paper supply
administration call.
[CC Call]
5508
Sets PM count level that emits PM alarm call.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-508-001 Jam Remains *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-508-002 Continuous Jams *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-508-003 Continuous Door Open *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
SM 5-119 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Jam Detection:
5-508-012 *CTL [2 to 10 / 5 / 1time/step]
Continuous Count
[PartsAlermlevelCount]
5513 Call in at the point that the counter of PM Parts Counter Display: Normal
(SP7-617-001) reaches this level (K).
[PartsAlermlev]
5514 PM report alarm for each CSS parts: Sets DF paper feed criteria On/Off
(report or not).
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-514-001 Nomal *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-514-002 Df *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-120 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
[SC/Alarm Setting]
System
With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when
5515
an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when
an SC error occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-515-001 SC Call *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Service Parts Near End
5-515-002 *CTL 0: OFF
Call
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-515-003 Service Parts End Call *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-515-004 User Call *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Communication Test
5-515-006 *CTL 0: OFF
Call
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Machine Information
5-515-007 *CTL 0: OFF
Notice
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-515-008 Alarm Notice *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Supply Automatic
5-515-010 *CTL 0: OFF
Ordering Call
1: ON
SM 5-121 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Supply Management
5-515-011 *CTL 0: OFF
Report Call
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-515-012 Jam/Door Open Call *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 to 255 / 10 / 1min/step]
When SMC info collect is interrupt,
Get SMC Info: Retry
5-517-031 *CTL retries during the time between
Interval
receving Request for obtaining SMC
info, to value set with this setting.
[Network Setting]
5728 Displays and sets the port numbers of the port forward for transfering to the
Android operation panel.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-122 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
Maintenance
5-728-011 NAT Machine Port6 *CTL [1 to 65535 / 49106 / 1/step]
System
5-728-012 NAT UI Port6 *CTL [1 to 65535 / 55106 / 1/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
JavaTM Platform 0: OFF
5-730-001 *CTL
setting 1: ON
Turns on or off the Java TM platform.
[0 to 999 / 20 / 1day/step]
Expiration Prior Alarm
5-730-010 *CTL Sets the remaining days until the SDK
Set
application expires.
[Counter Effect]
5731
This SP is uesd only for Japan machines.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Change MK1 Cnt
5-731-001 *CTL 0: OFF
(Paper -> Combine)
1: ON
SM 5-123 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-1
[PDF Setting]
5734
Limits PDF file type when operating Scan to, fax send, and web download.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-734-001 PDF/A Fixed *CTL 0: non-fixed setting
1: fixed setting (PDF/A use only)
5745 [DeemedPowerConsumption]
Low Power
5-745-218 *CTL [0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
Consumption
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-124 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
System
5.7.1 SP5-XXX (MODE)
[Browser Setting]
5747
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step ]
Extended Memory
5-747-203 *CTL 0: Use extended memory
Limit
1: Not use extended memory
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Vertical Scroll Display
5-747-204 *CTL 0: Fixed
Setting
1: Not fixed
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Confirmation dialog for page moving:
displayed/ security warning: displayed
1: Confirmation dialog for page moving:
not displayed/ security warning:
Warning Confirmation displayed
5-747-205 *CTL
Setting 2: Confirmation dialog for page moving:
not displayed/ security warning: not
displayed
3: Confirmation dialog for page moving:
displayed/ security warning: not
displayed
SM 5-125 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[OpePanel Setting]
5748
Sets operation of related operational panel.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Not connected
Cheetah Panel
5-748-201 CTL 1: Connected
Connect Setting
Select 1 when the optional smart
operation panel is to be installed.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-126 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[Import/Export]
System
5749
Imports and exports preference information.
[- / - / -]
Target: System, Printer, Fax, Scanner
Option: Unique, Secret
5-749-001 Export CTL
Copy config: Encryption, Encryption key
(if selected)
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
Option: Unique
5-749-101 Import CTL Copy config: Encryption, Encryption key
(if selected)
[Execute]
[Copy:FlairAPI Setting]
5752
Sets copy FlairAPI functions ON/OFF.
SM 5-127 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[Display Setting]
5755
Sets the display for the administrator password.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Disp Administrator
Displays the password setting screen for
5-755-001 Password Change CTL
the supervisor and administrator 1 at the
Scrn
startup after the execution of this SP is
done.
[- / - / -]
Hide Administrator [Execute]
5-755-002 Password Change CTL Hides the input screen of the
Scrn administrator password temporarily after
the execution of this SP is done.
[Remote UI Setting]
5758
Enabels or disables the authentication function for the Remote UI.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-758-001 Authentication *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
[Memory Clear]
5801 Resets NVRAM data to the default settings. Before executing any of these
SP codes, print an SMC Report.
[- / - / -]
5-801-001 All Clear CTL
[Execute]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-128 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[- / - / -]
System
[Execute]
5-801-002 Engine ENG
Initializes all registration settings for the
engine and copy process settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Initializes default system settings, SCS
5-801-003 SCS CTL
(System Control Service) settings,
operation display coordinates, and ROM
update information.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-004 IMH Memory Clr CTL
Clears Image Memory Handler which
manages memory and HDD access.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-005 MCS CTL Initializes the automatic delete time
setting for stored documents.
(MCS: Memory Control Service)
[- / - / -]
5-801-006 Copier application CTL [Execute]
Initializes all copier application settings.
[- / - / -]
5-801-007 Fax Application CTL [Execute]
Initializes all fax application settings.
SM 5-129 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Initializes the printer defaults, programs
registered, the printer SP bit switches,
and the printer CSS counter.
The following service setting:
Bit switches
Gamma setting (User & Service)
5-801-008 Printer Application CTL Toner Limit
The following user setting:
Tray Priority
Menu protect
System Setting except for setting of
Energy Saver
I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O
Timeout)
PCL Menu
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-009 Scanner Application CTL
Initializes the scanner defaults for the
scanner and all the scanner SP modes.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Deletes the Netfile (NFA) management
5-801-010 Web Service CTL files and thumbnails, and initializes the
Job login ID. Netfiles are jobs to be
printed from the document server using
a PC and the DeskTopBinder software.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-130 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[- / - / -]
System
[Execute]
Initializes the system defaults and
5-801-011 NCS CTL interface settings (IP addresses also),
the SmartNetMonitor for Admin settings,
WebStatusMonitor settings, and the
TELNET settings.
[- / - / -]
5-801-012 R-FAX CTL [Execute]
Initializes the remote fax settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-014 Clear DCS Setting CTL
Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control
Service) settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-015 Clear UCS Setting CTL
Initializes the UCS (User Information
Control Service) settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-016 MIRS Setting CTL
Initializes the MIRS (Machine
Information Report Service) settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-017 CCS CTL
Initializes the CCS (Certification and
Charge-control Service) settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-018 SRM Memory Clr CTL
Initializes the SRM (System Resource
Manager) settings.
SM 5-131 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
5-801-019 LCS CTL [Execute]
Initializes the LCS settings.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-020 Web Uapli CTL
Initializes the web user application
settings.
[- / - / -]
5-801-021 ECS CTL [Execute]
Initializes the ECS settings.
[- / - / -]
5-801-023 AICS CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-801-024 BROWSER CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-801-025 Websys CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-801-026 PLN CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-801-027 SAS CTL
[Execute]
[INPUT Check]
5803
See page 5-355 "Input Check Table".
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
See page 5-387 "Output Check Table".
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-132 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[Anti-Condensation Heater]
System
Switches ON/OFF dehumidify heater / dew condensation preventing heater
during standby.
5805 If set to "ON", the anti-condensation heater remains in operation even
while the machine is in standby, energy saving mode, or trouble (SC, etc.).
However, the heater is off while warming up, printing, and in the sleep
state.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF (Switches OFF when the
5-805-001 0:OFF / 1:ON *ENG machine is in standby mode.)
1: ON (Switches ON when the machine
is in standby mode.)
5811 [MachineSerial]
SM 5-133 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Sets the telephone number for a service
representative. This number is printed
on the Counter List, which can be
5-812-001 Service *CTL
printed with the users Counter menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both
numbers and alphabetic characters can
be input).
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Sets the fax or telephone number for a
service representative. This number is
5-812-002 Facsimile *CTL printed on the Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both
numbers and alphabetic characters can
be input).
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Use this to input the telephone number
5-812-003 Supply *CTL
of your supplier for consumables. Enter
the number and press #.
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Use this to input the telephone number
5-812-004 Operation *CTL
of your sales agency. Enter the number
and press #.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-134 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[Remote Service]
5816
System
Use it for Network remote diagnosis.
[0 to 2 / 2 / 2/step]
0: Remote service off
5-816-001 I/F Setting *CTL 1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
Selects the remote service setting.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
Performs the CE Call at the start or end
5-816-002 CE Call *CTL
of the service.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Enables or disables the remote service
function.
5-816-003 Function Flag *CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Uses the RCG certification
1: Does no use the RCG certification
5-816-007 SSL Disable *CTL
Uses or does not use the RCG
certification by SSL when calling the
RCG.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1second/step]
RCG Connect
5-816-008 *CTL Specifies the connect timeout interval
Timeout
when calling the RCG.
SM 5-135 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1second/step]
5-816-009 RCG Write Timeout *CTL Specifies the write timeout interval when
calling the RCG.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1second/step]
5-816-010 RCG Read Timeout *CTL Specifies the read timeout interval when
calling the RCG.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No. Access denied
5-816-011 Port 80 Enable *CTL 1: Yes. Access granted.
Enables/disables access via port 80 to
the SOAP method.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: RFU is executed whenever update
request is received.
5-816-013 RFU Timing *CTL
1: RFU is executed only when the
machine is in the sleep mode.
Selects the RFU timing.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0:Normal condition 1:Error
Displays the cause of an RCG error.
When @Remote is used, normally
displays "0".
5-816-014 RCG Error Cause CTL
If "1" is displayed, this means that the
authentication from client to server failed
when the network re-booted. To restore
normal operation, cycle the machine
off/on to return a "0" (normal condition).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-136 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
0: Installation not completed
5-816-021 RCG-C Registed CTL 1: Installation completed
This SP displays the Embedded RC
Gate installation end flag.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Internet connection
5-816-023 Connect Type (N/M) *CTL 1: Dial-up connection
This SP displays and selects the
Embedded RC Gate connection method.
[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1second/step]
Cert Expire Timing
5-816-061 *CTL Proximity of the expiration of the
DFU
certification.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Not use
1: Use
5-816-062 Use Proxy *CTL
This SP setting determines if the proxy
server is used when the machine
communicates with the service center.
SM 5-137 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
This SP sets the address of the proxy
server used for communication between
the RCG
Device and the gateway. Use this SP to
set up or display the customer proxy
server
address
The address is necessary to set up the
5-816-063 Proxy Host *CTL
embedded RCG-N.
[0 to 0xFFFF / 0 / 1/step]
This SP sets the port number of the
proxy server used for communication
between the Embedded RCG-N and the
gateway. This setting is necessary to set
5-816-064 Proxy PortNumber *CTL up the embedded
RC Gate-N.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-138 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
Maintenance
This SP sets the HTTP proxy
System
certification user name.
[- / - / -]
This SP sets the HTTP proxy
certification password.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
5-816-067 CERT:Up State *CTL Displays the status of the certification
update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an
4
update is being sent to the GW URL.
SM 5-139 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified
15
of the successful completion of this event.
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being
16
notified of the failure of this event.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays a number code that
CERT:Error *CTL
describes the reason for the request
for update of the certification.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-140 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
6 Notification that GW URL does not exist.
System
[- / - / -]
5-816-069 CERT:Up ID *CTL
The ID of the request for certification.
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays the status of the firmware update.
0: Farm update reception standby
1: Farm update start schedule standby.
2: User confirmation standby.
5-816-083 Firm Up Status *CTL
3: Device farm update preparation is
executing.
4: Device farm update process is executing.
5: Device farm update end process is
executing.
[- / - / -]
5-816-087 CERT: Macro Ver. CTL Displays the macro version of the @Remote
certification. Max. 8digits.
SM 5-141 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
5-816-088 CERT: PAC Ver. CTL Displays the macro version of the @Remote
certification. Max. 16 digits.
[- / - / -]
Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification.
Spaces are displayed as underscores (_).
5-816-089 CERT: ID2 Code CTL Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"
indicates "Common certification". Max. 16
digits.
[- / - / -]
Displays the common name of the @Remote
certification subject. CN = the following 17
bytes. Spaces are displayed as underscores
5-816-090 CERT: Subject CTL
(_). Asterisks (*) indicate that no @Remote
certification exists. "000000___________"
indicates "Common certification". Max. 16
digits.
[- / - / -]
Displays serial number for the @Remote
5-816-091 CERT: Serial No CTL
certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no
@Remote certification exists. Max. 7 digits.
[- / - / -]
Displays the common name of the issuer of
5-816-092 CERT: Issuer CTL the @Remote certification. CN = the following
30 bytes. Asterisks () indicate that no
@Remote certification exists. Max. 7 digits.
[- / - / -]
Displays the start time of the period for which
5-816-093 CERT: Valid Start CTL
the current @Remote certification is enabled.
Max. 10 digits.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-142 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[- / - / -]
System
Displays the end time of the period for which
5-816-094 CERT: Valid End CTL
the current @Remote certification is enabled.
Max. 10 digits.
[1 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
1:512bit
2:2048bit
Displays the strength of encryption used for
NRS authentication. The displayed value is
CERT: Encrypt
5-816-102 *CTL not the value acquired from the authentication
Level
domain, rather it is the value stored in
NVRAM when authentication is written. When
NRS starts up, if there is a mismatch between
this SP setting and the authentication
encryption, then the SP value is updated.
[0 to 3 / 0/ 1/step]
Saves the communication type that the
machine succeeded in @Remote client
Client
communication
5-816-103 Communication *CTL
0: Not communicated (initial settting)
Method
1: IPv4
2: IPv6
3: Hostname
[1 to 7 / 7 / 1/step]
Determines the destinations of NRSGateway
Client that the machine can use during @Remote
5-816-104 Communication *CTL communication. If NRS device runs, the
Limit setting specified here will be invalid.
Enable: Uses as the destinations
Disable: Does not use as the destinations
IPv6 IPv4
Value Hostname
Address Address
SM 5-143 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[5 to 255 / 5 / 1/sec]
Saves the time until the latest network
Network information is determined.
5-816-115 Information *CTL If SCS does not notify a boot of the network or
Waiting timer IPv6 address event, NRS determines the
network information and notrifies the setting
change(s) to intermediary device(s).
Line Type
[- / - / -]
5-816-151 Automatic CTL
[Execute]
Judgement
Line Type
5-816-152 CTL [0 to 255 / 0 / 0]
Judgement Result
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-144 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
Selection Dial /
System
5-816-153 CTL 0: Tone dialing phone
Push
1: Pulse dialing phone
Outside Line
5-816-154 CTL [char (4 digits) / - / -]
Outgoing Number
Local Phone
5-816-161 CTL [numeric (24 digits) / - / -]
Number
Connection Timing
5-816-162 Adjustment CTL [0 to 24 / 1 / 1/step]
Incoming
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-816-164 Line Connecting CTL 0: Sharing FAX
1: No Sharing FAX
[- / - / -]
5-816-173 Modem Serial No. CTL
Displays the modem serial number.
Retransmission [- / - / -]
5-816-174 CTL
Limit [Execute]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-816-187 FAX TX Priority CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[- / - / -]
5-816-200 Manual Polling CTL [Execute]
Executes the manual polling.
SM 5-145 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
external RCG.
2. The embedded RCG device is set. In this status, the external RCG unit
cannot answer a polling request.
3. The registered device by the external RCG is being set. In this status the
embedded RCG device cannot be set.
4 The registered module by the external RCG has not started.
[- / - / -]
Allows entry of the number of the
5-816-202 Letter Number *CTL
request needed for the RCG-N
device.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Executes the inquiry request to the
5-816-203 Confirm Execute CTL
@Remote GW URL.
If SP5-816-202 was not entered, an
error occurs.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays a number that indicates
5-816-204 Confirm Result CTL
the result of the inquiry executed
with SP5-816-203.
[- / - / -]
Displays the result of the
notification sent to the device from
5-816-205 Confirm Place CTL the GW URL in answer to the
inquiry request. Displayed only
when the result is registered at the
GW URL.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-146 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
Maintenance
[Execute]
5-816-206 Register Execute CTL
System
Executes "Embedded RCG
Registration".
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
5-816-207 Register Result CTL Displays a number that indicates
the registration result.
[-2147483647 to 2147483647 / 0 /
1/step]
Displays a number that describes
5-816-208 Error Code CTL
the error code that was issued
when either SP5816-204 or
SP5816-207 was executed.
SM 5-147 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-148 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
-2385 correct international prefix for the
System
telephone number.
[- / - / -]
5-816-209 Instl Clear CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-149 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[- / - / -]
5-816-250 CommLog Print CTL [Execute]
Prints the communication log.
[00000000h to FFFFFFFFh /
00000000h / 1/step]
Sets the IP address of the RCG
5-821-002 RCG IPv4 Address *CTL
(Remote Communication Gate)
destination for call processing at the
remote service center.
[0 to 15 / /RCG/services/ /-]
Sets the IPv4 address of the RCG
5-821-004 RCG IPv4 URL Path *CTL destination URL path for call
processing at the remote service
center.
[- / - / -]
Sets the IPv6 address of the RCG
5-821-005 RCG IPv6 Address *CTL
destination for call processing at the
remote service center.
[0 to 15 / /RCG/services/ /-]
Sets the IPv6 address of the RCG
5-821-006 RCG IPv6 URL Path *CTL destination URL path for call
processing at the remote service
center.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-150 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
Sets the IPv6 address of the RCG
System
destination host name for call
5-821-007 RCG Host Name *CTL
processing at the remote service
center.
[0 to 15 / /RCG/services/ /-]
Sets the IPv6 address of the RCG
5-821-008 RCG Host URL Path *CTL host name destination URL path for
call processing at the remote service
center.
[- / - / -]
5-824-001 NV-RAM Upload CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-825-001 NV-RAM Download CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-151 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[Network Setting]
5828
Sets interface of Ethernet and wireless LAN.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
1284 Compatiblity Enables or disables 1284
5-828-050 *CTL
(Centro) Compatibility.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Enables or disables ECP
Compatibility.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
5-828-052 ECP (Centro) *CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-828-065 Job Spooling *CTL Enables/disables Job Spooling.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Treatment of the job when a spooled
Job Spooling Clear: Start
5-828-066 *CTL job exists at power on.
Time
0: ON (Data is cleared)
1: OFF (Automatically printed)
[- / 0111111 / - ]
Validates or invalidates the job
spooling function for each protocol.
0: Validates
1: Invalidates
bit0: LPR
5-828-069 Job Spooling (Protocol) *CTL bit1: FTP
bit2: IPP
bit3: SMB
bit4: BMLinkS
bit5: DIPRINT
bit6: sftp
bit7: (Reserved)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-152 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
1: It has been processed by hit
System
protocol.
5-828-087 Protocol usage *CTL 0: It has Never processed by hit
protocol.
See [Bit assignment for SP5-828-087]
below.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Enabled or disabled the Telnet
5-828-090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON) *CTL
protocol.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Enables or disables the Web
5-828-091 Web (0: OFF 1: ON) *CTL
operation.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
SM 5-153 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
IPv6 Stateless Auto 0: Disable, 1: Enable
5-828-161 CTL
Setting Enables or disables the automatic
setting for IPv6 stateless.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-154 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
System
Displays or does not display the link to
Web shopping link
5-828-237 *CTL Net RICOH on the top page and link
visible
page of the web system.
0: Not display, 1:Display
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Displays or does not display the link to
5-828-238 Web supplies Link visible *CTL Consumable Supplier on the top page
and link page of the web system.
0: Not display, 1:Display
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Displays or does not display the link to
5-828-241 Web Link1 visible *CTL URL1 on the top page of the web
system.
0: Not display, 1:Display
SM 5-155 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-828-244 Web Link2 visible *CTL
Same as "-241"
[0 or 1 / 00000000000000 / 1/step]
5-828-249 DHCPv6 DUID *CTL This SP confirms or changes the value
of DUID.
1 IPv6 17 WSD-Printer
5 Appletalk 21 Reserve
6 DHCP 22 Bluetooth
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-156 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[HDD]
System
5832 Enter the SP number for the partition to initialize, then press #. When the
execution ends, cycle the machine power off and on.
[- / - / -]
5-832-001 HDD Formatting (ALL) CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-832-002 HDD Formatting (IMH) CTL
[Execute]
HDD Formatting [- / - / -]
5-832-003 CTL
(Thumbnail/OCR) [Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-832-007 Mail RX Data CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-832-008 Mail TX Data CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-832-010 HDD Formatting (Log) CTL
[Execute]
HDD Formatting [- / - / -]
5-832-012 CTL
(Thumbnail) [Execute]
SM 5-157 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[Capture Setting]
5836
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable
1: Enable
Capture Function (0:Off
5-836-001 *CTL With this function disabled, the
1:On)
settings related to the capture feature
cannot be initialized, displayed, or
selected.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Displayed
1: Not displayed
5-836-002 Panel Setting *CTL
Determines whether each capture
related setting can be changed in the
system settings or not.
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1,
Reduction for Copy B&W 1: 1/2
5-836-072 *CTL
Text 2: 1/3
3: 1/4
6: 2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1,
Reduction for Copy B&W 1: 1/2
5-836-073 *CTL
Other 2: 1/3
3: 1/4
6: 2/3
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1,
Reduction for Printer 1: 1/2
5-836-075 *CTL
B&W 2: 1/3
3: 1/4
6: 2/3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-158 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1/step]
Maintenance
0: JFIF/JPEG
Format for Copy B&W
System
5-836-082 *CTL 1: TIFF/MMR
Text
2: TIFF/MH
3: TIFF/MR
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1/step]
0: JFIF/JPEG
Format for Copy B&W
5-836-083 *CTL 1: TIFF/MMR
Other
2: TIFF/MH
3: TIFF/MR
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1/step]
0: JFIF/JPEG
5-836-085 Format for Printer B&W *CTL 1: TIFF/MMR
2: TIFF/MH
3: TIFF/MR
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1/step]
Sets the JPEG format default for
documents sent to the document
management server with the MLB,
5-836-091 Default for JPEG *CTL
with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional File
Format Converter (MLB: Media Link
Board) is installed.
[000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
/ 000.000.000.000 / 1/step]
5-836-101 Primary srv IP address *CTL Sets the IP address of the PC
designated to operate as the primary
capture server (CS).
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
5-836-103 Primary srv port number *CTL Use to set the IO device for the
primary CS remotely.
SM 5-159 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[0 to 16 / - / -]
Use to set the IO device for the
5-836-104 Primary srv URL path *CTL
primary CS remotely.
Max. characters: 16
[000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
/ 000.000.000.000 / 1/step]
Sets the IP address of the PC
5-836-111 Secondary srv IP address *CTL
designated to operate as the
secondary capture server
(CS).
[Char: Max. 6 / - / -]
Sets the IO device of the secondary
5-836-112 Secondary srv scheme *CTL
CS remotely.
Max. characters: 6
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
Secondary srv port
5-836-113 *CTL Sets the IO device of the secondary
number
CS remotely. Max. characters: 6
[0 to 16 / - / -]
Sets the IO device of the secondary
5-836-114 Secondary srv URL path *CTL
CS remotely.
Max. characters: 6
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-836-120 Default Reso Rate Switch *CTL
Sets the IO device of the CS remotely.
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]
Sets the IO device of the CS remotely:
5-836-122 Reso: Copy(Mono) *CTL
0: 600dpi, 1: 400dpi, 2: 300dpi, 3:
200dpi, 4: 150dpi, 5: 100dpi, 6: 75dpi
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]
Sets the IO device of the CS remotely:
5-836-124 Reso: Print(Mono) *CTL
0: 600dpi, 1: 400dpi, 2: 300dpi, 3:
200dpi, 4: 150dpi, 5: 100dpi, 6: 75dpi
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-160 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
Maintenance
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]
System
5-836-126 Reso: FAX(Mono) *CTL 0: 600dpi, 1: 400dpi, 2: 300dpi, 3:
200dpi, 4: 150dpi, 5: 100dpi, 6: 75dpi
[0 to 255 / 4 / 1/step]
5-836-127 Reso: Scan(Color) *CTL 0: 600dpi, 1: 400dpi, 2: 300dpi, 3:
200dpi, 4: 150dpi, 5: 100dpi, 6: 75dpi
[0 to 255 / 3 / 1/step]
5-836-128 Reso: Scan(Mono) *CTL 0: 600dpi, 1: 400dpi, 2: 300dpi, 3:
200dpi, 4: 150dpi, 5: 100dpi, 6: 75dpi
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Expands the scope of used resources
5-836-141 All addr Info Switch *CTL and performance. Switch this off if this
feature is not being used.
1: ON, 0: OFF
SM 5-161 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[IEEE 802.11]
5840
-
[1 to 14 / 14 / 1/step]
Sets the maximum number of
channels available for data
transmission via the wireless LAN.
The number of channels available
varies according to location. The
default settings are set for the
5-840-006 Channel MAX *CTL
maximum end of the range for each
area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the
maximum number of channels. DFU
[1 to 11 / 1 / 1/step]
Sets the minimum number of channels
available for data transmission via the
wireless LAN. The number of channels
available varies according to location.
The default settings are set for the
5-840-007 Channel MIN *CTL minimum end of the range for each
area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the
minimum number of channels. DFU
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-162 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-2
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
Maintenance
1: info
5-840-045 WPA Debug Lvl *CTL
System
2: warning
3: error
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Not used
5-840-046 11w *CTL
1: preferentially used
2: Required
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-840-047 PSK Set Type *CTL 0: Passphrase
1: PSK
SM 5-163 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-164 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[GWWS Analysis]
System
5842 These settings select the output mode for debugging information as each
network file is processed.
Default: 00000000
Do not change
5-842-001 Setting 1 *CTL Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the
document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software
Default: 00000000
Adjusts the debug program mode
setting.
5-842-002 Setting 2 *CTL Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting
0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second
1: Minute/Second/Msec.
0 to 6: Not used
[USB]
5844
-
SM 5-165 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Selects the PnP name standardization
mode.
5-844-005 Fixed USB Port *CTL
0: OFF
1: Level 1
2: Level 2
5-844-006 PnP Model Name *CTL Specifies PnP name for USB device.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-844-008 Mac Supply Level *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Displays or does not display USB
5-844-100 Notify Unsupport *CTL unsupported message.
0: Not display
1: Display
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-166 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[Delivery Server Setting]
5845
System
Provides items for delivery server settings.
[000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
/ 000.000.000.000 / 1/ - ]
Use this SP to set the Scan Router
5-845-002 IP Address (Primary) *CTL
Server address. The IP address under
the transfer tab can be referenced by
the initial system setting.
[000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
/ 000.000.000.000 / 1/step]
Specifies the IP address assigned to
the computer designated to function
5-845-008 IP Address (Secondary) *CTL
as the secondary delivery server of
Scan Router. This SP allows only the
setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Unknown
1: SG1 Accessory version
2: SG1 package version
5-845-009 Delivery Server Model *CTL 3: SG2 Accessory version
4: SG2 package version
Allows changing the model of the
delivery server registered by the I/O
device.
SM 5-167 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
Server Scheme (Primary) This is used for the scan router
5-845-013 *CTL
DFU program.
6 Character strings.
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
Server Port Number
5-845-014 *CTL This is used for the scan router
(Primary) DFU
program.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-168 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
Maintenance
Server URL Path Character strings 16byte.
5-845-015 *CTL
System
(Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router
program.
[- / - / -]
Server Scheme This is used for the scan router
5-845-016 *CTL
(Secondary) DFU program.
6 character strings.
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
Server Port Number
5-845-017 *CTL This is used for the scan router
(Secondary) DFU
program.
[- / - / -]
Server URL Path Character strings 16byte.
5-845-018 *CTL
(Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router
program.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Enables or disables the prevention
function for the continuous data
sending error.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
SM 5-169 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[UCS Setting]
5846
-
[- / - / -]
Displays the unique device ID in use
by the delivery server directory. The
Machine ID (For Delivery value is only Displayed and cannot be
5-846-001 *CTL
Server) changed. This ID is created from the
NIC MAC or IEEE 1394
EUI. The ID is displayed as either
6-byle or 8-byte binary.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Clears the unique ID of the device
used as the name in the file transfer
Machine ID Clear (for directory. Execute This SP if the
5-846-002 *CTL
Delivery Server) connection of the device to the
delivery server is unstable. After
clearing the ID, the ID will be
established again automatically by
cycling the machine off and on.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 / second]
Sets the interval for retry attempts
when the delivery server fails to
acquire the delivery server address
Delivery Server Retry
5-846-006 *CTL book.
Timer
0: retry OFF
Retry time x retry count has to be set
in 180second (SC reboot compatible
model).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-170 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1time/step]
Maintenance
Sets the number of retry attempts
System
when the delivery server fails to
acquire the delivery server address
Delivery Server Retry
5-846-007 *CTL book.
Times
0: retry OFF
Retry time x retry count has to be set
in a 180 seconds (SC reboot
compatible model).
[1 to 255 / 60 / 1/step]
5-846-010 LDAP Search Timeout *CTL Sets the length of the timeout for the
search of the LDAP server.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Uses certification information of
device login user.
5-846-021 Folder Auth Change *CTL 1: Uses certification information of
address.
This SP would be reflected after
rebooting the machine.
SM 5-171 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Transfers address book from SD/USB
Addr Book FlashROM to HDD when the model
5-846-040 CTL
Migraion(USB->HDD) has address book in SD/USB
FlashROM.
After the transfer, change its Model
that has address book in HDD.
[- / - / -]
5-846-041 Fill Addr Acl Info. CTL
[Execute]
[0 to 30 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays the slot number where an
address book data is in.
0: Unconfirmed
5-846-043 Addr Book Media *CTL 1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
4: USB Flash ROM
20: HDD
30: Nothing
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-172 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
Maintenance
[Execute]
5-846-047 Initialize Local Addr Book CTL
System
Clears the local address book
information, including the user code.
[- / - / -]
Initialize Delivery Addr [Execute]
5-846-048 CTL
Book Clears the distribution address book
information, except the user code.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-846-049 Initialize LDAP Addr Book CTL
Clears the LDAP address book
information, except the user code.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Clears the LDAP address book
information, except the user code.
5-846-050 Initialize All Addr Book CTL
However administrator account (login
ID & password) is not deleted.
Administrator account is set at
initialization of security setting.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-846-051 Backup All Addr Book CTL
Uploads all directory information to the
SD card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-846-052 Restore All Addr Book CTL
Downloads all directory information
from the SD card.
SM 5-173 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Deletes the address book data from
the SD card in the service slot.
Deletes only the files that were
uploaded from this machine.
This feature does not work if the card
5-846-053 Clear Backup Info CTL is write-protected.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-174 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
Use this SP to set the conditions for
System
password entry to access the local
address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the
password entry to upper case and sets
the length of the password.
5-846-062 Complexity option 1 *CTL
This SP does not normally
require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after
the system administrator has
set up a group password
policy to control access to the
address book.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the
password entry to lower case and sets
the length of the password.
5-846-063 Complexity Option 2 DFU *CTL
This SP does not normally
require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after
the system administrator has
set up a group password
policy to control access to the
address book.
SM 5-175 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the
password entry to numeric character
and sets the length of the password.
5-846-064 Complexity Option 3 DFU *CTL
This SP does not normally
require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after
the system administrator has
set up a group password
policy to control access to the
address book.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the
password entry to symbolic number
and sets the length of the password.
5-846-065 Complexity Option 4 DFU *CTL
This SP does not normally
require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after
the system administrator has
set up a group password
policy to control access to the
address book.
[0 to 255 / - / 1/step]
5-846-094 Encryption Stat *CTL Shows the status of the encryption
function for the address book data.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-176 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
1: Encryption in-operation. (in use) Encryption process finished.
System
2: Encryption ->plain text in-conversion in-combined treatment.
3: Plain-text->encryption in-conversion in-encryption.
4: Encryption-> Plain-text double sign is completed.
5: Plain-text-> Encryption is completed.
6: Security in-change Encryption key change in-process
7: Security change is completed Encryption key change is completed.
8: Previous security key change file default is completed.
9: C security key change is completed. Encryption key change is
completed.
[ 0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
5-847-002 Rate for Copy B&W Text *CTL
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x
[ 0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
5-847-003 Rate for Copy B&W Other *CTL
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x
SM 5-177 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[ 0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
5-847-005 Rate for Printer B&W *CTL
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x
[ 0 to 6 / 1 / 1/step]
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
Rate for Printer B&W 2: 1/3x
5-847-007 *CTL
1200dpi 3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
6: 2/3x
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
Sets the default value for the quality of
Network Quality Default JPEG images sent as NetFile pages.
5-847-021 *CTL
for JPEG This function is available only with the
MLB (Media Link Board) option
installed.
[Web Service]
5848-002 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting.
5848 Setting of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848-100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The
default is equal to 1 gigabyte.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-178 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
Access Control: 0000: access enabled
5-848-004 *CTL
System
udirectory (Lower 4bits) 0001: access disabled
0010: read only
SM 5-179 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Transfer OFF
5-848-217 Setting: Timing *CTL
1: Successively transfer
2: Regular transfer
[Installation Date]
5849
Displays or prints the installation date of the machine.
[- / - / -]
The Counter Clear Day has been
5-849-001 Display *CTL
changed to
Installation Date or Inst. Date.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Determines whether the installation
date is printed on the printout for the
5-849-002 Switch to Print *CTL
total counter.
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
5-849-003 Total Counter *CTL Displays total count value from
establishment data (SP5-849-001).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-180 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[Address Book Function] Japanes Use Only
5850
System
-
[Bluetooth]
5851
Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth unit. Press either key.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-851-001 Mode CTL 0: Public
1: Private
[- / - / -]
5-853-001 - CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-181 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable
1: Enable
When set to "1" allows reception of
firmware data via the local port (IEEE
5-856-002 Local Port CTL
1284) during a remote ROM update.
This setting is reset to zero after the
machine is cycled off and on.
Allows the technician to upgrade the
firmware using a parallel cable.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF
1: ON
5-857-001 On/Off *CTL
Switches the debug log feature on and
off. The debug log cannot be captured
until this feature is switched on.
[1 to 3 / 2/ 1/step]
1: IC card
2: HDD
3: SD card
5-857-002 Target(2:HDD 3:SD) *CTL
Selects the storage device to save
debug logs information when the
conditions set with SP5-858 are
satisfied.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-182 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[- / 20120101 / 1/step]
System
5-857-101 Debug Logging Start Date *CTL Sets start date of the debug log
output.
[- / 20371212 / 1/step]
5-857-102 Debug Logging End Date *CTL
Sets end date of the debug log output.
[- / - / -]
5-857-103 Acquire All Debug Logs *CTL [Execute]
Obtains all debug logs.
[- / - / -]
Acquire Only Controller
5-857-104 *CTL [Execute]
Debug Logs
Obtains controller debug log only.
[- / - / -]
Acquire Only Engine
5-857-105 *CTL [Execute]
Debug Logs
Obtains engine debug log only.
[- / - / -]
Acquire Only Opepanel [Execute]
5-857-107 *CTL
Debug Logs Outputs the controller debug log to the
media inserted front I/F
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-120 Make LogTrace Dir *CTL
Makes a folder for the log trace in the
SD card.
[- / - / -]
Get All Debug Logs Time [Execute]
5-857-151 *CTL
Dips Displays the total time to get the all
debug logs.
[- / - / -]
Get Controller Debug [Execute]
5-857-152 *CTL
Logs Time Dips Displays the total time to get the
controller debug logs.
SM 5-183 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
Get Engine Debug Logs [Execute]
5-857-153 *CTL
Time Disp Displays the total time to get the
engine debug logs.
[- / - / -]
Get Opepanel Debug [Execute]
5-857-154 *CTL
Logs Time Dips Displays the total time to get the
operation panel debug logs.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-155 Get SMC Time Dips *CTL
Displays the total time to get the SMC
data.
[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]
5860
-
[1 to 168 / 72 / 1hour/step]
Sets the amount of time to wait before
saving a mail that breaks up during
Partial Mail Receive
5-860-020 *CTL reception. The received mail is
Timeout
discarded if the remaining portion of
the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Determines whether RFC2.5298
compliance is switched on for MDN
reply mail.
MDN Response
5-860-021 *CTL 0: No
RFC2298 Compliance
1: Yes
Sends MAIL FROM SMTP Commands
as empty (<>) when conforming to
RFC2298.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-184 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
Determines whether the FROM item of
System
the mail header is switched to the
SMTP Auth. From Field
5-860-022 *CTL validated account after the SMTP
Replacement
server is validated.
0: No. From item not switched.
1: Yes. From item switched.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Selects the MIME header type of an
S/MIME: MIME Header E-mail sent by S/MIME.
5-860-026 *CTL
Setting 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: non-check, 1: check
S/MIME: Authentication
5-860-028 *CTL Specifies whether to check or
Check
non-check address certification at
sending S/MIME mail.
SM 5-185 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[E-Mail Report]
5866
This SP controls operation of the email notification function.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
5-866-001 Report Validity CTL
Enables or disables the e-mail
notification to @Remote.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
5-866-005 Add Date Field CTL
Disables and re-enables the addition
of a date field to the email notification.
[- / - / -]
5-870-001 Writing CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Initializes the set certification.
When the GW controller board is
replaced with a new one for repair, you
5-870-003 Initialize CTL must execute the "Initiralize (-003)"
and "Writing (-001)" just after the new
board replacement.
NOTE: Turn off and on the main power
switch after the "Initialize (-003)" and
"Writing (-001)" have been done.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-870-004 Writing: 2048bit CTL
Writes the authentication data used for
@Remote into the flash ROM.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-186 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[SDCardAppliMove]
5873
System
Allows you to move applications from one SD card to another.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
This SP copies the application
5-873-001 MoveExec CTL
programs from the original SD card in
SD card slot 2 to an SD card in SD
card slot 1.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
This SP copies back the application
programs from an SD card in SD Card
5-873-002 UndoExec CTL Slot 2 to the original SD card in SD
card slot 1. Use this menu when you
have mistakenly copied some
programs by using "Move Exec"
(SP5873-1).
SM 5-187 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Enables or disables the automatic
reboot function when an SC error
occurs.
0: The machine reboots automatically
when the machine issues an SC error
5-875-001 Reboot Setting *CTL and logs the SC error code. If the
same SC occurs again, the machine
does not reboot.
1: The machine does not reboot when
an SC error occurs.
The reboot is not executed for Type A
or C SC codes.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
This setting determines how the
machine reboots after an SC code is
5-875-002 Reboot Type *CTL
issued.
0: Manual reboot
1: Automatic reboot.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-188 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[Option Setup]
System
5878 This SP enables the DOS application (Data Overwrite Security). Do this SP
after installing Data Overwrite Security Unit.)
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Enables the Data Overwrite Security
5-878-001 Data Overwrite Security CTL
unit. Press "EXECUTE" on the
operation panel. Then reboot the
machine.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-878-002 HDD Encryption CTL Enables the Copy Data Security unit.
Press "EXECUTE" on the operation
panel. Then reboot the machine.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Installation Process
1: Put the SD card in the SD slot
(service slot), then start the device.
2: Execute SP5-878-004.
3: Reboot the machine.
4: Execute SP5-878-004.
*This SP executes linking SD card and
copying OCR dictionary.
5-878-004 OCR Dictionary CTL
Step 2 executes linking SD card, and
Step 4 executes copying dictionary.
And be sure to turn Off the main power
supply between step 2 (linking SD
card) and step 4 (copying dictionary).
* OCR dictionary is able to overwrite.
Overwrite process is same as initial
installation process.
Use new SD card to execute
Installation process 1 to 4.
SM 5-189 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
5-879-001 - *CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-881-001 - *CTL
[Execute]
[CPM Set]
5885
Sets access control for document box on Web Image Monitor.
[8bit / 00000000 / -]
Sets access control for document box
on Web Image Monitor.
bit0: Forbid all document sever access
(1)
bit1: Forbid user mode access (1)
5-885-020 DocSvr Acc Ctrl *CTL
bit2: Forbid print function (1)
bit3: Forbid fax TX (1)
bit4: Forbid scan sending (1)
bit5: Forbid downloading (1)
bit6: Forbid delete (1)
bit7: Reserved
[0 to 2 / 0 /1/step]
0: Thumbnail
1: Icon
5-885-050 DocSvr Format *CTL
2: Detail
Sets the default display format for
document list in document box.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1/step]
Sets the default display number of
5-885-051 DocSvr Trans *CTL
items per page in the document list in
document box.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-190 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
Sets whether to put signature or not
5-885-100 Set Signature *CTL
System
when transferring mails that is
scanned and stored from WIM.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Determines whether the scanned
5-885-101 Set Encrypsion *CTL documents with the WIM are
encrypted when they are transmitted
by an e-mail.
[8bit / 00000000 / -]
Controls memory leak detection of
Web Image Monitor.
5-885-200 Detect Mem Leak *CTL Changed value of this SP will be
available when displaying document
list in document box on a new HTTP
session.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Version check for package firmware
1: No version check for package
firmware
When selecting "0", only new firmware
5-886-100 Skip Version Chech - against the firmware in the machine is
updated at the package firmware
updating.
Do not change this setting to "1"
normally. The setting "1" is only used
for a special order.
SM 5-191 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Version check for indivisual firmware
1: No version check for indivisual
firmware
When selecting "0", indivisual firmware
5-886-101 Skip LR Chech -
in the machine is not updated at the
package firmware updating.
Do not change this setting to "1"
normally. The setting "1" is only used
for a special order.
[SD GetCounter]
This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated.
This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower
slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in a folder created in the root
5887 directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text
file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the machine.
1. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).
2. Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].
3. Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.
[- / - / -]
5-887-001 - *CTL
[Execute]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No authentication, No protection for
5-888-001 - *CTL logs
1: No authentication, Protected logs
(only an administrator can see the logs)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-192 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[Engine Log Upload] DFU
System
5900
For design use. Do not change.
SM 5-193 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-194 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
Depress enter key (#) after choosing
System
5-907-001 - *CTL number.
The act of displayed maker name and
model name is changed this time.
[data]
Do not enter maker name and model
name imperfectly at every word and
every phrase. If it has wrong word, it
cannot plug and play understandably.
So we check the characters fully, the
text is single byte character or double
character? Is it space or under score?
Is it capital letter or small letter?
You have to check requirements
specification fully.
5-907-001 - *CTL notice of entering following select
parameter
SM 5-195 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[3 to 30 / 3 / 1/step]
Sets the amount of time to elapse while
the machine is in standby mode (and
5-913-002 Print Application Timer *CTL
the operation panel keys have not been
used) before another application can
gain control of the display.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Enables and disables the document
server. This is a security measure that
prevents image data from being left in
5-967-001 (0:ON 1:OFF) *CTL
the temporary area of the HDD. After
changing this setting, you must switch
the main switch off and on to enable the
new setting.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 0.1mm/step]
5-973-101 Frame deletion setting *CTL Sets the margin for the user stamp
registration for each edge of paper.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-196 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
Maintenance
[Cherry Server]
5974
System
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Light version
1: Full version
5-974-001 (0:Light 1:Full) *CTL
Selects which version of the Scan
Router application program, "Light" or
"Full (Professional)", is installed.
[Device Setting]
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this
5985
SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB
functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[- / - / -]
5-990-001 All (Data List) CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-002 SP (Mode Data List) CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-003 User Program CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-004 Logging Data CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-005 Diagnostic Report CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-197 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
5-990-006 Non-Default CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-007 NIB Summary CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-008 Capture Log CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-021 Copier User Program CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-022 Scanner SP CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-023 Scanner User Program CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-024 SDK/J Summary CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-025 SDK/J Application Info CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-990-026 Printer SP CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-001 All (Data List) CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-002 SP (Mode Data List) CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-003 User Program CTL [Execute]
This SP for only MFP model.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-198 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP5000-3
[- / - / -]
5-992-004 Logging Data CTL
Maintenance
[Execute]
System
[- / - / -]
5-992-005 Diagnostic Report CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-006 Non-Default CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-007 NIB Summary CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-008 Capture Log CTL [Execute]
This SP for only MFP model.
[- / - / -]
5-992-021 Copier User Program CTL [Execute]
This SP for only MFP model.
[- / - / -]
5-992-022 Scanner SP CTL [Execute]
This SP for only MFP model.
[- / - / -]
5-992-023 Scanner User Program CTL [Execute]
This SP for only MFP model.
[- / - / -]
5-992-024 SDK/J Summary CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-025 SDK/J Application Info CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-992-026 Printer SP mode CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-199 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Side-to-Side Regist:
*ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Front
6-006-001 Adjusts the main scan registeration of the front original for ADF.
Side-to-Side Regist:
*ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Rear
6-006-002 Adjusts the main scan registeration of the rear original for ADF.
Leading Edge
*ENG [-5.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Registration: Front
Adjusts the DFGATE assert timing of the front original for ADF.
6-006-003 If the leading edge margin of image is wide, increase value.
Leading Edge
*ENG [-5.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Registration: Rear
Adjusts the DFGATE assert timing of the rear original for ADF.
6-006-004 If the leading edge margin of image is wide, increase value.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-200 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
Buckle: Duplex Front *ENG [-5.0 to 5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
System
Adjusts the buckle amount (skew correct amount) of the front original for
ADF.
6-006-005 If the original skew is unacceptable, increase value.
Adjusts the buckle amount (skew correct amount) of the rear original for
ADF.
6-006-006 If the original skew is unacceptable, increase value.
Rear Edge Erase Front *ENG [-10.0 to 10.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Adjusts the DFGATE negate timing of the front original for ADF.
If the trailing edge of the front original has the shadow, use this SP to erase
6-006-007 it.
Value increase: Dereases scanning range of the trailing edge of
original.
Value decrease: Increases scanning range of the trailing edge of
original.
Rear Edge Erase Rear *ENG [-10.0 to 10.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Adjusts the DFGATE negate timing of the rear original for ADF.
If the trailing edge of the rear original has the shadow, use this SP to erase
6-006-008 it.
Value increase: Dereases scanning range of the trailing edge of
original.
Value decrease: Increases scanning range of the trailing edge of
original.
SM 5-201 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
6-006-010 For SPDF models only. Adjusts the leading edge registration of the front
original for SPDF.
Value Increase: Registration start timing is later.
Value decrease: Registration start timing is earlier.
6-006-011 For SPDF models only. Adjusts the leading edge registration of the rear
original for SPDF.
Value Increase: Registration start timing is later.
Value decrease: Registration start timing is earlier.
For SPDF models only. Adjusts the buckle amount (skew correct amount)
6-006-012 of the front original for SPDF.
6-006-013 For SPDF models only. Adjusts the buckle amount (skew correct amount)
For SPDF models only. Adjusts the erase margin of the front side at the
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-202 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
T-Edge Erase (1-Pass):
*ENG [-5.0 to 5.0 / -1.5 / 0.1 mm/step]
System
Rear
6-006-015 For SPDF models only. Adjusts the erase margin of the rear side at the
original trailing edge for SPDF.
Value increase: add trailing edge to image.
Value decrease: erases trailing edge of image.
SM 5-203 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Sets to judge as witch original size for two original sizes that can not be
6016 judged with ADF. Size of each bit is different depending on region. Set
corresponding bit to "0" when to prior the default size. Set "1" to let the
switching size judge.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-020-001 - *ENG 0: Small sizes (B6, A5, HLT)
1: All sizes
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-204 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
[Sub-scanPunchPosAdj:2K/3K FIN]
System
Adjusts the punch position in the sub scan direction.
[Main-scanPunchPosAdj:2K/3K FIN]
SM 5-205 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[SkewCorrectBuckleAdj:2K/3K FIN]
6102 Adjusts the skew correction amount in the punch mode for each paper size.
Adjusts value to -: Buckling amount decreases
Adjusts value to +: Buckling amount increases.
Adjusts the skew correction amount in the punch mode for non specified
6-102-017 paper.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-206 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
[SkewCorrectCtrlSW:2K/3K FIN]
System
6103 Enables or disables the skew correction in the punch mode for each paper
size.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Other ENG 0: BuckleAdj On
Enables or disables the skew correction in the punch mode for non
specified paper.
SM 5-207 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[ShiftTrayJogPosAdj:2K/3K FIN]
6104
These SPs are not used for the finisher D688/D689.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-208 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
[ShftTJogRtrctAngAdj:2K/3K FIN]
System
6105
These SPs are not used for the finisher D688/D689.
SM 5-209 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-106-014 Other ENG 0: Jogging On
1: Jogging Off
[JogPosAdj(CrnrStplr):2K/3K FIN]
Adjusts the width (main scan direction) of the jogger fences on the corner
stapling unit for each paper size.
6107 Adjusts value to -: Width between jogger fences becomes shorter
than the default value.
Adjusts value to +: Width between jogger fences becomes wider than
the default value.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-210 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Adjusts the width (main scan direction) of the jogger fences on the corner
Maintenance
stapling unit for non specified paper.
System
Adjusts value to -: Width between jogger fences becomes shorter
than the default value.
Adjusts value to +: Width between jogger fences becomes wider than
the default value.
[JogPosAdj(BookStplr):2K/3K FIN]
Adjusts the width (main scan direction) of the jogger fences on the booklet
stapling unit for each paper size.
6108 Adjusts value to -: Width between jogger fences becomes shorter
than the default value.
Adjusts value to +: Width between jogger fences becomes wider than
the default value.
SM 5-211 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[CrnrStplrJogTimeAdj:2K/3K FIN]
6109 Adjusts the jogging times of the jogger fences on the corner stapling unit
for each paper size.
[BookStplrJogTimeAdj:2K/3K FIN]
6110 Adjusts the jogging times of the jogger fences on the booklet stapling unit
for each paper size.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-212 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
6-110-007 LT SEF ENG
System
6-110-008 12x18 ENG
Adjusts the staple position of the corner stapling unit in the main scan
direction for each paper size.
6111 Adjusting value to -: Staple position moves toward the front side of
machine.
Adjusting value to +: Staple position moves toward the rear side of
machine.
SM 5-213 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[BookletStaplerPosAdj:2K/3K FIN]
Adjusts the staple position of the booklet stapling unit in the sub scan
direction for each paper size.
6112 Adjusting value to -: Staple position moves toward the trailing edge of
paper.
Adjusting value to +: Staple position moves toward the leading edge
of paper.
[BookletFolderPosAdj:2K/3K FIN]
Adjusts the folding position of the booklet stapling unit in the sub scan
direction for each paper size.
6113 Adjusting value to -: Folding position moves toward the trailing edge
of paper.
Adjusting value to +: Folding position moves toward the leading edge
of paper.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-214 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
6-113-006 LG SEF ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.2mm/step]
System
6-113-007 LT SEF ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.2mm/step]
Adjusts the folding speed (extra folding time) of booklet stapling unit for
SM 5-215 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[CrnrStplrMxPrstkShAdj:2K/3KFIN]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-216 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
Maintenance
[BookStplrMxPrstkShAdj:2K/3KFIN]
System
Adjusts the maximum number of the pre-stack sheets on the booklet
stapling unit for each paper size.
6117 Adjust value: 0; 3 sheets pre-stack (standard)
Adjust value: -1; 2 sheets pre-stack
Adjust value: -2; 1 sheet pre-stack
Adjust value: -3 to -7; no pre-stack.
SM 5-217 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-1
[CrnrStplrPrstkOffsAdj:2K/3KFIN]
Adjusts the pre-stack offset amount between stacked paper on the corner
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-218 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
System
5.10.1 SP6-XXX (PERIPHERALS)
[BookStplrPrstkOffsAdj:2K/3KFIN]
SM 5-219 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
[CrnStpPosExFeedAmtAdj:2K/3KFIN]
6120 Adjusts over sending amount (sub scan direction) of positioning roller
when edge stitching specified paper.
Other ENG
6-120-014 Adjusts over sending amount (sub scan direction) of positioning roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-220 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
[BkFoldJogSolMovAmtAdj:2K/3KFIN]
System
Adjusts move amount of saddle stitch conformity claw when saddle
6122 stitching specified paper.
Adjusts value to +: towards up
Adjusts value to -: towards down
Other ENG
SM 5-221 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
[Sub-scan PunchPosAdj:FrontFIN]
6130 Adjusting value to -: hole position moves toward trailing edge of paper
when intaking.
Adjusting value to +: hole position moves toward leading edge of
paper when intaking.
Domestic
6-130-001 *ENG
2Hole(Europe 2Hole)
[Main-scan PunchPosAdj:FrontFIN]
Domestic
6-131-001 *ENG
2Hole(Europe 2Hole)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-222 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
[Jogger Fence Fine Adj:FrontFIN]
System
Adjusts width (main scan direction) of edge stitch jogger when running
specified paper conformity.
6132 Adjusts value to -: move towards jogger width is tighter than base
value.
Adjusts value to +: move towards jogger width is wider than base
value.
SM 5-223 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Adjusts staple position (main scan direction) for the near side parallel
stitch/ far side parallel stitch of specified paper.
6133 Adjusting value to -: staple position moves toward front side of
machine.
Adjusting value to +: staple position moves toward rear side of
machine.
Adjusts staple position (main scan direction) for near side trailing edge
parallel stitch / far side trailing edge parallel stitch.
6140 Adjusting value to -: staple position moves toward front side of
machine.
Adjusting value to +: staple position moves toward rear side of
machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-224 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
6-141-002 B4 SEF ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.2mm/step]
System
6-141-003 A4 SEF ENG [-3.0 to 3.0 / 0.0 / 0.2mm/step]
6142 Adjusting value to -: hole position moves toward trailing edge of paper
when intaking.
Adjusting value to +: hole position moves toward leading edge of
paper when intaking.
SM 5-225 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-226 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
Adjusts position of width direction (main scan direction) for punch.
System
6144 Adjusting value to -: hole position moves toward front side of
machine.
Adjusting value to +: hole position moves toward rear side of
machine.
SM 5-227 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Adjusts the skew correction bending amount when punching except the
6-145-017 specified paper.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-001 A3 SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-002 B4 SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-003 A4 SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-004 A4 LEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-005 B5 SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-228 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
6-146-006 B5 LEF ENG 0: enable
System
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-007 A5 LEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-008 DLT SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-009 LG SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-010 LT SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-011 LT LEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-012 HLT LEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-013 12x18 ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-014 8K SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-015 16K SEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
SM 5-229 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-146-016 16K LEF ENG 0: enable
1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Other ENG 0: enable
6-146-017 1: disable
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-230 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
[Fold Times Adj: 1K FIN]
System
6148
Adjusts extra folding times (time) for folding when saddle stitching.
[PositioningStrtTimingAdj:1KFIN]
SM 5-231 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Other ENG
[PosTimeAdj(LstPr2ndTime):1KFIN]
[PosTiAdj(ExcLstPr3rdTi):1KFIN]
6152 Adjust positioning time for specified paper except the last sheet 2nd time.
Adjusts the value to -: shortens the positioning time
Adjusts the value to +: extends the positioning time
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-232 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
6-152-009 LT SEF ENG [-100 to 100 / 0 / 10msec/step]
System
6-152-010 LT LEF ENG [-100 to 100 / 0 / 10msec/step]
Adjust positioning time for other than the specified paper except the last
6-152-015 sheet 2nd time.
SM 5-233 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
6180 [M-ScanBindPosAdj:NoStplBindFIN]
6-180-001 Adjusts the position of width direction (main scan direction) for binding.
Value increase: The bind position moves toward outside of sheets.
Value decrease: The bind position moves toward inside of sheets.
6181 [BindSpeedSetting:NoStplBindFIN]
- ENG [1 to 3 / 3 / 2/step]
6-181-001 Improves the noise for bind finishing by adjusting the bind speed.
1: Bind Spd1(L) (Low noise mode)
3: Bind Speed 3 (Productivity mode)
6182 [ExitSpeedSwitch:NoStplBindFIN]
Adjusts the paper exit speed to align the stacked sheets properly.
Value increase: increases the paper exit speed.
Value decrease: decreases the paper exit speed.
1:Exit Spd1(L)
2:Exit Speed 2
3:Exit Speed 3
4:Exit Speed 4
5:Exit Speed 5(High)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-234 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
Maintenance
6-182-005 PaperLength:210.0-296.9mm,Plain(60-105g/m2) ENG [1 to 5 / 2 / 1/step]
System
6-182-006 PaperLength:210.0-296.9mm,Thin(52-59g/m2) ENG [1 to 5 / 4 / 1/step]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
- *ENG 0: No
6-801-001 1: Yes
SM 5-235 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP6000-2
[Extra]
More than the standard number of sheets can be stapled. This SP sets the
additional number of sheets (This Setting + Standard Number = maximum
number of sheets).
If the number of the maximum for staples is increased, and the
6830 mechanical warranty of the unit can be guaranteed, then the setting
can take effect without changing the controller software.
However, assurance that mechanical performance can be guaranteed is
required before changing the setting to increase the staple load for more
than the maximum in the feed/exit specifications. Raising this setting
without quality assurance could damage the machine.
Saddles 0 to 50 (Initial:
6-830-002 *CTL [0 to 50 / 0 / 1/step]
0)
Half-Fold 0 to 50 (Initial:
6-830-003 *CTL [0 to 50 / 0 / 1/step]
0)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-236 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
System
5.11.1 SP7-XXX (DATA LOG)
[Total SC]
7401
Displays the number of SC codes detected.
[SC History]
Logs the SC codes detected.
7403
The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen,
but can be seen on the SMC (logging) outputs.
SM 5-237 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-238 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7504 Displays the number of jams according to the location where jams were
System
detected.
SM 5-239 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-240 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-504-109 Exit Guide Plate Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
7-504-110 Stapler Shift Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
S-to-S Registration
7-504-116 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Move Motor
Horizontal Transport
7-504-152 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: On
Horizontal Transport
7-504-153 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: Off
Switchback Transport
7-504-154 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: On
Switchback Transport
7-504-155 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: Off
SM 5-241 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Horizontal Transport
7-504-160 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Motor
Pre-Stack Transport
7-504-161 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-242 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
Saddle Stitch Stapler
7-504-176 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
Jog SOL Motor
Dynamic Roller
7-504-179 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Transport Mt
SM 5-243 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Exit
7-504-222 Transport/Positioning *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Roller Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-244 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-504-231 Punch Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
7-504-232 Stack Transport Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Scanning Entrance
7-505-015 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
Sn:On
Scanning Entrance
7-505-065 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
Sn:Off
SM 5-245 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-246 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-507-002 Latest 1 *CTL [- / - / -]
System
7-507-003 Latest 2 *CTL [- / - / -]
SM 5-247 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-248 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-509-052 Staple Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
System
7-509-053 Feed-Out: Off *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
SM 5-249 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-250 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-514-103 Transport: Off *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
7-514-104 Paper Exit *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Horizontal Transport
7-514-152 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: On
HorizontalTransportSenor:
7-514-153 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Off
SM 5-251 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Switchback Transport
7-514-154 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: On
Switchback Transport
7-514-155 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Sensor: Off
Horizontal Transport
7-514-160 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-252 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
Corner Stapler Move
7-514-173 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
Motor
SM 5-253 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Exit Transport/Positioning
7-514-222 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
Roller Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-254 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Maintenance
7-514-226 Feed Out Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
System
7-514-227 Output Tray Motor *CTL [0000 to 9999 / - / 1/step]
SM 5-255 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-1
Scanning Entrance
7-515-015 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
Sn:On
Scanning Entrance
7-515-065 *CTL [0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
Sn:Off
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-256 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
System
5.12.1 SP7-XXX (DATA LOG)
SM 5-257 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-258 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
[Update Log]
System
7520 Displays error history of firmware update in the past 10 times. [-001] is the
latest error history, and [-010] is the most old error history.
SM 5-259 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
[- / - / - ]
[Execute]
Clears the counter of SP7617-001.
7-618-001 Normal *CTL
Push [Execute] to clear the parts
replacement alarm counter for the
main machine.
[- / - / - ]
[Execute]
Clears the counter of SP7617-002.
7-618-002 Df *CTL
Push [Execute] to clear the parts
replacement alarm counter for the
ADF.
Cleaner:Charge
7-621-019 ENG [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
Roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-260 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
Bearing:Development
7-621-028 ENG [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
System
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-621-119 ENG [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
Roller
Cleaner:Charge
7-622-019 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Roller
SM 5-261 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Bearing:Development
7-622-028 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-622-119 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Roller
Cleaner:Charge
7-624-019 ENG
Roller [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-262 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
7-624-025 Development Filter ENG
System
Bearing:Development
7-624-028 ENG
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-624-119 ENG
Roller
Bearing:Development
ENG [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1page]
Screw
7-625-028
Displays the page counter for the previous development mixing auger
bearings.
Bearing:Development
ENG [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1page]
Screw
7-626-028
Displays the page counter for the 2nd previous development mixing auger
bearings.
SM 5-263 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
7-801-255 - CTL -
[- / - / - ]
7-804-001 Paper CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / - ]
7-807-001 - CTL
[Execute]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-264 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
[MF Error Counter]
7826
System
Displays the number of counts requested of the card/key counter.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
A request for the count total failed at
7-826-001 Error Total *CTL
power on. This error will occur if the
device is installed but disconnected.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
The request for a staple count failed
7-826-002 Error Staple *CTL
at power on. This error will occur if the
device is installed but disconnected.
[- / - / - ]
7-827-001 - CTL
[Execute]
[- / - / - ]
7-832-001 - CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-265 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Dust Detection
*ENG [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
Counter
001 Records the times detecting dust at all points of front side scan position.
When there is a dust even when before starting the next job, consider as
same dust and doesn't count. Counts when SP4-020-001: DF scan glass
part dust detect front is ON.
002 For checking front side scan position move effect. Counts the times that
strips were avoided by detecting dust and move the sheet thrugh DF scan
position. Counts when SP4-020-001: DF scan glass part dust detect front
is ON.
Dust Detection
*ENG [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
Counter: Back
003 For Single Path simultaneous duplex models only. Records the times
detecting dust at all points of rear side scan position. When there is a
same dust even when before starting the next job, consider as same dust
and doesn't count. * Counts when SP4-020-011: DF
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-266 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
[Assert Info.]
Maintenance
7901 Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. Used for
System
debugging.
Cleaner:Charge
7-942-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-942-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Screw
SM 5-267 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Bearing:Pressure
7-942-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
Cleaner:Charge
7-944-019 *ENG [0 to 4294967295 / 0 / 1mm/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-944-028 *ENG [0 to 4294967295 / 0 / 1mm/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-944-119 *ENG [0 to 4294967295 / 0 / 1mm/step]
Roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-268 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
[Remain Day Counter: Pages]
System
7951
-
Cleaner:Charge
7-951-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-951-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-951-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
SM 5-269 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Cleaner:Charge
7-952-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-952-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-952-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-270 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
[PM Counter Display: Pages (%)]
System
7954
-
Cleaner:Charge
7-954-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-954-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-954-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
SM 5-271 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Cleaner:Charge
7-955-019 ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-955-028 ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-955-119 ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
Roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-272 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
[Estimated Remain Days]
System
7956
-
Cleaner:Charge
7-956-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-956-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-956-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 255 / 1day/step]
Roller
SM 5-273 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Cleaner:Charge
7-960-019 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
Bearing:Development
7-960-028 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Screw
Bearing:Pressure
7-960-119 ENG [0 to 255 / 0 / 1%/step]
Roller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-274 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP7000-2
Maintenance
7970 [Cumulative Counter]
System
Rotation:Opc Drive
*ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1m/step]
7-970-001 Unit
Rotation:Fusing
*ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1m/step]
7-970-008 Drive Unit
Count:Paper
Transfer On-Off *ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
7-970-010 Drive Unit
Page:Feed Drive
*ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
7-970-011 Unit
Page:Registration
*ENG [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1page/step]
7-970-012 Drive Unit
SM 5-275 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
SP8401 to SP8406 The number of pages printed from the document server
SP8691 to SP8696 The number of pages sent from the document server
C: Copy application.
S: Scan application.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-276 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
The L: counters work differently case by case.
System
Sometimes, they count jobs/pages stored on the
document server; this can be in document server
mode (from the document server window), or from
Local storage
L: another mode, such as from a printer driver or by
(document server)
pressing the Store File button in the Copy mode
window. Sometimes, they include occasions when
the user uses a file that is already on the document
server. Each counter will be discussed case by
case.
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on
the small LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations
below and refer to it again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
Apl Application
Bk Black
C Cyan
SM 5-277 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Comb Combine
Comp Compression
Deliv Delivery
Emul Emulation
FC Full Color
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does
not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts
GPC
up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page
job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g.
ImgEdt
border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
K Black (YMCK)
Mag Magnification
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-278 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor
System
NRS machines remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in
Japan.
PC Personal Computer
Ppr Paper
Rez Resolution
Scn Scan
S-to-Email Scan-to-E-mail
Svr Server
SM 5-279 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
All of the Group 8 SPs are able to reset by SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.
8003 [F:Total Jobs] *CTL Note: The L: counter is the total number
of times the other applications are used
8004 [P:Total Jobs] *CTL to send a job to the document server,
8005 [S:Total Jobs] *CTL plus the number of times a file already
on the document server is used.
8006 [L:Total Jobs] *CTL
These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages
processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer
using the SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is
counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not
(the document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are
not counted separately).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-280 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission
Maintenance
System
has been completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a
print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters
both increments.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server,
only the L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server,
only the L: counter increments.
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments.
However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter
increments.
[T:Jobs/LS] *CTL
8011 These SPs count the number of jobs
stored to the document server by each
8012 [C:Jobs/LS] *CTL
application, to reveal how local storage
8013 [F:Jobs/LS] *CTL is being used for input.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
8014 [P:Jobs/LS] *CTL
The L: counter counts the number of
8015 [S:Jobs/LS] *CTL jobs stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8016 [L:Jobs/LS] *CTL
panel.
8017 [O:Jobs/LS] *CTL
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter
document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
SM 5-281 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C:
counter increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document
server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both
increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S:
counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the
L: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are
printed with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web
Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-282 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
8031 [T:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL
System
These SPs reveal what applications
8032 [C:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL
were used to output documents from
8033 [F:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL the document server.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
8034 [P:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL
The L: counter counts the number of
8035 [S:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL jobs printed from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8036 [L:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL
panel.
8037 [O:Pjob/DesApl] *CTL
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the
application that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor,
etc.) the L: counter increments.
8041 [T:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL These SPs count the applications that
stored files on the document server that
8042 [C:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL
were later accessed for transmission
8043 [F:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL over the telephone line or over a
network (attached to an e-mail, or as a
8044 [P:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL
fax image by I-Fax).
8045 [S:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
Note: Jobs merged for sending are
8046 [L:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL
counted separately.
The L: counter counts the number of
jobs scanned from within the document
8047 [O:TX Jobs/LS] *CTL
server mode screen at the operation
panel.
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as
an e-mail, the O: counter increments.
SM 5-283 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
8051 [T:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL These SPs count the applications used
to send files from the document server
8052 [C:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL
over the telephone line or over a
8053 [F:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL network (attached to an e-mail, or as a
fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for
8054 [P:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL
sending are counted separately.
8055 [S:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of
8056 [L:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL
jobs sent from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8057 [O:TX Jobs/DesApl] *CTL
panel.
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O:
counter increments.
[T:FIN Jobs]
8061 These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
[C:FIN Jobs]
8062 These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
[F:FIN Jobs]
8063 These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
[P:FIN Jobs]
8064 These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-284 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[S:FIN Jobs]
System
8065 These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is
specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.
[L:FIN Jobs]
8066 These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified
from the print window within document server mode.
[O:FIN Jobs]
8067 These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external
application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
004 Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the machine is in staple mode, the
005 Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for
folding (Z-fold).
006 Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job, the
SM 5-285 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
[T:Jobs/PGS]
8071 These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in
the job, regardless of which application was used.
[C:Jobs/PGS]
8072 These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the
number of pages in the job.
[F:Jobs/PGS]
8073 These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the
number of pages in the job.
[P:Jobs/PGS]
8074 These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the
number of pages in the job.
[S:Jobs/PGS]
8075 These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the
number of pages in the job.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-286 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[L:Jobs/PGS]
System
8076 These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of
pages in the job.
[O:Jobs/PGS]
8077 These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web
Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server
mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the
time the error occurs.
SM 5-287 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the
number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of
pages of the copy job (SP 8072).
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is
counted.
[T:FAX TX Jobs]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by
8111 fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a
telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8113 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by
fax directly on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-288 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[T:IFAX TX Jobs]
System
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent,
8121 either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images
using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8123 These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not
stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
SM 5-289 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
[T:S-to-Email Jobs]
8131 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned
and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was
used or not.
8135 These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and
attached to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-290 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[T:Deliv Jobs/Svr]
System
8141 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned
and sent to a Scan Router server.
8145 These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in
scanner mode and sent to a Scan Router server.
SM 5-291 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
[T:Deliv Jobs/PC]
8151 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned
and sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
[S:Deliv Jobs/PC]
8155 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned
and sent with Scan-to-PC.
8161 [T:PCFAX TX Jobs] *CTL These SPs count the number of PC Fax
transmission jobs. A job is counted from
when it is registered for sending, not
when it is sent.
8163 [F:PCFAX TX Jobs] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
Note: At the present time, these
counters perform identical counts.
This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to
the destination from the PC through the copier.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-292 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[T:Deliv Jobs/WSD/DSM]
System
8171
These SPs count the pages scanned by WS.
[S:Deliv Jobs/WSD/DSM]
8175
These SPs count the pages scanned by WS.
8192 [C:Total Scan PGS] *CTL These SPs count the pages scanned by
each application that uses the scanner
8193 [F:Total Scan PGS] *CTL
to scan images.
8195 [S:Total Scan PGS] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical
pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
SM 5-293 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S:
count is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File
button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for
8201 scan and copy jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission
are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for
8203 fax transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for
8205 scan jobs only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are
not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
8211 [T:Scan PGS/LS] *CTL These SPs count the number of pages
scanned into the document server.
8212 [C:Scan PGS/LS] *CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
8213 [F:Scan PGS/LS] *CTL The L: counter counts the number of
pages stored from within the document
8215 [S:Scan PGS/LS] *CTL
server mode screen at the operation
panel, and with the Store File button
8216 [L:Scan PGS/LS] *CTL
from within the Copy mode screen
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-294 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
System
If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.
If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.
If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6
and the L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
8221 These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back
side scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count
is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The
front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.)
002 With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is
the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting.
Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
SM 5-295 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
[Scan PGS/Mode]
8231 These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to
determine the work load on the ADF.
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the
original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is
enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with
SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-296 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[T:Scan PGS/Org] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step
System
8241 These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all
jobs, regardless of which application was used.
8246 These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File
button from within the Copy mode screen
SM 5-297 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
8251 [T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] *CTL These SPs show how many times
Image Edit features have been selected
8252 [C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] *CTL
at the operation panel for each
8255 [S:Scan PGS/ImgEdr] *CTL application. Some examples of these
editing features are:
8256 [L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] *CTL
Erase> Border
8257 [O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] *CTL Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
Note: The count totals the number of
times the edit features have been used.
A detailed breakdown of exactly which
features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen
at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8281 [T:Scan PGS/TWAIN] *CTL These SPs count the number of pages
scanned using a TWAIN driver. These
counters reveal how the TWAIN driver
is used for delivery functions.
8285 [S:Scan PGS/TWAIN] *CTL [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
Note: At the present time, these
counters perform identical counts.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-298 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
8291 [T:Scan PGS/Stamp] *CTL These SPs count the number of pages
System
stamped with the stamp in the ADF unit.
8293 [F:Scan PGS/Stamp] *CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
The L: counter counts the number of
pages stored from within the document
8295 [S:Scan PGS/Stamp] *CTL server mode screen at the operation
panel, and with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen
[T:Scan PGS/Size]
8301 These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all
applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-441].
[C:Scan PGS/Size]
8302 These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-442].
[F:Scan PGS/Size]
8303 These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-443].
[S:Scan PGS/Size]
8305 These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-445].
SM 5-299 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
[L:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from
8306 within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the
Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to
compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446].
8311 These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-300 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
S: Scan PGS/Rez *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
System
8315 These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by
applications that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is
counted as 2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted
for the application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the
following pages are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
SM 5-301 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
8391 These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-302 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
System
8421 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
[C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8422 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the copier application.
[F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8423 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the fax application.
[P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8424 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the printer application.
[S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8425 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by the scanner application.
[L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8426 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window
at the operation panel.
[O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8427 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of
pages processed for printing by Other applications
SM 5-303 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-304 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve
Maintenance
System
their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
SM 5-305 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Booklet Magazine
1 1 1 1
2 2 2 2
3 2 3 2
4 2 4 2
5 3 5 4
6 4 6 4
7 4 7 4
8 4 8 4
[T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8431 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below, regardless of which application was used.
[C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8432 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the copy application.
[P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8434 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the print application.
[L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8436 These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below.
8437 [O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-306 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
Maintenance
below with Other applications.
System
Cover/Slip Sheet *CTL [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
001 Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The count for a cover printed
002 The number of pages printed in series (one side) or printed as a book with
003 The number of pages printed where stamps were applied, including page
[T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8441 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all
applications.
[C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8442 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy
application.
[F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8443 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax
application.
[P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8444 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
printer application.
[S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8445 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
scanner application.
SM 5-307 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within
the document server mode window at the operation panel.
[O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8447 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other
applications.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-308 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-1
Maintenance
[PrtPGS/Ppr Tray]
System
8451
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
Bypass Tray
001 Bypass Tray *CTL
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
LCT (Option)
006 Tray 5 *CTL
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
SM 5-309 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is
8461 based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed
rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a
page printed on one side counts as 1.
[C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8462 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
application.
[F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8463 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax
application.
[P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8464 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer
application.
[L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8466 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-310 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
007 OHP *CTL [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
System
008 Other *CTL [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
[PrtPGS/Mag]
8471
These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but
performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification
adjustment as well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document
server are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are
counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate
of 100%.
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature
switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print
application.
SM 5-311 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[T:PrtPGS/Emul]
8511 These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.
[P:PrtPGS/Emul]
8514 These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
printed.
016 XPS - -
SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-312 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
[T:PrtPGS/FIN]
System
8521 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all
applications.
[C:PrtPGS/FIN]
8522 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Copy application.
[F:PrtPGS/FIN]
8523 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Fax application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
[P:PrtPGS/FIN]
8524 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Print application.
[S:PrtPGS/FIN]
8525 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the
Scanner application.
[L:PrtPGS/FIN]
8526 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.
SM 5-313 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled
pages are still counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries
are counted.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-314 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
8551 [T:PrtBooks/FIN]
System
001 Perfect-Bind *CTL Booklet finishing
8552 [C:PrtBooks/FIN]
8554 [P:PrtBooks/FIN]
8556 [L:PrtBooks/FIN]
SM 5-315 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-316 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
8567 [O:A Sheet Of Paper]
System
001 Total: Over A3/DLT *CTL
[T:Counter]
8581 These SPs count the total output broken down by output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these
counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
032 Total(A3) - -
[O:Counter]
8591 These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages
printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:)
applications only.
[T:Coverage Counter]
8601 These SPs count the total coverage for the total printout pages for each
printing mode.
SM 5-317 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[C:Coverage Counter]
8602
-
[F:Coverage Counter]
8603
-
[P:Coverage Counter]
8604
-
[L:Coverage Counter]
8606
-
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-318 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
010 SDK-10 *CTL
System
011 SDK-11 *CTL
SM 5-319 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-320 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
041 Function-041 *CTL
System
042 Function-042 *CTL
SM 5-321 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[T:FAX TX PGS]
8631
These SPs count the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
[F:FAX TX PGS]
8633
These SPs count the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately
as B/W.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and
SP8633 are the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is
done for each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
[T:IFAX TX PGS]
8641 These SPs count the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using
I-Fax.
[F:IFAX TX PGS]
8643
These SPs the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using I-Fax.
If a document has black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and
SP8643 are the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is
done for each destination.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-322 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
System
[T:S-to-Email PGS]
8651 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications.
[S:S-to-Email PGS]
8655 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an
e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications.
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If
the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the
pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the
document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page
document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted
separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10
for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for
a total of 20.).
SM 5-323 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[T:Deliv PGS/Svr]
8661 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by both Scan and LS applications.
[S:Deliv PGS/Svr]
8665 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by the Scan application.
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan
Router server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are
not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router
server.
[T:Deliv PGS/PC]
8671 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on
a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
8675 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with
Scan-to-PC with the Scan application.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-324 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
8681 [T:PCFAX TXPGS] *CTL These SPs count the number of pages
System
sent by PC Fax. These SPs are
provided for the Fax application only, so
8683 [F:PCFAX TXPGS] *CTL the counts for SP8 681 and SP8 683
are the same.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier
to the destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are
only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The
counter goes up by 10, not 20.)
8691 [T:TX PGS/LS] *CTL These SPs count the number of pages
sent from the document server. The
8692 [C:TX PGS/LS] *CTL
counter for the application that was
8693 [F:TX PGS/LS] *CTL used to store the pages is incremented.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1 / step]
8694 [P:TX PGS/LS] *CTL
The L: counter counts the number of
8695 [S:TX PGS/LS] *CTL pages stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
panel. Pages stored with the Store File
8696 [L:TX PGS/LS] *CTL button from within the Copy mode
screen go to the C: counter.
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted
for the application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the
number of pages sent to each destination.
SM 5-325 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[TX PGS/Port]
8701 These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send
them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4,
the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.
[S:Scan PGS/Comp]
8715
These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode.
009 PDF/A(OCR) - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-326 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
8721 [T:Deliv PGS/WSD/DSM]
System
[S: Deliv PGS/WSD/DSM]
8725
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
[S:Scan PGS/Media]
8735 These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each
scanner mode.
[RX PGS/Port]
8741 These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to
receive them.
SM 5-327 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[Dev Counter]
8771 These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the
development rollers) for black toner.
8781 These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles.
NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in
SP8-781-001 through 004 are the same.
[Toner Remain]
8801 These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP
allows the user to check the toner supply at any time.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-328 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
[Eco Counter]
System
8811
-
8851 These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of
each color is from 0% to 10%.
SM 5-329 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
8861 These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of
each color is from 11% to 20%.
8871 These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of
each color is from 21% to 30%.
8881 These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of
each color is 31% or higher.
[Page/Toner Bottle]
8891
These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.
[Page/Toner_Prev1]
8901
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.
[Page/Toner_Prev2]
8911 These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each
color.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-330 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[Cvr Cnt/Total]
8921
Maintenance
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
System
001 Coverage (%) Bk *CTL [0 to 2147483647 / 0 / 1% / step]
[Machine Status]
8941 These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation
mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine
operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.
001 Engine operation time. Does not include time while controller is saving data to
002 Engine not operating. Includes time while controller saves data to HDD. Does
not include time spent in Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes.
004 Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on. Includes time while
005 Includes time while machine is performing background printing. Does not
include time machine remains powered off with the power switches.
SM 5-331 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[AddBook Register]
8951 These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data
registration.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-332 SM
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
Maintenance
Fax Program *CTL [0 to 255 / 0 / 255 / step]
System
008
Fax application registrations with the Program (job settings) feature.
[Electricity Status]
8961
-
SM 5-333 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Mode Tables - SP8000-2
[Unit Control]
8971
-
Scanner Transmission:
104 *CTL [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
Color
Scanner Transmission:
105 *CTL [0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1 / step]
BW
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-334 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
System
5.15.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE)
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
If this bit switch is enabled, print jobs will be saved to the GW SD slot and
not output to paper.
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
Prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border around the printable area.
SM 5-335 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
A collate type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not
explicitely define a collate type.
Note: If #5-0 is enabled, this BitSwitch has no effect.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-336 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
1001 [Bit Switch]
System
003 Bit Switch 3 Setting 0 1
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
SM 5-337 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
If enabled, the simplex pages of IPDS jobs will be printed on the front side
because of printing on the back side of the page. This might reduce
printing speed.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-338 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
1001 [Bit Switch]
System
005 Bit Switch 5 Setting 0 1
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and
Punch Type from the operation panel. The available Types will depend on
the device and configured options.
After enabling this BitSw, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
If this BitSw is enabled, SDK applications will not be able to alter print
data. This is achieved by preventing SDK applications from accessing a
module called the "GPS Filter".
Note: The main purpose of this BitSw is for troubleshooting the effects of
SDK applications on data.
Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD.
The default (disabled) is 100. If this is enabled, the max. will be raised to
750 or 1000 depending on the model.
SM 5-339 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 7 Enabled
Letterhead mode printing Disabled
(Duplex)
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-340 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
1001 [Bit Switch]
System
007 Bit Switch 7 Setting 0 1
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 Enabled
(allow BW
[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without
Disabled jobs to print
requiring User Code
without a
user code)
SM 5-341 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs.
Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might
result in problems:
- Job submission via USB or Parallel Port
- Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-342 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
bit 3 PCL/PS bypass tray paper rotation
Disabled Enabled
System
(SEF/LEF)
This bitsw determines the timing of the PJL USTATUS JOB END sent when
multiple collated copies are being printed.
0 (default): JOB END is sent by the device to the client after the first copy has
completed printing. This causes the page counter to be incremented after the
first copy and then again at the end of the job.
1: JOB END is sent by the device to the client after the last copy has finished
printing. This causes the page counter to be incremented at the end of each
job.
Enabled (=0):
Text composed of UTF-8 characters can be displayed in the operation panel.
Disabled (=1):
UTF-8 characters cannot be displayed in the operation panel.
For example, job names are sometimes stored in the MIB using UTF-8
encoded characters. When these are displayed on the operation panel, they
will be garbled unless this BitSw is enabled (=0).
SM 5-343 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
Switches super option disable on / off. It this is On, multiple jobs are grouped
at LPR port. PJL settings are enabled even jobs that are specified queue
names are sent.
Determines whether Print from USB/SD will have the Preview function.
Enabled (=0): Print from USB/SD will have the Preview function.
Disabled (=1): Print from USB/SD will not have the Preview function.
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 Store and Skip Errored Job locks the Queue is Queue
queue not locked locked after
after SSEJ SSEJ
If this is 1, then after a job is stored using Store and Skip Errored Job
(SSEJ), new jobs cannot be added to the queue until the stored job has
been completely printed.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-344 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
bit 6 Allow use of Store and Skip Errored Job if Does not
System
connected to an external charge device. allow Allows SSEJ
SSEJ with with ECD
ECD
If this is 0, the Menu List button will be removed from Printer Features.
0 (default): Print jobs are not interrupted. If a job is promoted to the top of
the print queue, it will wait for the currently printing job to finish.
1: If a job is promoted to the top of the queue, it will interrupt the currently
printing job and start printing immediately.
SM 5-345 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
bit 2 DFU
You can specify whether or not to apply
"Extended Auto Tray Switching" to the
bypass tray when Printer Features > System Off On
> Tray Setting Priority >Bypass Tray is set to
"Any Size/Type" (when the bypass tray is set
to receive any type of paper).
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-346 SM
Printer SP Mode
Maintenance
1001 [Bit Switch]
System
012 Bit Switch C Setting 0 1
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
[- / - / -]
Initialize System *CTL
1-003-001 [Execute]
[- / - / -]
1-003-003 Delete Program *CTL
[Execute]
[Print Summary]
1004 Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller
settings).
[- / - / -]
1-004-001 Print Summary *CTL
[Execute]
SM 5-347 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Printer SP Mode
1-006-002 Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the
document server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service
Mode SP5-967. When you select "1," the document server is enabled
regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[ 0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step ]
- *CTL 0: Excluding New Job
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-348 SM
Scanner SP Mode
Maintenance
System
5.16.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS)
[Scan Nv Version]
1-001-005 - *CTL [- / - / -]
1005 Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.
If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This
SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Enable 1: Disable *CTL 0: Enable
1-009-001 1: Disable
This SP switches the TWAIN scanner function on/off. This is one of the
scanner application functions.
0: Display 1: [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
*CTL
1-010-001 Nondisplay 0: Display, 1: Nondisplay
SM 5-349 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner SP Mode
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: ON 1: OFF *CTL 0: ON (count displays)
1-011-001 1: OFF (no display)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: NO 1: YES *CTL 1: No
0: Yes
This SP code sets the machine to release or not release the following
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: OFF 1: ON *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-350 SM
Scanner SP Mode
Maintenance
1013 [Scan to Media Device Setting]
System
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: OFF 1: ON *CTL 0: OFF
1: ON
1-013-003
Determines to disable/enable Scan-To-Media.
0: Disables
1: Enables
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: OFF 1: ON *CTL 0: OFF
1-014-001 1: ON
Sets enable or disable the password setting when make a Scan to Folder
job.
meanings
bit Setting Description
0 1
SM 5-351 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner SP Mode
If it is 0, accessing is
limited from the machine
Access
only, such as operating
permission of
panel, SDK/J, MFP browsers
bit 1 FlairAPI from Disabled Enabled
etc If it is 1, accessing is
outside of the
allowed from outside of
machine
FlairAPI such as PC,
Remote UI, IT-Box etc
bit 2 Reserved - - -
bit 3 Reserved - - -
bit 6 Reserved - - -
bit 7 Reserved - - -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-352 SM
Scanner SP Mode
Maintenance
System
[Compression Level (Grayscale)]
2021 Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for
the five settings that can be selected at the operation panel.
2024 Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.
Compression Ratio
2-024-001 *CTL [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 / step]
(Normal)
Compression Ratio
2-024-002 *CTL [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 / step]
(High)
2025 Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.
Compression Ratio
2-025-001 *CTL [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 / step]
(Normal) JPEG2000
Compression Ratio
2-025-002 *CTL [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 / step]
(High) JEPG2000
SM 5-353 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Scanner SP Mode
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-354 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
System
5.17.1 MAIN MACHINE INPUT CHECK
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Registration Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Feed Sensor 1 ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Transport Sensor 1 ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Feed Sensor 2 ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Transport Sensor 2 ENG 0: paper exist
SM 5-355 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing Exit Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing Entrance Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Exit Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Inverter Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Duplex Exit Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Duplex Entrance Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-356 SM
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
Paper Exit Tray Full Sensor ENG 0: Not full
System
5-803-012 1: full
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
When full is 100%,
11: 71 to 100%
Tray 1 Remain Switch ENG
01: 31 to 70%
00: 11 to 30%
5-803-013 10: 1 to 10%
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 1: Upper Limit Sensor ENG 0: less then limit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 1 Paper End Sensor ENG 0: No paper
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 1 Set Switch ENG 0: set
SM 5-357 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
When full is 100%,
11: 71 to 100%
Tray 2 Remain Switch ENG
01: 31 to 70%
00: 11 to 30%
5-803-017 10: 1 to 10%
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 2 Upper Limit Sensor ENG 0: less then limit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 2 Paper End Sensor ENG 0: No paper
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Tray 2 Set Switch ENG 0: set
5-803-021 Value changes depending on paper size (fence position) set to 2nd paper
feed tray.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-358 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
By-pass: Paper End Sensor ENG 0: No paper
5-803-023 Value changes depending on main scan direction of paper set to bypass
tray.
5-803-024 Value changes depending on sub scan direction of paper set to bypass
tray.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Main Door Interlock Switch ENG 00: Unlocked
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Right Door Open/Close Switch ENG 0: close
5-803-026 1: open
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Duplex Guide Plate Open/Close
ENG 0: close
Switch
5-803-027 1: open
SM 5-359 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Transfer Open/Close Sensor ENG 0: open
5-803-028 1: close
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Transfer Contact Sensor ENG 0: Abutting
5-803-029 1: Alienate
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Waste Toner Bottle Near Full
ENG 0: Not full
Sensor
5-803-032 1: full
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Toner Bottle Set Switch ENG 0: set
[0 to 15 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing Set & Country Detection ENG 0111:200V system
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-360 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing New Fuse Blown
System
ENG 0: New
Detection
5-803-039 1: Old
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing Exit Fan:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
PSU Cooling Fan:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Main Exhaust Fan:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Paper Exit Cooling Fan: Lock ENG 0: Running
SM 5-361 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Toner Bottle Cooling Fan:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Development Motor : Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Fusing/Fusing Exit Motor:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Drum Motor:Lock ENG 0: Running
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
HVP/Separation DC/(-):Abnormal
ENG 0: SC detected
Detection
5-803-067 1: Normal
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-362 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
HVP/ChargeDC/(-):Abnormal
System
ENG 0: SC detected
Detection
5-803-068 1: Normal
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
HVP/PTR DC/(+)&(-):Abnormal
ENG 0: SC detected
Detection
5-803-069 1: Normal
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
HVP/Development
ENG 0: SC detected
DC/(-):Abnormal Detection
5-803-070 1: Normal
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: set
Key Counter:Set Sensor 1 ENG 1:unset
key counter: set 1=0, 2=1
5-803-072 for set, others for unset
SM 5-363 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: set
Key Counter:Set Sensor 2 ENG 1:unset
key counter: set 1=0, 2=1
5-803-073 for set, others for unset
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Key Card: Set Detection ENG 0: set
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
1-Bin Remain Paper Detection ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
1-Bin Set Detection ENG 0: paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bridge Relay Sensor ENG 0: paper exist
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-364 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
Bridge Exit Sensor ENG 0: Paper exist
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Relay Set Detection Mechanism ENG 0: set
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
RelayTransCov OP
ENG 0: close
Detect/LeftTransCov OP Sn
1: open
5-803-082
Detects open/close of the relay exit cover open/close sensor (bridge unit)
and the left transport cover open/close sensor (left exit tray).
(0: close, 1: open)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
RelayPprExitCovOP
ENG 0: close
Detect/UpperTransCovOP Sn
1: open
5-803-083
Detects open/close of the relay exit cover open/close sensor (bridge unit)
and the upper transport cover open/close sensor (left exit tray).
(0: close, 1: open)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Shift Tray Set Detection
ENG 01: set
Mechanism
5-803-084 11:not set
SM 5-365 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Stop on this side. during
Shift Tray: Position Sensor 1 ENG moving towards inner
1: Stop on inner side. during
5-803-085 moving towards this side
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Relay Fuse Blown Detection
ENG 0: Not cut
+24V
5-803-095 1: Cut
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Relay Fuse Blown Detection +5V ENG 0: Not cut
5-803-096 1: Cut
Displays in order of ID0, ID1, ID2, ID3, ID4 from the left.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Controller Fan:Lock ENG 0: Running
5-803-102 1: Stopped, or locked
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-366 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
HP Sensor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
5-803-200
Tests the scanner HP sensor.
[INPUT Check]
5803
Gets information of specified sensor.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-803-220 LCT Slide Open/Close ENG 0: slide open
1: slide closed
SM 5-367 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-368 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
System
[1-Pass ADF INPUT Check]
6011
For Single-Pass simultaneous duplex models only.
6-011-004 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-005 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-006 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
SM 5-369 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
6-011-007 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-008 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-010 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-011 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-012 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-013 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
6-011-014 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when there is a paper at sensor
area.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-370 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
Feed Cover Sensor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
6-011-015
Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when cover is open.
6-011-018 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when pick up roller is not in
home position.
6-011-021 Gets sensor information from ADF. Gives 1 when bottom plate is not in
home position.
SM 5-371 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
Horizontal Transport
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-002 Sensor
Switchback Transport
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-003 Sensor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-372 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
S-to-S Registration
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
6-123-010 Detection HP Sensor
Positioning Roller HP
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-013 Sensor
Booklet Stapler HP
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-016 Sensor
SM 5-373 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
Booklet Stapler HP
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-020 Sensor
6-123-025 Gets information of specified sensor. Displays signal level of sensor as it is.
6-123-026 Gets information of specified sensor. Displays signal level of sensor as it is.
6-123-027 Gets information of specified sensor. Displays signal level of sensor as it is.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-374 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
6-123-028 Sensor
System
Gets information of specified sensor. Displays signal level of sensor as it is.
SM 5-375 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
S-to-S Registration
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-041 Detection Sensor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-376 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
Shift Tray Lower Limit
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
6-123-047 Sensor 1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Punch Set Detection ENG 0: connected
6-123-053 1: not connected
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Shift Jogger Set Detection ENG 0: connected
1: not connected
6-123-054
Gets connection status of setting jogger unit.
* Not Use: Currently, Booklet Finisher SR3170 (D688) / Finisher SR3160
(D689) do not have setting jogger in system configuration.
SM 5-377 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Booklet Stapler Set
ENG 0: not connected
6-123-055 Detection 1: connected
Dynamic Roller
Open/Close Guide Plate ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-123-057 Sensor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-378 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
System
[INPUT Check: FrontFIN]
6135
Gets information of specified sensor. Displays signal level of sensor as it is.
SM 5-379 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
Punch Registration
6-135-021 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection HP Sensor
Punch Registration
6-135-022 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection Sensor
Positioning Roller HP
6-161-008 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sensor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-380 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
6-161-010 Jogger HP Sensor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
6-161-011 Feed Out HP Sensor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Driver HP Sensor
6-161-018 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
(Corner/Booklet Stapler)
Driver Timing
6-161-019 Sensor(Corner/Booklet ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Stapler)
Clincher HP Sensor
6-161-020 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
(Corner/Booklet Stapler)
SM 5-381 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
S-to-S Registration
6-161-027 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection HP Sensor
S-to-S Registration
6-161-028 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection Sensor
TE Stopper Transport
6-161-038 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sensor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-382 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
6-161-039 TE Stopper HP Sensor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
Booklet Folder Exit
6-161-040 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sensor
SM 5-383 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
6-170-001 Gets information from sensor (relay paper exit sensor... internal paper exit
6-170-002 Gets information from sensor (relay carry sensor... relay carry to finisher) of
bridge unit.
6-170-003 Gets connection information of bridge unit and main unit. When connected,
1.
6-170-004 Gets micro SW information of bridge unit. When cover open, 1. Main unit
6-170-005 Gets micro SW information of bridge unit. When cover open, 1. Finisher
side cover.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-384 SM
Input Check Table
Maintenance
System
6184 [Input Check:NoStplBindFIN]
6-184-002 Gets the paper exit sensor information of non staple finisher.
Horizontal Registration
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection Sensor
6-184-003
Gets the horizontal registration sensor information of non staple finisher.
(0: Sensor Off, 1: Sensor On)
6-184-005 Gets the junction solenoid HP sensor information of non staple finisher. (0:
6-184-007 Gets the stapler HP sensor information of non staple finisher. (0: Sensor
6-184-008 Gets the tray full detection sensor 1 information of non staple finisher. (0:
Paper overflow )
SM 5-385 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Input Check Table
6-184-009 Gets the tray full detection sensor 2 information of non staple finisher. (0:
Paper overflow )
6-172-001 Gets connection information of shift tray and main unit. When connected,
1.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-386 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
System
5.18.1 MAIN MACHINE OUTPUT CHECK
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves paper feed tray rising motor.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves register motor.
Registration Motor:CCW:Std
5-804-009 ENG
Speed
Registration Motor:CCW:Mid
5-804-010 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed
Registration Motor:CCW:Low
5-804-011 ENG
Speed
SM 5-387 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
Registration Motor:CCW:Std
5-804-012 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:IncSpd
Registration Motor:CCW:Position
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-804-015 Hold
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves paper feed motor.
Feed Motor:CCW:Std
5-804-025 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:IncSpd
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves vertical carry motor.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-388 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
5804 [OUTPUT Check]
System
Vertical Transport Motor:Position
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-804-034 Hold
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves paper exit motor.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves inverter motor.
Inverter Motor:CW:Std
5-804-052 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:Feed Speed
Inverter Motor:CW:Low
5-804-054 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:Feed Speed
Inverter Motor:CW:Mid
5-804-055 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:Feed Speed
Inverter Motor:CCW:Std
5-804-061 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:IncSpd
SM 5-389 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
Inverter Motor:CCW:Mid
5-804-062 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:IncSpd
Inverter Motor:CCW:Low
5-804-063 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:IncSpd
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves duplex entrance motor.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves duplex bypass motor.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-390 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
Speed:Feed Speed
System
Duplex Bypass Motor:CCW:Low
5-804-081 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Speed:Feed Speed
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves fusing motor. *See Important below
SM 5-391 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
Important: Use the procedure below to do the output checks for the fusing exit motor. If
you do not follow this procedure, a kink will form in the fusing belt sleeve, and the fusing
sleeve belt unit will need to be replaced.
1. Do one of the following:
Open the right cover of the paper bank
Remove one of the toner bottles
Pull out the waste toner bottle half-way
Remove the fusing unit
2. Enter SP mode.
3. Do the following out output checks:
SP5-804-092 (Fusing Motor:CW:Standard Speed)
SP5-804-093 (Fusing Motor:CW:Middle Speed)
SP5-804-094 (Fusing Motor:CW:Low Speed)
SP5-804-098 (Fusing Motor:CCW:Low Speed)
4. Without exiting SP mode, turn the main power switch off and then on again.
Important: If you exit SP mode before you turn the main power switch off, the fusing exit
motor will stay off when the machine warms up. Heat will be concentrated in one area of
the fusing belt sleeve and cause a kink to form. If this happens, you will need to replace
the fusing sleeve belt unit.
5. Do the reverse of what you did in step 1 (for example, reattach the fusing unit).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-392 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
5-804-112 Cooling Fan
System
Moves develop left exhaust air fan and toner supply cooling fan.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves develop motor.
SM 5-393 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves paper transfer divide motor.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Moves toner bottle drive motor.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804 Moves relay carry motor (bridge unit)/left paper exit carry motor (left paper
exit tray).
BridgeRelay/LefExit Motor:Std
5-804-166 ENG
Speed:IncSpd
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-394 SM
Output Check Table
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Maintenance
Outputs PWM for electrify HVP (DC/AC)
System
5-804-179 HVP/ChargeDC/(-):PWM ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Outputs PWM for develop HVP.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Outputs PWM for divide HVP.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Outputs PWM for transfer HVP (paper transfer: +/-).
SM 5-395 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Continuously drives specified motor for operation test.
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
Drives specified motor for a certain period of time to test operation.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-396 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
5-804-254 Solenoid:CCW
System
Moves waste toner open/close solenoid counterclockwise.
SM 5-397 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Pick-Up Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
6-012-001 1:On
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Feed Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
6-012-003 1:On
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Relay Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
6-012-005 1:On
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Exit Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
6-012-009 1:On
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Bottom Plate Motor
ENG 0:Off
For/Rev
6-012-010 1:On
Moves up/down the bottom plate by driving the ADF bottom plate motor
forward, backward.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Stamp ENG 0:Off
6-012-012 1:On
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-398 SM
Output Check Table
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Maintenance
Pull-Out Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
System
6-012-015 1:On
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Middle Motor Forward ENG 0:Off
6-012-016 1:On
Entrance Transport
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-001 Motor
Horizontal Transport
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-002 Motor
Pre-Stack Transport
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-003 Motor
SM 5-399 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
S-to-S Registration
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-011 Detection Move Motor
Positioning Roller
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-014 Rotation Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-400 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
Corner Stapler Motor ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
6-124-017
Drives specified motor for a certain period of time to test operation.
Booklet Stapler
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-020 Standard Fence Motor
Dynamic Roller
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-124-022 Transport Motor
SM 5-401 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
6-124-028 Drives specified motor for a certain period of time to test operation.
* Not Use: Currently, Booklet Finisher SR3170 (D688) / Finisher SR3160
(D689) do not have setting jogger in system configuration.
6-124-029 Drives specified motor for a certain period of time to test operation.
* Not Use: Currently, Booklet Finisher SR3170 (D688) / Finisher SR3160
(D689) do not have setting jogger in system configuration.
6-124-030 Drives specified motor for a certain period of time to test operation.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-402 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
System
[OUTPUT Check: FrontFIN]
6136
Continuously drives specified motor for operation test.
Punch Registration
6-136-015 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Moving Motor
SM 5-403 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
Entrance Transport
6-162-001 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Motor
Paper Feed/Positioning
6-162-003 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
& Move Roller Motor
S-to-S Registration
6-162-016 ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Detection Move Motor
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-404 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
6-162-018 Rls/Stndrd Fence Rtrct ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System
M
SM 5-405 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Output Check Table
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-406 SM
Output Check Table
Maintenance
System
6185 [Output Check:NoStplBindFIN]
6-185-001 Checks the transport motors movement of non staple finisher. Turn the
Junction Solenoid
ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
6-185-003 Motor
Checks the exit pressure release motors movement of non staple finisher.
SM 5-407 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Test Pattern Printing
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, SC
will occur.
1. Enter the SP mode then select SP2-109-003 Pattern Selection.
2. Select test pattern for print from the list then press [OK].
3. To change the density of the test pattern, select the density with SP2-109-006, then
press [#].
If select "0" with SP2-109-006, the color adjusted so will not show up in the test
pattern.
4. To print, touch [Copy Window], then set settings within the following window for test
print (paper size etc).
5. Press "Start" key to start test print.
6. After checking test pattern, touch "SP Mode" on the LCD to return to SP mode display.
7. Reset all settings to the default values (SP2-109-003, SP2-109-006).
8. Exit SP mode.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-408 SM
Test Pattern Printing
Maintenance
9 Argyle Pattern Small 22 2 Beam Density Pttrn
System
10 Argyle P:L (Argyle Pattern Large) 23 Full Dot Pattern
SM 5-409 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
5.20.1 OVERVIEW
In order to update the firmware of this machine, it is necessary to download the latest version of
firmware on a SD card.
Insert the SD card in SD card slot 2 beside the left rear of the controller box.
Media print
Controller board MediaPrint:JPEG/TIF
JPEG/TIFF
Network document
Controller board NetworkDocBox
box
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-410 SM
Firmware Update
Even when not using a RPCS driver, the XPS driver requires RPCS firmware.
Maintenance
System
5.20.3 PROCEDURE
A SD card is a precision device, so when you handle an SD card, respect the following.
When the power is switched ON, do not insert or remove a card.
During installation, do not switch the power OFF.
Since the card is manufactured to high precision, do not store it in a hot or humid location,
or in direct sunlight.
Do not bend the card, scratch it, or give it a strong shock.
Before downloading firmware on an SD card, check whether write-protection of the SD
card is canceled. If write-protection is enabled, an error code (error code 44, etc.) will be
displayed during download, and the download will fail.
Before updating firmware, remove the network cable from this machine.
If SC818 is generated during software update, switch the power OFF -> ON, and
complete the update which was interrupted.
During software update, network cables, remove interface cables, wireless boards, etc.,
(so that they are not accessed during update).
SM 5-411 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
Update procedure
1. First download the software to be updated to the SD card.
2. Switch the power OFF.
3. Remove the SD card slot cover [A]. ( 1)
Check whether the card is properly in the SD card slot. When a SD card is inserted, a
click is heard, and it is locked.
To remove the card, release by pressing once in the set state.
5. Switch the power ON.
6. Wait until the update screen starts (about 45 seconds).
When it appears, "Please Wait" is displayed.
7. Check whether a program installation screen is displayed. (English display) When two or
more software modules are contained in the SD card, they are displayed as follows.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-412 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
When two or more software names are displayed
1. Press the module selection button or 10 keypad [1] - [5].
2. Choose the appropriate module. (If already selected, cancel the selection)
Operation of keys or buttons
Display contents
On the above screen, two programs, i.e., engine firmware and printer application are
displayed. (The screen may change depending on the firmware or application).
The display contents are as follows:
Display Contents
* The upper row corresponds to the module number, the lower row corresponds to the
version name.
8. Select the module with the module selection button or 10 key operation. The selected module
is highlighted, and [Verify] and [Update] are displayed.
SM 5-413 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
In the middle row, the name of the module currently being updated is displayed. (in this
case, the printer is being updated)
In the lower row, a progress bar is displayed in ten steps. (The more *, the more the
progress.)
When updating the control unit program, since progress cannot be displayed on the
screen, the ROM update process is determined when the LED of the [Start] key changes
from red to green.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-414 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
This screen is displayed when all selected firmware modules are to be updated.
"printer" in the second row shows that the module updated last is the printer. (When
more than one are updated simultaneously, only what was updated last is displayed.)
When Verify has completed normally, the Update done display of the above screen is
"Verify done." If "Verify Error" is displayed, reinstall the software of the application
displayed in the lower row.
11. After switching power OFF, remove the SD card.
12. Again, switch the power ON, and check whether the machine is operating normally.
13. Return the SD card slot cover to the original position.
When the power supply is switched OFF during firmware update, update is interrupted,
and the power is switched ON again, normal operation cannot be guaranteed.
To guarantee operation, an update error continues to be displayed until update is
successful.
In this case, insert the SD card again, switch the power ON, and continue download of
firmware from the SD card automatically.
Web access card software: EXJS (EXtended Java Script) is a Type-C ESA application,
and like a conventional Web access card, update using an sdk folder is required.
The PS3 firmware program is included in the preinstalled PDF firmware.
In the default state, although the PS3 firmware program is hidden in the disabled state,
the function is enabled by installing the PS3 card.
(The program installed in the PS3 card is a dongle (key) for enabling PS3 function).
Due to the above specification, the self-diagnosis result report shows the ROM module
number / software version of the PDF firmware at the PS location.
SM 5-415 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
20 Physical address mapping Switch the main power supply off and
cannot be performed. on to try again.
Re-insert the SD card to reboot it.
Replace the controller board if the
above solutions do not solve the
problem.
21 Insufficient memory for the Switch the main power supply off and
download on to try again.
Replace the controller board if the
updating cannot be done by switching
the power off and on.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-416 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
24 SD card access error Re-insert the SD card.
System
Switch the main power supply off and
on to try again.
Replace the SD card used for the
update.
Replace the controller board if the
above solutions do not solve the
problem.
32 The SD card used after Insert the SD card containing the same
download suspension is program as when the firmware update
incorrect. was suspended, and then switch the
SD cards are different main power supply off and on to try
between the one which was again.
inserted before power There is a possibility that the SD card
interruption and the one which is damaged if the update cannot be
was inserted after power done after the correct SD card has
interruption. been inserted. In this case, try again
with a different SD card.
Replace the controller board if the
above solutions do not solve the
problem.
Replace all relevant boards if the
update is done for the BCU and FCU.
Replace the operation panel unit if the
update is done for the operation panel.
33 Card version error. Install the correct ROM update data for
The wrong card version is each version in the SD card.
downloaded.
SM 5-417 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
40 Engine download fails. Switch the main power supply off and
on to try again.
If the download fails again, replace the
controller board and the BCU.
41 Fax download fails. Switch the main power supply off and
on to try again.
If the download fails again, replace the
controller board and the FCU board.
42 Control panel / language Switch the main power supply off and
download fails. on to try again.
If the download fails again, replace the
controller board and the operation
panel unit.
43 Printing download fails. Switch the main power supply off and
on to try again.
The SD card media is damaged if the
update fails again. Replace the SD
card media.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-418 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
44 The data to be overwritten Switch the main power supply off and
System
cannot be accessed when on to try again.
controller-related programs Install the correct ROM update data in
are downloaded. the SD card.
Replace the controller board if the data
to be overwritten is contained on the
controller board.
50 The results of the electronic Install the correct ROM update data in
authorization check have the SD card.
rejected the update data.
SM 5-419 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
64 Reception fails due to the Reset the reservation date/time for the
power off at the reserved remote update.
date/time of the package
firmware update from the
network.
66 Reception failed due to the Reset the reservation date/time for the
status error of the machine at remote update.
the reserved date/time of the
package firmware update
from the network.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-420 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
70 Package firmware download Check that the network is connected
System
from the network fails. correctly.
SM 5-421 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Firmware Update
64 Reception fails due to the Reset the reservation date/time for the
power off at the reserved remote update.
date/time of the package
firmware update from the
network.
66 Reception failed due to the Reset the reservation date/time for the
status error of the machine at remote update.
the reserved date/time of the
package firmware update
from the network.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-422 SM
Firmware Update
Maintenance
70 Package firmware download Check that the network is connected
System
from the network fails. correctly.
The PDF firmware installed as standard contains a program required to print PS3 data as
default. However, this PS3 program is normally disabled.
The PS3 firmware is a dongle (key) which enables PS3 data printing functions. When the
PS3 firmware is installed, the PS3 program in the PDF firmware is enabled. Due to this
specification, the self-diagnosis result report shows the ROM part number/software
version of the PDF firmware contained in the PS3 program.
SM 5-423 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Updating JavaVM
When unzipping the downloaded file, two subfolders ("update" and "sdk") exist in the
"sdk" folder. Rather than just copying the subfolder "sdk", copy the whole folder
"sdk".
Updating Procedure
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-424 SM
Updating JavaVM
4. When the update is complete, "Update SDK / J done SUCCESS" will appear in the
banner message of the touch panel display. After turning off the power, remove the SD
Maintenance
System
card from the slot.
When you fail to update, "Update SDK/J done FAIL" is displayed. You can confirm the cause
of the error message below.
5. Reconfigure the Heap size. ([Extended Feature Settings]-[Administrator
Tools]-[Heap/Stack Size Settings]).
See the manual for the ESA application to know what value to set for the heap size.
6. Return to the previous setting for the boot priority application.
SM 5-425 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Updating JavaVM
pasePut() - error : The file of Inadequacy with the SD Re-create the SD card for
the card for updating updating.
copy origin is not found (Files are missing in the
Put Error! updating tool)
paseCopy() - error : The file Inadequacy SD card for Inadequacy SD card for
of the copy origin is not updating updating
found. (Files in the updating tool (Files in the updating tool
Copy Error! are missing) are missing)
[file name: XX] error,No Writing destination is full. Uninstall the unnecessary
space (The NAND flash memory SDK applications.
left on device on the controller board is If you can not uninstall it,
pasePut() - error : The full.) implement escalation,
destination directory cannot stating the "model name,
be application configuration,
made. SMC sheet
pasePut() - error : fileCopy (SP5-990-006/024/025),
Error. and error file."
Put Error!
[file name: XX] error,No Writing destination is full. Uninstall the unnecessary
space (The NAND flash memory SDK applications.
left on device on the controller board is If you can not uninstall it,
paseCopy() - error : The full.) implement escalation
destination directory cannot stating the "model name,
be application configuration,
made. SMC sheet
paseCopy() - error : fileCopy (SP5-990-006/024/025),
Error. and error file."
Copy Error!
Put Error! *1 Error, not normally expected If you cannot uninstall it,
to occur implement escalation
Copy Error! *1
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-426 SM
Updating JavaVM
Maintenance
Delete Error! stating the "model name,
System
application configuration,
[XXXXX] is an unsupported
SMC sheet
command.
(SP5-990-006/024/025),
Version Error and error file."
*1
Without the foregoing error
message, only "Put Error /
Copy Error" will be
displayed
SM 5-427 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Updating the EXJS
2. Put the SD card containing the firmware to install in SD card slot 2 [A].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-428 SM
Updating the EXJS
Maintenance
System
15. Press the [Default setting/counter] key.
16. Press the [Extension function default setting] button.
17. Press the [Extension function default setting] button on the [Extension function default
menu setting] screen.
18. Press the [Install] tab.
19. Press [SD card], and select "Extended JS" from the list of extension functions.
20. Select [MFP hard disk] as the installation location, and press [Next].
21. After checking extension function information on the Installation preparation
complete screen, press the [Enter] button.
22. "The following extension functions are already installed. The message Overwrite
extension function? is displayed. Press the [Continue] button.
23. When installation is complete, the message Extension function has been installed" is
displayed. Press the [OK] button.
24. On the [Startup settings] tab, set [Extended JS] to the startup standby state, and switch
the power OFF.
25. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2, and return the controller cover.
26. Switch the power ON.
27. Press the [Default setting/counter] key.
28. Press the [Extension function default setting] button.
29. Press the [Extension function default setting] button on the [Extension function default
menu setting] screen.
30. Check the version of [Extended JS] on the [Startup settings] tab is the latest version.
If the power is ON before starting Step 1, switch the power OFF after first performing
Steps 5-9, and perform Step 1 and subsequent steps. In that case, skip Steps 5-10. (This
saves time.)
If you do not plan to update Extension JavaScript, return the controller cover to the
original position after performing Step 5.
SM 5-429 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Updating the EXJS
If checked apart from the above procedure (firmware version displayed in system default
settings), a different version from the actual version may be displayed.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-430 SM
NVRAM Data Upload/Download
Maintenance
System
5.23.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD
Do the following procedure to upload SP code settings from NVRAM to an SD card.
This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked
1. Do SP5-990-001 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record
of the NVRAM settings if the upload fails.
2. Switch the copier main power switch off.
3. Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( x1).
SM 5-431 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
NVRAM Data Upload/Download
7. The following files are coped to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload
procedure is finished.
The file is saved to the path and the following filename:
NVRAM<serial number>.NV
Here is an example with Serial Number K5000017114:
NVRAMK5000017114.NV
8. In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that
holds the uploaded data with the number of the machine from which the data was
uploaded.
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the
machine for the NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the
serial numbers do not match.
This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM:
Total Count
C/O, P/O Count
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-432 SM
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Maintenance
System
5.24.1 OVERVIEW
Import/export conditions
Import/export is possible between devices only if their model type, region of use, and the following
device configurations match.
Input Tray
Output Tray
ARDF
Whether or not equipped with a hard disk
Whether or not equipped with a finisher and the type of finisher
SM 5-433 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
UP/SP Data Import/Export
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-434 SM
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Maintenance
System
Specify whether to [Include] or [Exclude] the "Device Unique Information". "Device
Unique Information" includes the IP address, host name, fax number, etc.
Specify an encryption key.
8. Press [Run Export].
9. Press [OK].
10. Press [Exit].
11. Log out.
If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.
When device Information is periodically imported, it is necessary to create the device
setting information file with special software and store it on the web server.
SM 5-435 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Press [Select] of the "Device Setting Info. File" to select the file(s) to import.
When inserting a file into a home screen, press [Select] for the Image for Home screen
and select the file. You cannot use this setting when using the Smart Operation Panel.
Specify whether to [Include] or [Exclude] the "Device Unique Information". "Device
Unique Information" includes the IP address, host name, fax number, etc.
Enter the encryption key that was specified when the file was exported.
8. Press [Run Import].
9. Press [OK].
10. Press [Exit].
The machine restarts.
If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-436 SM
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Maintenance
System
Data that can be imported and exported
System SP
Printer SP
Fax SP
Scanner SP
SM 5-437 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
UP/SP Data Import/Export
* The IP address is exported when both 'Unique' and 'Secret' are selected.
6. Select Crpt config setting (Encryption).
7. Press [Execute].
8. Press [OK].
If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-438 SM
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Maintenance
System
Import device information saved on an SD card.
1. Insert an SD card into the media slot on the side of the control panel.
2. Enter SP mode.
3. Press SP5-749-101(Import/Export: Import)
4. Select a unique setting.
5. Press [Encryption Key], if the encryption key was created when the file was exported.
6. Select an encryption setting.
Unique If you want to apply the unique Refer to the above information.
information to the target machine,
select the "Unique" key.
7. Press [Execute].
8. Press [OK].
If data export fails, the details of the error can be viewed in the log.
SM 5-439 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
UP/SP Data Import/Export
If you cannot solve the problem or do not know how to solve it after checking the code, note down
the error log entry, then contact your supervisor.
2 (INVALID A file import was Import files exported from the same
REQUEST) attempted between model with the same device
different models or configurations.
machines with
different device
configurations.
4 (INVALID OUTPUT Failed to write the Check whether the destination device is
DIR) device information to operating normally.
the destination
device.
7( MODULE ERROR) An unexpected error Switch the power off and then back on,
occurred during and then try the operation again. If the
import or export. error persists, contact your supervisor.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-440 SM
UP/SP Data Import/Export
Maintenance
8 (DISK FULL) The available storage Execute the operation again after
System
space on the external making sure there is enough storage
medium is insufficient. space.
9 (DEVICE ERROR) Failed to write or read Check whether the path to the folder for
the log file. storing the file or the folder in which the
file is stored is missing.
20 (PART FAILED) Failed to import some The reason for the failure is logged in
settings. "NgCode". Check the code.
Reason for the Error (Ng-Name)
2. INVALID VALUE
The specified value exceeds the
allowable range.
3. PERMISSION ERROR
The permission to edit the setting is
missing.
4. NOT EXIST
The setting does not exist in the system.
5. INTERLOCK ERROR
The setting cannot be changed because
of the system status or interlocking with
other specified settings.
6. OTHER ERROR
The setting cannot be changed for some
other reason.
21 (INVALID FILE) Failed to import the Check whether the file format is correct.
file because it is in the The import file should be a CSV file.
wrong format in the
external medium.
22 (INVALID KEY) The encryption key is Use the correct encryption key.
not valid.
SM 5-441 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
UP/SP Data Import/Export
When exporting device information from the control panel, the data can be saved only on
an SD card.
The file format for exports is CSV.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-442 SM
Address Book Export/Import
Maintenance
System
5.25.1 EXPORT
Backup address book information on SD card formatted with the specified software.
1. Switch the power OFF.
2. Remove the SD slot cover [A] ( x1).
SM 5-443 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Address Book Export/Import
5.25.2 IMPORT
1. Switch the power OFF.
2. After removing the SD slot cover of the controller unit, set the SD card in the service
slot.
3. Switch the power ON.
4. Execute SP5-846-052 (address book information restore).
5. Switch the power OFF.
6. Remove the SD card.
7. Attach the SD slot cover to the original position ( x1).
8. Switch the power ON, and check that the address book has been restored.
5.25.3 SPECIFICATION
The information which can be exported /imported is the following items.
Entry information
User code information
E-mail information
Protection code information
Fax information
Fax additional information
Group information
Title information
Title position information
Folder information
SMTP attestation
Local authorization
Folder authorization information
Account ACL information
New document initial ACL information
LDAP authorization information
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-444 SM
RFU Updating the Firmware
Maintenance
System
In this machine, software can be updated by remote control using @Remote.
SM 5-445 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
The HDD unit must be installed on the machine to enable the SFU or the package
firmware update via SD card.
5.27.1 OVERVIEW
Each firmware module (such as System/Copy, Engine, etc) used to be updated individually.
However, an all-inclusive firmware package (package_ALL) is now available.
There are two ways to update using the firmware package.
Package Firmware Update via a network: SFU (Smart Firmware Update)
Package Firmware Update with an SD card
SFU requires the connection to @Remote via a device which has the embedded
@Remote communicating function. When a machine is connected to @Remote via
an intermediate device (RC Gate), the SFU function is disabled.
Package Firmware Update via an SD Card
Package firmware update can also be performed using the conventional SD card method by
writing the package firmware directly to the SD card.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-446 SM
Package Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
SFU SD RFU
The [Firmware Update] button will appear even when a machine is connected to
@Remote with a device which does not have an embedded @Remote communicating
function.
If an error code is displayed, refer to Error screens during updating (page 5-416).
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Touch [Firmware Update].
3. Touch [Update].
SM 5-447 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
5. Touch [YES].
If the error code E66, which indicates that the download of the firmware has failed, is
displayed, implement this procedure from step 1.
Update will be started automatically after the download is finished.
When the machine is in the update mode, the automatic update is suspended if a
print job is implemented. After the print job is finished, touch [YES] on the display
shown with the following picture to restart updating.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-448 SM
Package Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
1. [Update done] is displayed.
The machine will automatically reboot itself.
The figures at the lower right of the display indicate Number of updated items/ All
items to be updated.
SM 5-449 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
The [Firmware Update] button will appear even when a machine is connected to
@Remote with a device which does not have an embedded @Remote communicating
function. If an error code is displayed, refer to page 5-416.
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Touch [Firmware Update].
3. Touch [Reserve].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-450 SM
Package Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
5. Enter the dates and times of next visit and start of receiving data.
Next time to visit this customer: The package firmware will be automatically downloaded
by this time/date.
When to receive? (1-7): The download of the package firmware will begin this number
of days before the next visit.
Successful Download
In the two diagrams below, the firmware is set to be downloaded by the day before the next
scheduled visit. In the first diagram, the download is successful on the first try. In the second
diagram, the download fails three times and is successful on the fourth try.
If the firmware download fails or cannot be completed due to the network settings/condition,
no power to the machine, or other reason, the machine will continue retrying every six hours
until the scheduled deadline (up to a maximum of four tries). For example, if the download is
SM 5-451 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
set for the day before the next visit, the machine will attempt the download at 24 hours before
the visit, and then continue trying every six hours (max. four tries total).
The retry is only performed in cases when the firmware download has failed.
If the machine is in Energy Saver mode when the download is scheduled to begin, the
download will be performed in the background and the machine/panel will stay in Energy
Saver mode.
The download will continue uninterrupted even if the customer initiates a print job, copy job,
fax receiving or other operation while the download is in progress.
The download will be terminated if the customer turns the power off while the download is in
progress.
If the download cannot be completed successfully by the time of the next scheduled visit, the
machine will stop trying to download the firmware.
3. Touch [Reserve].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-452 SM
Package Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
5. Check the information displayed.
When the package firmware is downloaded successfully, the details of the download result
are displayed as the following picture shows.
This information will only be displayed if the reserved firmware has already been
downloaded. If not, all the data items are indicated with -.
SM 5-453 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
3. Touch [Update].
5. Check the version of the received package firmware, and then touch [YES].
Update is started.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-454 SM
Package Firmware Update
Maintenance
System
If the version of the reserved package in the HDD is older than the latest version, the
messages shown in the following picture are displayed.
If you wish to download the latest version, touch [Execute] beside the message
Download and update the latest package. Then update of the package firmware will
be started.
If you wish to update using the firmware in the HDD (old version), touch [Execute]
beside the message Update to the received package.
6. [Update done] message is displayed.
The machine will automatically reboot itself.
SM 5-455 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
The figures at the lower right of the display indicate Number of updated items/ All
items to be updated.
If you copy the package firmware into the conventional romdata folder, the update
will not work.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-456 SM
Package Firmware Update
Only one version of the package firmware should be copied into the folder. If you
copy multiple versions of package firmware to the SD card, the machine will select
Maintenance
System
only one version of the firmware randomly.
3. Turn the power OFF.
4. Insert the SD card which contains the package into SD card slot 2 (for service).
5. Turn the power ON and touch [Update].
When the SD card contains both a firmware package and one or more modules, the
following display may show up. Select [Package] and touch [OK] to move to step 4
above.
6. Update is started automatically after the package firmware download to the HDD has
been completed.
7. When update is completed, Update done is displayed.
SM 5-457 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Package Firmware Update
The figures at the lower right of the display indicate Number of updated items/ All
items to be updated.
8. Turn the main power switch OFF, and then pull out the SD card from SD card slot 2.
9. Turn the power ON.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-458 SM
Capturing the Debug Logs
Maintenance
System
5.28.1 OVERVIEW
With this feature, you can save debug logs that are stored in the machine (HDD or operation
panel) on an SD card. It allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve error information for
analysis.
The Capturing Log feature saves debug logs for the following three.
Controller debug log
Engine debug log
Debug log of the operation panel
In older models, a technician enabled the logging tool after a problem occurred. After that,
when the problem had been reproduced, the technician was able to retrieve the debug
log.
However, this new feature saves the debug logs at the time that problems occur. Then
you can copy the logs to an SD card.
You can retrieve the debug logs using a SD card without a network.
Analysis of the debug log is effective for problems caused by the software. Analysis of the
debug log is not valid for the selection of defective parts or problems caused by
hardware.
SM 5-459 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Capturing the Debug Logs
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-460 SM
Capturing the Debug Logs
Maintenance
System
Retrieve debug logs to identify the date of occurrence of the problems and to find details
of the problems
e.g.: At around 8:00 am on March 10, an engine stall occurred. The operation panel does
not respond. Turn the main power supply off / on.
You need to retrieve the debug logs dating back three days from the date of the problem.
Analysis of the debug log is effective for problems caused by the software. Analysis of the
debug log is not valid for the selection of defective parts or problems caused by
hardware.
It is recommended to use the SD card provided as a service part. This is because the
log data can be acquired much faster than when using commercially available SD
cards.
2. Enter SP mode.
3. Set the start date of the log with SP5-857-101 (Start date of debug log output)
e.g.: March 28, 2013: input 20130328 (yyyymmdd)
Set the date three days earlier than the occurrence of the problems.
4. Set the end date of the log with SP5-857-102 (End date of debug log output)
e.g.: March 31, 2013: input 20130331 (yyyymmdd)
5. Execute SP5-857-103 (Get a debug log of all) to write the debug log to the SD card.
If the transfer is finished successfully, completed is displayed on the touch panel display.
The approximate time it takes to transfer the debug log is as follows. Transfer time
may be affected by the type or format of the SD card. (It is recommended that you
format the SD card using the Panasonic SD Formatter (freeware)).
Controller debug log (GW debug log): 2 - 20 minutes
Engine debug log: 2 minutes
Operation panel debug log: 2 - 20 minutes
6. Make sure that the SD card access LED is off, then remove the SD card.
If failed appears on the touch panel display, turn the power off, and then recover
from step 1 again.
SM 5-461 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Capturing the Debug Logs
The debug logs are saved with the following file names.
/LogTrace/machine
Controller debug log (GW debug
number/watching/yyyymmdd_hhmmss_unique
log)
identification number.gz
/LogTrace/machine
Engine debug log
number/engine/yyyymmdd_hhmmss.gz
/LogTrace/machine
Operation panel debug log
number/opepanel/yyyymmdd_hhmmss.tar.gz
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-462 SM
SP Text Mode (Saving SMC List to SD Card)
Maintenance
System
5.29.1 OVERVIEW
SP Text Mode
This function is used to save the SMC list as CSV files to the SD card inserted into service slot 2
or the operation panel card slot.
5.29.2 PROCEDURE
1. Turn the main power switch OFF.
2. Insert the SD card into slot 2 or the operation panel SD card slot. Then turn the power
ON.
3. Enter SP mode.
4. Select Copy SP.
006 Non-Default
SM 5-463 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Text Mode (Saving SMC List to SD Card)
022 Scanner SP
026 Printer SP
7. Press [EXECUTE].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 5-464 SM
SP Text Mode (Saving SMC List to SD Card)
Maintenance
System
10. Wait for 2 to 3 minutes until Completed is shown.
A folder named by the machine serial number will be created on the SD card when this
function is executed.
SM 5-465 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SP Text Mode (Saving SMC List to SD Card)
Maintenance
System
TROUBLESHOOTING
SM 5-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Self-Diagnostic Mode
6. TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
6.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
SC call or SC
alarm in
Pattern Display How to reset
customer
support system
SM 6-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Self-Diagnostic Mode
SC call or SC
alarm in
Pattern Display How to reset
customer
support system
Occurrence &
The SC is
alarm count
displayed on the
Power OFF
operation panel,
ON
D and the machine Switch main power from OFF to ON.
cannot be used
Alarm count
(machine-error
and alarm only
SC).
if recurrence
6.1.2 SC LOGGING
When an SC is generated, the "total count value when the SC is generated" and the "SC code"
are logged. However, if the total count value during the SC is the same as last time, logging is not
performed.
Logged data can be checked by outputting an administrative report (SMC print). The SC history is
logged up to the last 10 entries, and if there are more than 10 entries, data are progressively
deleted starting from the oldest.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-2 SM
Self-Diagnostic Mode
Troubleshooting
When an ordinary SC (pattern D) is generated, automatically reboot is performed. Automatic
reboot or reboot by user operation can be set by SP5-875-001 (SC automatic reboot setting out)
(default value: 0 "Automatic reboot").
When a type D occurs, automatic reboot is done or the machine display asks the customer if it can
reboot. However, when the SC occurs twice in a short time, the machine sends a report to the
@Remote server without rebooting. This is because just rebooting may not be a good solution if
an SC occurs twice.
When an automatic reboot is performed, a confirmation screen is displayed after reboot. The
confirmation screen can be cancelled by pressing the [OK] key (display is not cancelled only when
the main power switch is switched OFF to ON).
Screen display during reboot
Status display on the current screen
Post-processing ...... Post-processing during printing, etc.
Automatic reboot .... After operation end
Post-processing
SM 6-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Self-Diagnostic Mode
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-4 SM
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
Troubleshooting
6.2 SC TABLES: SC1XX (SCANNING)
The white level peak did not reach the prescribed threshold
when the white plate was scanned.
LED defective
IDB (LED driver) defective
SBU defective
IPU defective
Power/signal harness defective
Condensation in scanner unit
Mirrors or lenses dirty or positioned incorrectly
White plate dirty or installed incorrectly
SM 6-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
LED defective
IDB (LED driver) defective
Power/signal harness defective
The white level peak reached the prescribed threshold when the
white plate was scanned after a specified number of
adjustments.
LED defective
IDB (LED driver) defective
SBU defective
IPU defective
Power/signal harness defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-6 SM
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
Troubleshooting
SC120-00 D Scanner Home Position Error 1
SM 6-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
The black level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto
gain control.
SBU defective
IPU defective
Power/signal harness defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-8 SM
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SBU defective
LED defective
IDB (LED driver) defective
IPU defective
Power/signal harness defective
Scanner drive error
Condensation in scanner unit
Mirrors or lenses dirty or positioned incorrectly
White plate dirty or installed incorrectly
SM 6-9 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
SBU defective
The other side of the communication (BCU, IPU etc.)
defective
Power/signal harness defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-10 SM
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
The data read from the ASIC register on the CIS were not as
expected.
Details:
Occurs when a serial communication error between the CIS
board and the DF board is detected. Occurs also when an
error is detected during initialization of the ASIC on the CIS.
This can happen during initialization and feeding. The first
and second consecutive occurrences of each constitute
jams. The third occurrence constitutes an SC.
SM 6-11 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
During initialization:
The ratio between the average values of leading-edge area
and rear-edge area is out of specification.
Shading data peak value is below specification.
During scanning:
Shading data peak value is below specification.
Details:
During initialization:
Occurs when one out of two CIS LEDs is malfunctioning,
causing the difference between the average values of
leading-edge area and rear-edge area to be large (CIS LED
error detection).
Occurs when both of the CIS LEDs are malfunctioning
(unlit), causing the shading data peak value to be extremely
low (CIS white level adjustment).
During scanning:
Occurs when both of the CIS LEDs are malfunctioning
(unlit), causing the shading data peak value to be extremely
low (CIS scan control, gray balance adjustment /
confirmation).
The first and second consecutive occurrences of each
constitute initial/feed jams. The third occurrence constitutes
an SC.
During initialization:
One or two out of two CIS LEDs are defective
During scanning:
Both of the CIS LEDs are defective.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-12 SM
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
Troubleshooting
SC187-00 D CIS Black Level Error
CIS defective
The shading data peak value read out from the CIS is
abnormal.
Details:
Occurs when abnormality is detected in the process of CIS
shading data peak detection.
The first and second consecutive occurrences constitute
initial jams. The third occurrence constitutes an SC.
CIS defective
CIS background white roller is scratched, dirt, or improperly
connected.
SM 6-13 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC1xx (Scanning)
CIS defective
The GS20 chart is scratched or deteriorated due to dirty.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-14 SM
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
Troubleshooting
6.3 SC TABLES: SC2XX (EXPOSURE)
After the polygon motor turned on, or within 10 sec. after the
rpms changed, the motor did not enter READY status.
SM 6-15 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-16 SM
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
The FGATE signal did not turn ON within the given time period
after the writing process started.
GAVD defective
Image processing ASIC defective
BCU, controller board not connected correctly or defective
Harness between BCU and LDB defective
SM 6-17 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
The FGATE signal did not turn OFF within the given time period
after the writing process ended.
GAVD defective
Image processing ASIC defective
IPU, controller board not connected correctly or defective
Harness between IPU and LDB defective
SC240-00 D LD Error
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-18 SM
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
GAVD defective
CPU defective
BCU defective
SM 6-19 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC2xx (Exposure)
If the value is not same when the machine reads and writes the
same registration at the machine start-up.
If the communication parity retries three consecutive times, the
SC is generated.
CPU defective
IPU defective
BCU defective
Harness defective
If the Door Open status does not change to Door Close after
closing the door.
CPU defective
IPU defective
SC272-10 D BCU defective
Harness defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-20 SM
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
Troubleshooting
6.4 SC TABLES: SC3XX (IMAGE PROCESSING1
(CHARGE, DEVELOPMENT))
Hardware error
Input / Output connector is disconnected.
Input / Output harness is short-circuited.
Surface/air clearance insufficient (arc discharge)
BCU error (signal error)
HVPS defective
Load error
Grounding fault of charging output, short-circuit with other
outputs
Surface/air clearance insufficient in charging output path
(including distance from other outputs)
Unexpected deterioration of drum and over current due to
pinholes gap error between the drum and charge roller
(PCU error).
Over current due to drum surface condensation
PCU is disconnected.
SM 6-21 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Unit torque increased
TD sensor defective
Loose connection
Harness broken
Developer toner density differs from initial developer
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-22 SM
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-23 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-24 SM
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Hardware error
Input / Output connector is disconnected.
Surface/air clearance insufficient (arc discharge)
Input / Output harness is short-circuited.
BCU error (signal error)
HVPS defective
Load error
Grounding fault of charging output, short-circuit with other
outputs
Surface/air clearance insufficient in charging output path
(including distance from other outputs)
Unexpected deterioration of drum, and over current due to
pinholes
Over current due to drum surface condensation
PCDU is not set properly.
SM 6-25 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC3xx (Image Processing1 (Charge, Development))
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
PCU torque increased
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-26 SM
SC Tables: SC4xx (Image Processing2 (Around the Drum))
Troubleshooting
6.5 SC TABLES: SC4XX (IMAGE PROCESSING2 (AROUND
THE DRUM))
Hardware error
Input / Output connector is disconnected.
Input / Output harness is short-circuited.
IOB error (signal error)
HVPS defective
Load error
Transfer roller's impedance increases.
Transfer unit is not set properly.
SM 6-27 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC4xx (Image Processing2 (Around the Drum))
When the machine does not detect the high/low signal for a
specified time after the transfer roller contact motor has been
turned on.
Hardware error
Input / Output connector is disconnected.
Input / Output harness is short-circuited.
Transfer unit is not set properly.
IOB error (signal error)
HVPS defective
Load error
Grounding fault of separation power output, short-circuit
with other outputs
Surface/air clearance insufficient in separation power output
path (including distance from other outputs)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-28 SM
SC Tables: SC4xx (Image Processing2 (Around the Drum))
Troubleshooting
Cycle the main power off/on
Reconnect or replacethe harness of the HVPS (power
pack).
Reconnect or replace the harness between the BCU to the
HVPS.
Reset or replace the trausfer unit.
Check if the contact and separation movement of the
transfer unit works correctly.
Replace the HVPS.
Replace the BCU.
SM 6-29 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC4xx (Image Processing2 (Around the Drum))
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-30 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
6.6 SC TABLES: SC5XX (PAPER FEED AND FUSING)
The machine detects the error of the 1st tray lift motor 3 times
consecutively when the 1st tray is lifted..
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
The machine detects the error of the 1st tray lift motor 5 times
consecutively when the 1st tray is lowered.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 4 times or less.)
SM 6-31 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
The machine detects the error of the 2nd tray lift motor 3 times
consecutively when the 2nd tray is lifted..
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-32 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
Reset the paper.
Remove the foreign matter.
2nd tray limit sensor, 2nd tray lift motor
Check the harness.
Reset the connector.
Replacement
2nd paper feed unit, 2nd tray
Replacement
Paper transport IOB
Replacement
The machine detects the error of the 2nd tray lift motor 5 times
consecutively when the 2nd tray is lowered.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 4 times or less.)
SM 6-33 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
PFU (D694) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is lifted at
the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
The machine detects the lowering error of the tray lift motor for
the PFU (D694) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is
lowered at the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-34 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
Tray lift motor connector disconnected
Limit sensor harness disconnected or broken
Control board defective
Paper overload
Foreign matter, such as paper scrap, is caught between the
paper feed tray and the tray lift motor
Paper set fault
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
PFU (D787) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is lifted at
the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
SM 6-35 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
The machine detects the lowering error of the tray lift motor for
the PFU (D787) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is
lowered at the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error 2 times consecutively.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-36 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
LCIT (D695) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is
lowered at the machines initialization.
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
LCIT (D695) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is lifted
at the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
SM 6-37 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
LCIT (D695) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is
lowered at the machines initialization.
The machine detects the lift error of the tray lift motor for the
LCIT (D695) 3 times consecutively when the 3rd tray is lifted
at the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the
machine detects the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-38 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Both of the upper limit and lower limit detects the base plate 3
times consecutively at the machines initialization.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the both
sensors detect the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
Paper overload
Paper set fault
Limit sensor harness disconnected or broken
Lower limit sensor harness disconnected or broken
Control board defective
Foreign matter, such as paper scrap, is caught inside the
right tray.
Paper set fault (paper is offset from position for pushing end
fence)
Foreign matter entry (foreign matter is caught in the position
for pushing end fence)
End fence open/close sensor error/connector missing
Harness broken
Bank control board defective
SM 6-39 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-40 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
Replace the motor.
Reset the connector.
Replace the harness.
Replace the sensor.
Replace the control board for the optional paper feed tray.
Reset the paper.
Remove the foreign matter.
Replace the tray.
Replace the timing belt.
Replace the timing pulley.
Replace the end fence of the left tray.
SM 6-41 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-42 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-43 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-44 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-45 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-46 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
Lift motor error/connector missing
Lower limit sensor error/connector missing
Harness broken
Bank control board defective
Paper set fault
Timing belt damage/dropout
Timing pulley damage/dropout
Base plate damage/horizontality fault
Foreign matter, such as paper scrap, is caught inside the
tray
During tray initialization, both the upper limit and lower limit are
detected for 3 times consecutively.
(The message of resetting the tray is displayed when the both
sensors detect the error consecutively 2 times or less.)
Paper overload
Paper set fault
Limit sensor error/connector missing
Lower limit sensor error/connector missing
Harness broken
Bank control board defective
Foreign matter, such as paper scrap, is caught inside the
tray
SM 6-47 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Encoder defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-48 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Encoder defective
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Encoder defective
SM 6-49 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-50 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
SM 6-51 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
During motor ON, after checking lock signals for 2sec, a High
level was detected at least 20 times.
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
IOB defective
Unit torque increased
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-52 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Disconnection
Connector disconnected
NC sensor disconnection
Connector disconnected
NC short-circuit
Connector disconnected
SM 6-53 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
SC542-06 D When the fusing central thermopile does not reach the
permission temperature of heat central reloading for specified
seconds continuously.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-54 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Triac short-circuit
IOB board defective
BCU board defective
SM 6-55 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
After waiting for full power for more than specified seconds
continuously, not detected for specified seconds.
Definition of heater full power
Continuously heating rate set point (maximum heating rate)
Measurement start point
After reload (after heater extinguished, after rotation
complete) below the standby temperature (target
temperature), measurement starts after a heater heat-up
request is issued.
Measurement stop condition
Rotation started due to a print signal during measurement or
other.
Maximum heat-up Duty (SP interlinked value) 0% is
excluded.
Thermistor deformation/float
Heater disconnection
After excessive temperature rise prevention unit operates
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-56 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
Replace the thermistor.
Replace the fusing lamp.
Replace the fusing unit.
SM 6-57 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Thermopile disconnection
Connector disconnected
NC sensor disconnection
Connector disconnected
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-58 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
NC sensor short-circuit
Connector disconnected
SC552-06 D When the fusing edge thermopile does not reach the permission
temperature of heat edge reloading for specified seconds
continuously.
SM 6-59 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Triac short-circuit
IOB defective
BCU defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-60 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-61 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
After waiting for full power for more than specified seconds
continuously, not detected for specified seconds.
Definition of heater full power
Continuously heating rate set point (maximum heating rate)
Measurement start point
After reload (after heater extinguished, after rotation
complete) below the standby temperature (target
temperature), measurement starts after a heater heat-up
request is issued.
Measurement stop condition
Rotation started due to a print signal during measurement or
other
Maximum heat-up Duty (SP interlinked value) 0% is
excluded
Thermistor deformation/float
Heater disconnection
After excess temperature rise prevention unit operation
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-62 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Fusing jam (does not reach fusing exit sensor) is detected for 3
times consecutively.
Detection conditions
Displays the SC559-00 at the time of integrating the counter
each time fusing jam occurs, became fusing jam counter
value = 3.
The counter value is retained without fusing jam also reset
by OFF/ON the power supply.
Control ON/OFF
And enables ON / OFF is this SC, the default is set to OFF,
then ON at the time of customer requirements.
SP1-142-001 0: OFF (default), 1: ON (Set at the time of
customer requirements)
Counter reset condition occurs fusing jam
1. Normal paper exit has been done during this
continuous fusing jam, fusing jam counter is reset.
2. When "1" is changed to "0" SP1-142-001, to reset the
(SP9-912-001) fusing jam counter.
3. When after displaying SC559, SC release is made,
reset the (SP9912-001) fusing jam counter.
SM 6-63 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Thermistor disconnection
Connector disconnected
Thermistor dirt
Thermistor deformation, float
Outside input voltage guarantee
After excess temperature rise prevention unit operation
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-64 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Triac short-circuit
IOB defective
BCU defective
Triac short-circuit
Pressure roller thermistor defective
BCU controller defective
Fusing control: out of control
SM 6-65 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Thermistor disconnection
Connector disconnected
Thermistor dirt
Thermistor deformation, float
Outside input voltage guarantee
After excess temperature rise prevention unit operation
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-66 SM
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Triac short-circuit
IOB defective
BCU defective
Triac short-circuit
Pressure roller thermistor defective
BCU defective
Fusing control: out of control
SM 6-67 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC5xx (Paper Feed and Fusing)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-68 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
6.7 SC TABLES: SC6XX (COMMUNICATION AND OTHERS)
SC620-01
After ADF connection was recognized on startup, an error is
detected. (disconnection detection)
SC620-02:
After ADF connection was recognized on startup, an error is
detected. (Retry out due to communication error)
SM 6-69 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-70 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
When two trays PFU (D787) and side LICT (D696) or LCIT
(D695) and side LCIT (D696) are installed,
1. When the upper stream unit (D787 or D695) recognizes the
lower stream unit (D696), the break of the lower stream unit
is not canceled within predetermined milliseconds.
2. After the upper stream unit (D787 or D695) recognizes the
lower stream unit (D696), there is no ACK within
predetermined milliseconds after transmission of a data
frame to the lower stream unit, and a timeout error occurs
for 3 times consecutively even if retransmission is
performed.
SM 6-71 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
SC633-00 B Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board
and copier control board is disconnected or damaged.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-72 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC636-02 D correct.
SM 6-73 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-74 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-75 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-76 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
Remote Service Modem Communication Error (insufficient
current or connection fault)
SM 6-77 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Software bug
Logging only.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-78 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC651-02 C Center.
Software bug
Logging only.
SM 6-79 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
SC664-02 D Write Error to ASIC on the BCU SRAM (write result error)
Electrical Noise.
Hardware defection.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-80 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
BCU defective
SM 6-81 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-82 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC669-24 D EEPROM Data read: Operation stopped error
Electrical noise.
EEPROM damaged.
Electrical noise
Electrical noise
EEPROM damaged
SM 6-83 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Case 1
/ENGRDY signal was not asserted when the machine was
turned on or returned from energy saver mode.
/IPURDY signal was not asserted when the machine was
turned on or returned from energy saver mode.
EC response was not received within specified time from
power on.
SC670-00 D PC response was not received within specified time from
power on.
SC response was not received within specified time from
power on.
Writing to Rapi driver failed (the other party not found
through PCI).
Case 2
Unexpected down status was detected after /ENGRDY
assertion.
Case 1
Engine board does not start up.
Case 2
Engine board reset unexpectedly.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-84 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller stalled
SM 6-85 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller board defective
SC672-13 D Operation panel connector loose, broken, or defective
Controller late
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-86 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller board defective
SC672-99 D Operation panel connector loose, broken, or defective
Controller late
SM 6-87 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-88 SM
SC Tables: SC6xx (Communication and Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Communication error
SM 6-89 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
SC700-01
Even if the base plate motor is rotated in the base plate ascent
direction, the base plate paper feed correct position sensor does
not detect.
Even if the base plate motor is rotated in the base plate descent
direction, the base plate home position sensor does not detect.
SC700-02
Even if the pick up arm motor is rotated, the pick up arm home
position sensor does not detect.
SC700-04, 05, 06, 07, 09
When an error notification signal is detected during the motor
drive period.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-90 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC700-01
Base plate paper feed correct position sensor error (output
error)
Base plate home position sensor error (output error)
Base plate motor error (does not rotate)
Controller error
SC700-02
Pick-up home position sensor error (output error)
Pick-up motor error (does not rotate)
Controller error
SC700-04, 05, 06, 07, 09
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Harness broken
Overload
SC700-01, 02
Check the sensor harness and motor harness connection
Replace the sensor harness and motor harness
Replace the sensor
Replace the motor
Replace the controller
SC700-04, 05, 06, 07, 09
Check the harness connection
Replace the harness
Replace the motor
SM 6-91 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Encoder disconnection
Encoder connector dropout
Encoder defective
Overload
Motor deterioration
Encoder disconnection
Encoder connector dropout
Encoder defective
Overload
Motor deterioration
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-92 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-93 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-94 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Short-circuit defective
Overload defective
Motor defective
Solenoid defective
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encoder defective
SM 6-95 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
SC720-24 B Paper Exit Open/Close Guide Plate Motor Error (2K/3K sheet
finisher)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-96 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
Motor driver detects an error (short-circuit/ overheating) (1st
time, SC).
During movement to home, the home position could not be
detected within a predetermined pulse (p0 pulse) (1st time
is jam notification, 2nd time is SC notification).
During movement from home, the home position was
detected for longer than a predetermined pulse (p1 pulse)
(1st time is jam notification, 2nd time is SC notification).
The return pulse to home and pulse coming from home during
normal operation are calculated and measured. The pulses
which are 1.5-2 times the normal operation pulse are taken as
p0 and p1.
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encoder defective (*SC720-25 only)
Home position sensor defective
SM 6-97 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Home position sensor defective
SC720-62
Motor driver detects an error (DC motor control error) (1st
time is jam notification, 2nd time is SC notification).
SC720-63
Motor driver detects an error (short-circuit/ overheating) (1st
time is jam notification, 2nd time is SC notification).
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-98 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encoder defective
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Home position sensor defective
SM 6-99 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encorder error
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-100 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encorder error
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Encorder error
SM 6-101 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
SC721-24 B Paper Eject Cover Open/Close Motor Error (1K sheet finisher)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-102 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
Encorder error
SM 6-103 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-104 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
SM 6-105 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-106 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
SM 6-107 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-108 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
Retreat sensor error
SM 6-109 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Staple jam
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
Encorder error
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-110 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Center-folding blade HP sensor, or center-foliding cam HP
sensor defective
SM 6-111 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-112 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
SM 6-113 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-114 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
Paper surface sensor defective
SM 6-115 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
HP sensor defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-116 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Overload
SM 6-117 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
When the junction claw HP sensor was not turned off while
predetermined seconds applied to the solenoid motor with the
HP sensor turned on.
When the junction claw HP sensor was not turned on while
predetermined seconds applied to the solenoid motor with the
HP sensor turned off.
This SC will be issued when the above phenomenon repeated 2
times.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-118 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
Junction Solenoid Motor failure
Connector disconnected
Over load
Junction claw HP sensor error
When the exit paper pressure HP sensor was not turned off while
predetermined seconds applied to the exit pressure release
motor with the HP sensor turned on.
When paper output pressure HP sensor was not turned on while
predetermined seconds applied to the exit pressure release
motor with the HP sensor turned off.
This SC will be issued when the above phenomenon repeated 2
times.
SM 6-119 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
When the stapler drive HP sensor was not turned off while
predetermined seconds applied to the stapler motor with the HP
sensor turned on.
When stapler drive HP sensor was not turned on while
predetermined seconds applied to the stapler motor with the HP
sensor turned off.
The STM driver error detection is started after reset, and
predetermined seconds error signal is detected.
This SC will be issued when the above phenomenon repeated 2
times.
When the shift HP sensor was not turned off while predetermined
seconds applied to the shift motor with the HP sensor turned on.
When shift HP sensor was not turned on while predetermined
seconds applied to the shift motor with the HP sensor turned off.
The STM driver error detection is started after reset, and
predetermined seconds error signal is detected.
This SC will be issued when the above phenomenon repeated 2
times.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-120 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
Shift Motor failure
Connector disconnected
Shift Motor overload
Shift HP sensor error
Harness short-circuit
Circuit board failure
Excess current
Abnormal temperature
SM 6-121 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-122 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-123 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
SC724-71 B If the shift sensor has no response after the shift motor starts
moving 1.86 sec.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-124 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC724-86 B Stapler Motor Error (Internal finisher)
Motor defective
Connector disconnected
Motor overload
Home position sensor error
Paper surface sensor error (*SC724-38, 70 only)
Staple jam (*SC724-86 only)
SM 6-125 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-126 SM
SC Tables: SC7xx (Peripherals)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-127 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
SC816-10 to
D Sysarch (LPUX_GET_PORT_INFO) error
12
SC816-15 to
D open() error
18
SC816-26 to
D write() communication retry error
28
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-128 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC816-29, 30 D read() communication retry error
SC816-36 to
D Subsystem error
94
SM 6-129 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-130 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
If an unexpected error occurs at SCS processing end, gwint
processing also halts (this result is judged a kernel stop error, by
gwinit specification)
0x69742064 -> init died
"vm_pageout: VM is full"
Software defective
Insufficient memory
Hardware driver defective (RAM, FLASH memory)
SM 6-131 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-132 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data
from the video bridgedevice.
Defective I/F between the video bridge device and the controller
SM 6-133 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
HDD defective
HDD harness disconnected, defective
Controller board defective
HDD defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-134 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the
check sum stored in ROM.
PHY chip
Defective MAC of ASIC (SIMAC/COMIC/CELLO)
Defective I/F with the PHY board
Defective solder on the PHY board
SM 6-135 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
Loose connection
Defective SDRAM DIMM
Defective controller
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-136 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC828-00 D Self-diagnostic error: ROM
[xxxx]: Detailed error code
SM 6-137 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
A verify error occurred when setting data was read from the
clock generator via the I2C bus.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-138 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Defective EEPROM
SC841-00 D in EEPROM.
SM 6-139 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
SC853-00 B The Bluetooth hardware (USB type) was connected after the
machine was turned on.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-140 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC857-00 B USB driver error (There are three causes of USB error: RX
error/CRC error/STALL. SC is issued only in the case of STALL.)
SM 6-141 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
NVRAM defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-142 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
When the data encryption key was updated, HDD data was
converted, but not correctly. Image displayed at conversion only
(this SC is not displayed), but SC is displayed after machine is
cycled off/on.
SM 6-143 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
When the data encryption key was updated, HDD data was
converted, but not correctly. Image displayed at conversion only
(this SC is not displayed), but SC is displayed after machine is
cycled off/on.
SC859-01 B HDD conversion was set with the data encryption key
update function, but the HDD was removed.
Machine lost power during data encryption key update
Electrostatic noise, or an HDD error occurred, during data
encryption key update, and data was not encrypted.
When the data encryption key was updated, HDD data was
converted, but not correctly. Image displayed at conversion only
(this SC is not displayed), but SC is displayed after machine is
None
The display after restart instructs the user to format the HDD.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-144 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
When the data encryption key was updated, HDD data was
converted, but not correctly. Image displayed at conversion only
(this SC is not displayed), but SC is displayed after machine is
cycled off/on.
Details:
SC859-10 B Abnormal DMAC return value has been received two or more
times (DMAC timeout, serial communication error etc.)
SM 6-145 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
Unformatted HDD
Label data corrupted
HDD defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-146 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-147 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
HD defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-148 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC864-01 D HDD data CRC error
HD access error
SC865-00 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
SM 6-149 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
SC865-01 D sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in an area that does not belong to a partition,
such as the disklabel area.)
The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "a" (SC865-02) to partition v
(SC865-23)).
The HDD does not respond to the read/ write command from the
machine.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-150 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SD card removed
SC867-00 D An application SD card has been removed from the slot (mount
point of /mnt/sd0).
SM 6-151 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
SD card defective
* Do not format an SD card supplied with the main machine or sold as an option. You may only format SD
cards used for Firmware Update by a Customer Engineer.
SD card defective
SD controller defective
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-152 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SD card that starts an application
Turn the main power off and check the SD card insertion
status.
If no problem is found, insert the SD card and turn the
main power on.
If an error occurs, replace the SD card.
SD card for users
In case of a file system error, reformat the SD card
(using the "SD Formatter" made by Panasonic).*
In case of a device access error, turn the main power off
and check the SD card insertion status.
If no problem is found, insert the SD card and turn the
main power on.
If an error occurs, use another SD card.
If the error persists even after replacing the SD card,
replace the controller board.
* Do not format an SD card supplied with the main machine or sold as an option. You may only format SD
cards used for Firmware Update by a Customer Engineer.
SD card defective
SD controller defective
SM 6-153 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
* Do not format an SD card supplied with the main machine or sold as an option. You may only format SD
cards used for Firmware Update by a Customer Engineer.
Address Book data error (On startup: Media required for storing
SC870-01 B
the Address Book is missing.)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-154 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
Address Book data error (Initialization: Failed to generate a file
SC870-06 B
to store information required for LDAP search.)
SC870-20 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to initialize file.)
SC870-21 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to generate file.)
SC870-22 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to open file.)
SC870-23 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to write to file.)
SC870-24 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to read file.)
SC870-25 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to check file size.)
SC870-26 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to delete data.)
SC870-27 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to add data.)
SM 6-155 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-156 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
Address Book data error (Unable to obtain the on/off setting for
SC870-60 B
administrator authentication (06A and later).)
Software bug
Inconsistency of Address Book source location
(machine/delivery server/LDAP server)
Inconsistency of Address Book encryption setting or
encryption key (NVRAM or HDD was replaced individually
without formatting the Address Book)
Address Book storage device (SD/HDD) was temporarily
removed or hardware configuration does not match the
application configuration.
Address Book data corruption was detected.
SM 6-157 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
HDD defective
Power was turned of while the machine used the HDD.
HDD defective
Power was turned of while the machine used the HDD.
SC873-00 B
Format the HDD (SP5-832-007).
Replace the HDD.
When you do the above, the following information will be
initialized.
Default sender name/password (SMB/FTP/NCP)
Administrator mail address
Scanner delivery history
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-158 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-159 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-160 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC876-04 D Log encryption key is disabled but the log data file is
encrypted. (NVRAM data corruption)
Log encryption key is enabled but the log data file is not
encrypted. (NVRAM data corruption)
SM 6-161 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
Other causes
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-162 SM
SC Tables: SC8xx
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
MLB error
SM 6-163 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC8xx
SC899-00
In case of a hardware defect
Replace the hardware.
In case of a software error
Turn the main power off/on.
Try updating the firmware.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-164 SM
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
Troubleshooting
6.10 SC TABLES: SC9XX (OTHERS)
Software bug
Unexpected hardware configuration (such as insufficient
memory)
SM 6-165 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
HDD defective
Power loss while data was writing to HDD
Software bug
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-166 SM
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
Troubleshooting
Display Meaning
(-3) No label
SM 6-167 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
The first time that the network gets access to the machine, the management information
must be configured again (this will use a lot of time).
3. Before you initialize the Netfile partition with SP5-832-11, do these steps:
4. In the User Tools mode, do Document Management> Batch Delete Transfer Documents.
5. Do SP5-832-11, and turn the machine off and on.
Procedure 3
1. If Procedure 2 is not the solution for the problem, do SP5-832-1 (HDD Formatting - All)
1. Cycle the machine off/on.
SP5-832-001 erases all document and address book data on the hard disks. Consult with
the customer before you do this SP code.
Procedure 4
1. If Procedure 3 does not solve the problem, replace the HDD.
Logging only
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-168 SM
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-169 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SC Tables: SC9xx (Others)
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-170 SM
When SC549 Is Displayed
Troubleshooting
6.11 WHEN SC549 IS DISPLAYED
SM 6-171 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
When SC549 Is Displayed
2. Move the shield drive gear with your hands to put the upper surface of the feeler [A] in
a horizontal position.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-172 SM
When SC549 Is Displayed
Troubleshooting
The feeler moves smoothly: OK
The feeler does not move / stops during moving / moves but slowly: NG
<Procedure 2: Operation check for the upper side of the shield detection feeler>
1. Place the fusing unit on a flat place with the drawer connector [A] turned up and the
handle [B] touching a flat surface.
2. Move the shield drive gear with your hands to put the upper surface of the feeler [A] in
a vertical position.
SM 6-173 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
When SC549 Is Displayed
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-174 SM
When SC549 Is Displayed
6.11.3 SOLUTION
Troubleshooting
By tilting the fusing unit, you can check whether the feeler does not move smoothly due to burrs
on a part in the unit, and remove the burrs.
1. Tilt the fusing unit [A] approx. 30.
SM 6-175 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-176 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
Jam code: Shows the cause of a jam. Appears in the log data.
Position code: Shows the location of a jam. Appears on the operation panel.
These are lists of jam codes for the main machine and peripheral devices. Please note:
Late jam. The paper has failed to arrive within the prescribed time due to a jam that has
occurred upstream of the referenced sensor.
Lag jam. The paper has failed to leave the location of the referenced sensor within the
prescribed time due to a jam downstream of the referenced sensor.
Main Machine
1 Initial jam *1
3 Tray 1 No Feed A1
4 Tray 2 No Feed A2
5 Tray 3 No Feed Y1
6 Tray 4 No Feed Y2
7 LCT No Feed U1
9 Duplex No Feed Z
SM 6-177 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-178 SM
Jam Detection
*1 Initial Jam
Troubleshooting
Jam description Position code
Main Machine
Registration Sensor B
Exit Sensor C
Invert Sensor C
ARDF DF3080
SM 6-179 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
ARDF DF3090
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-180 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
ARDF DF3080
SM 6-181 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-182 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
183 Tray Lift Motor Jam R1-R5
SM 6-183 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-184 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
Internal Finisher SR3130
SM 6-185 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-186 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
SM 6-187 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Jam Detection
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-188 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
6.13 OTHER PROBLEMS
SM 6-189 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
Compared to non-adhesive contaminants (such as paper fragments and eraser dust), adhesive
contaminants are more likely to lead to complaints from customers because of the following:
Vertical streaks caused by adhesive contaminants are more visible in terms of image quality.
Unless removed by cleaning, adhesive contaminants continue to produce vertical streaks,
while non-adhesive contaminants stop producing streaks after they are dislodged.
Many adhesive contaminants are difficult to remove by cleaning.
The ARDF DF3090 (D779) features a system (non-contact scanning) to reduce vertical streaks
caused by adhesive contaminants.
The ARDF DF3090 (D779) can be converted from non-contact scanning to contact scanning for
users who wish to reduce vertical streaks caused by non-adhesive contaminants.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-190 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
SP4-688-001 (DF Density
97% 102%
Adjustment ARDF)
For SR3170/SR3160
The docking bracket for SR3170/SR3160 [A] (and its screw [B]) can adjust the side-to-side
registration.
SM 6-191 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
After the adjustment, check the side-to-side registration by feeding paper out to the proof
tray. If the shift has not been solved, adjust the docking bracket (screw for the docking
bracket) slightly again.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-192 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
For SR3150/SR3140
Side-to-side registration can be adjusted by the docking bracket for SR3150/SR3140 [A] (and the
docking bracket screw [B]).
1. Eject a sheet of A4(LEF) or A3 A4(LEF) paper to the proof tray and check for how many
divisions of the scale the edge of the paper has shifted from the center.
SM 6-193 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
[A]: Reverse
If paper shifts toward the front
Slide the docking bracket backward by the amount which corresponds to that of the shift, in
order to move the finisher in the same direction.
e.g.: When paper has shifted by 4 mm from the center toward the rear (2 mm/division of the
scale), move the docking bracket backward by 4 mm (2 divisions). The divisions move
forward.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-194 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
Slide the docking bracket backward by the amount which corresponds to that of the shift, in
order to move the finisher in the same direction.
e.g.: When paper has shifted by 4mm from the center toward the rear (2 mm/division of the
scale), move the docking bracket backward by 4 mm (2 divisions). The divisions move
forward.
After the adjustment, check the side-to-side registration by feeding paper out to the proof
tray. If the shift has not been solved, adjust the docking bracket (screw for the docking
bracket) slightly again.
SM 6-195 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-196 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
Place the sheet on the outer end [A] of the auxiliary tray and hook the bent portion [B]
at the edge of the tray.
3. Open and close the upper cover [A] or the front cover [B]. The shift tray [C] starts to descend.
4. "JAM227" is displayed about 3 seconds later. The shift tray descent is stopped. Release your
hand from the feeler.
5. Clean the place [A] to attach the fixing sheet with alcohol.
SM 6-197 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-198 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
FINISHER
Early paper full detection may occur due to paper stacking depending on the paper type / size. In
this case, it is possible to avoid the early detection by attaching the auxiliary tray
Installation procedure
1. Place the auxiliary tray [B] into the dent in the proof tray [A].
SM 6-199 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-200 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
Adjust the jogger width to be slightly narrower (approximately -0.5 mm) than the
paper width.
SM 6-201 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
4. Rotate the gear [A] to lift down the movable tray [B].
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-202 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
5. Paper output tray [A] ( x2)
SM 6-203 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-204 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
When the OCR unit is installed, its function is stored in the HDD, and its ID information in the SD
card is stored in the NVRAM. So the OCR unit must be installed again when you replace the HDD
and/or NVRAM.
If you have the original SD card and when you replaced:
Only HDD
Re-install the unit with the original SD card.
Only NVRAM
Re-install with the original SD card if you upload/download of the NVRAM data.
Order a new SD card and Re-install with the new SD card if you do not upload/download
of the NVRAM data.
Both the HDD and NVRAM at the same time
Re-install the original SD card.
If you do not have the original SD card:
Order a new SD card and Re-install with the new SD card.
2. Release the clamp and disconnect the harness of the paper output full sensor 1 [A].
SM 6-205 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Other Problems
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the harness of the paper output full sensor 2
(Staple) [A].
If the harness cable is short to loop, clamp the harness without looping.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-206 SM
Other Problems
Troubleshooting
6. Re-attach the paper output cover ( 2)
7. Attach the auxiliary tray (D7667010) [B] to the paper output tray [A]
SM 6-207 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Blown Fuse Condition
Fuse: NA
Field replacement
Capacity Part number
Name Output connector possible
5A - No
FU11 CN911-3 (IPU)
5V SLT250V5A -
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-208 SM
Blown Fuse Condition
Troubleshooting
Fuse: EU
Field replacement
Capacity Part number
Name Output connector possible
8A 11071346 Yes
5A 11071344 Yes
5A - No
FU11 CN911-3 (IPU)
5V SLT250V5A -
SM 6-209 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Blown Fuse Condition
Fuse Location
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 6-210 SM
Blown Fuse Condition
Troubleshooting
ENERGY SAVING
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SM 6-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Energy Saving
7. ENERGY SAVING
Energy Saving
7.1 ENERGY SAVING
If the [Energy Saver] key is pressed again during the job, the machine returns to
the Ready condition.
SM 7-1 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Energy Saving
*1: The machine return to ready status by doing one of the following,
Press the [Energy Saver] key
Open the platen cover
Set an original in the ADF
*2: Recovering from the Energy Saver mode is the same as previous models. Do one of the
following.
Press the [Energy Saver] key
Open the platen cover
Set an original in the ADF
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 7-2 SM
Energy Saving
Energy Saving
With this timer, the user can choose when the machine will automatically enter and recover
from Energy Saver mode, as well as when it will turn on and off. The user does not need to
worry about turning the machine on or off in the morning, during lunchtime, or when leaving
the office. As a result, the machine contributes to overall energy saving in the users office
environment, while at the same time helping to improve work efficiency.
The user is able to control how far the machine will power down, i.e. only to Energy Saver
mode or all the way off.
With auto power ON and OFF, the user need not remember to turn the machine on and off
every day.
Auto power ON:
Improves work efficiency, as machine warm-up is already completed by the time the user
is ready to begin work (the user is not made to wait).
Auto power OFF:
Prevents unnecessary power consumption during after-work hours, saving power.
The user can disable the Weekly Timer, so that the machine power is not turned on
automatically during extended periods of inactivity (Ex. Summer holiday).
A password can be set so that the machine can be used during this period if necessary, but
only by the select group who know this password.
You can set the energy saver timer setting on Weekly Timer in Timer Settings menu
under System Settings.
SM 7-3 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Save
1. Duplex:
2. Combine mode:
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 7-4 SM
Paper Save
3. Duplex + Combine:
Energy Saving
Using both features together can further reduce paper volume by 3/4!
To check the paper consumption, look at the total counter and the duplex counter.
The total counter counts all pages printed.
For one duplex page, the total counter goes up by 2.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the total counter goes up by 3.
The duplex counter counts pages that have images on both sides.
For one duplex page, the duplex counter goes up by 1.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the duplex counter will only increase by 1, even
though two sheets are used.
SM 7-5 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Save
Duplex mode:
Duplex
Simplex Duplex Total counter
Originals Paper Saved counter
Sheet used Sheets used SP8581-001
SP8411-001
1 1 1 0 1 0
2 2 1 1 2 1
3 3 2 1 3 1
4 4 2 2 4 2
5 5 3 2 5 2
10 10 5 5 10 5
20 20 10 10 20 10
If combine mode is used, the total and duplex counters work in the same way as explained
previously. The following table shows paper savings and how the counters increase for some
simple examples of duplex/combine jobs.
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 7-6 SM
Paper Save
2 in 1 mode:
Energy Saving
Duplex
Simplex Duplex Total counter
Originals Paper Saved counter
Sheet used Sheets used SP8581-001
SP8411-001
1 1 1 0 1 1
2 2 1 1 1 1
3 3 2 1 2 2
4 4 2 2 2 2
5 5 3 2 3 2
10 10 5 5 5 5
20 20 10 10 10 10
SM 7-7 D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
Paper Save
Duplex + 2 in 1 mode:
Duplex
Simplex Duplex Total counter
Originals Paper Saved counter
Sheet used Sheets used SP8581-001
SP8411-001
1 1 1 0 1 0
2 2 1 1 1 0
3 3 1 2 2 1
4 4 1 3 2 1
5 5 2 3 3 1
6 6 2 4 3 1
7 7 2 5 4 2
8 8 2 6 4 2
9 9 3 6 5 2
10 10 3 7 5 2
11 11 3 8 6 3
12 12 3 9 6 3
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 7-8 SM
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202
APPENDICES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
D197/D198/D199/D200/D201/D202 ii SM Appendix
APPENDIX:
SPECIFICATIONS
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
General Specifications
1. APPENDICES: SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications
Appendices:
1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
1.1.1 MAINFRAME
Item Spec.
Configuration: Desktop
D197/D198/D199:
Single Laser beam scanning and
electro-photographic printing
Printing process:
D200/D201/D202:
Twin Laser beam Scanning and electro-photographic
printing
D197: 4K
D198: 5K
D199: 7K
Target Monthly ACV:
D200: 10K
D201: 15K
D201: 20K
Item Spec.
11.0 sec
* If HDD installed: 14.0 sec
Warm-up Time (From main switch):
* If Smart Operation Panel installed: 71.0 sec
(Nominal Value)
Mainframe:
587 x 680 x 788 (23.1 x 26.8 x 31.0)
(Mainframe; when Operation panel is at home
position)
668 x 765 x 1035 (26.3 x 30.1 x 40.7)
(with 2-Tray Optional Bank, and Fall-Prevention
Material)
With ARDF:
587 x 680 x 913 (23.1 x 26.8 x 35.9)
(Mainframe; when Operation panel is at home
Dimensions (W x D x H): position)
668 x 765 x 1160 (26.3 x 30.1 x 45.7)
(with 2-Tray Optional Bank, and Fall-Prevention
Material)
With SPDF:
587 x 680 x 963 (23.1 x 26.8 x 37.9)
(Mainframe; when Operation panel is at home
position)
668 x 765 x 1210 (26.3 x 30.1 x 47.6)
(with 2-Tray Optional Bank, and Fall-Prevention
Material)
Item Spec.
Specifications
Mainframe only
Appendices:
Less than 60 kg (132.3 lbs)
With ARDF
Weight:
Less than 68.5 kg (151.0 lbs)
With SPDF
Less than 74 kg (163.1 lbs)
320GB
* Optional for Basic model. Standard with SP model.
Shared with other features (Copy, Fax, and
HDD:
Scanner).
Regarding HDD, users can use 206GB only to
enhance response rate for storing and loading data.
Register Group Address in HDD: Max. 100 Group (Max. 500 addresses in one group
address)
Item Spec.
Paper Feeding Std: 1,200 sheets (550 sheets + 550 sheets + 100
Capacity Sheets/ Bypass)
Item Spec.
Specifications
(LT/A4: 80gsm Option: Paper Feed Unit: 550 sheets x 2 trays
Appendices:
paper): Paper Feed Unit: 550 sheets x 1 tray
Tandem LCT: 1,000 sheets x 2
Side LCT: 1500 sheets
Paper Output Std: Face Down: 500 sheets (A4/LT or smaller) / 250
Capacity sheets (B4/LG or larger)
(LT/A4: 80gsm *When Bridge Unit or Side Tray is attached:
paper): 250 sheets (A4/LT or smaller), 125 sheets (B4/LG or
larger)
Item Spec.
<D197/D198/D199>
Side Tray: 125 sheets
or
1000 sheets Finisher: 1,000 + 250 sheets(A4/LT or
smaller), 500 + 50 sheets(B4/LG or larger)
or
Internal Finisher: 500 sheets, 250 sheets(B4/LG or
larger)
or
Stapleless stapler: 250 sheets(A4/LT or smaller), 125
sheets(B4/LG or larger)
<D200/D201/D202>
Side Tray: 125 sheets
or
1000 sheets Finisher: 1,000 + 250 sheets(A4/LT or
smaller), 500 + 50 sheets(B4/LG or larger)
or
2000 sheets Booklet Finisher: 2,000 + 250
sheets(A4/LT or smaller), 1,500 + 50 sheets(B4/LG
or larger)
or
3000 sheets Finisher: 3,000 + 250 sheets(A4/LT or
smaller), 1,000 + 50 sheets (B4/LG or larger)
or
Booklet Finisher: 2,000 + 250 sheets, 1000 + 50
sheets(B4/LG or larger)
or
Internal Finisher: 500 sheets
Item Spec.
Specifications
Paper Output Max: 3,625 sheets
Appendices:
Capacity (with 3,000 sheets Finisher (3,250 sheets) + bridge
(LT/A4: 80gsm unit (250 sheets) + 1 bin tray (125 sheets))
paper):
[Thickness]
Thin Paper, Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle
Thick, Thick Paper 1, Thick Paper 2, Thick Paper 3,
Thick Paper 4
[Thickness]
Thin Paper, Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle
Thick, Thick Paper 1, Thick Paper 2, Thick Paper 3,
Thick Paper 4
[Thickness]
Thin Paper, Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle
Thick, Thick Paper 1, Thick Paper 2, Thick Paper 3,
Thick Paper 4
Item Spec.
Copier Specifications
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
CPM Color: -
Item Spec.
Magazine:
2 sided original to
simplex:
Scan Position No
Adjustment:
Creep Adjustment: No
Item Spec.
Specifications
Erase Border: 1mm step (2-99mm)
Appendices:
Default = 10mm
Mirror: No
Positive/Negative: Yes
Erase Inside: No
Erase Outside: No
Item Spec.
Sharp/Soft: 7 levels
Contrast: 9 levels
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
Standard:
PCL: Scalable 45 fonts + international 13 fonts
Font: PS3: 136 Roman fonts
Option:
IPDS: 108 Roman fonts
Standard:
Ethernet (1000BASE-T/ 100BASE-TX/ 10BASE-T),
USB 2.0 Type A (2 port on back of the machine, 1 port on
Host Interfaces: operational panel), Type B, SD Slot on operational panel
Option:
IEEE1284/ECP, Wireless LAN (IEEE802.11a/b/g/n),
Bluetooth, Additional NIC(2nd port)
Standard:
MIB-II(RFC1213), Host Resource (RFC1514), Printer MIB
MIB: (RFC1759), Printer Port Monitor MIB
Private:
Ricoh Original
Item Spec.
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
Simplex:
110 pages/minute (A4 LEF/LT LEF, 200 dpi/300 dpi ) Push
Scan
BW:
Duplex:
180 pages/minute (A4 LEF/LT LEF, 200 dpi/300 dpi ) Push
Scanning Scan
Speed
(SPDF): Simplex:
110 pages/minute (A4 LEF/ LT LEF, 200 dpi/ 300 dpi )
Push Scan
Color:
Duplex:
180 pages/minute (A4 LEF/ LT LEF, 200 dpi/ 300 dpi )
Push Scan
Item Spec.
(EU/AS/CHN): SEF
*SP mode adjustment is required:
ARDF: 8"x13"(F) SEF, 8 1/4"x13"(Folio) SEF
8K SEF (detected the same as DLT SEF, Default = DLT
SEF), 16K SEF (detected the same as LT SEF, Default =
LT SEF), 16K LEF (detected the same as LT LEF, Default
= LT LEF)
sRGB Supported: No
Network: TCP/IP
Sending E-mail: SMTP, POP, IMAP4
Protocol: Scan to Folder: SMB, FTP, NCP*
Web Services on Devices for Scanning
*Option
Item Spec.
Specifications
Auto Density Selection(Effective in BW/Grayscale and FC
Appendices:
scan mode)
Image Density:
Manual: 7 levels (Effective in BW/Grayscale and FC scan
mode)
Item Spec.
Scan to Email
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
Register Group Address in Max. 100 Group (Max. 500 addresses in one group
HDD: address)
Search methods of Email Direct input on operation panel, Web Image Monitor,
Address in HDD: Smart Device Monitor for Admin
Item Spec.
Manual:
Max. 128 Characters via soft key (1 byte: up to 128
characters, 2 byte: up to 64 characters)
Input Subject: User Pre-register:
22 subjects.
Max. 20 Characters per a subject (1 byte: up to 20
characters, 2 byte: up to 10 characters)
Manual:
Max. 80 Characters via soft key (1 byte: up to 80
characters, 2 byte: up to 40 characters)
User Pre-register:
Input Main body text: Max. 400 Characters via soft key (80 characters x 5 lines)
(1 byte: up to 400 characters, 2 byte: up to 200
characters)
Preset:
Yes
Divide and send Email (If the Yes (By page or size) / No, Default = Yes(By size)*
file size exceed the max *If the sent file size exceeded the maximum E-mail size, it
size.): would be divided to multiple sending. In addition, the sent
files might not be accepted by the receiving side due to
the limitation in the receiving capacity at the receiver
SMTP server or E-mail software setting.
Scan to Folder
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
Resolution: 100 dpi, 200 dpi (default), 300 dpi, 400 dpi, 600 dpi
Maintain client folder Direct input on operation panel, Web Image Monitor,
address in HDD: Smart Device Monitor
Max. client folder numbers Max. 50 client folders / PCs per send
per send:
Item Spec.
Input Subject: Max. 128 Characters via soft key (1 byte: up to 128
characters, 2 byte: up to 64 characters)
File Size when combined 128 - 102, 400 KB, Default = 2,048 KB (With restriction)
Scan to Folder & Scan to 725MB (Without restriction), (Scan to E-mail file size
E-mail: applied).
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Spec.
Endorser: Supported.
Date / Page Number / Text
Stamp: Supported
Remarks:
Y Yes; available
- Not available
NA EU/Asia
Size (W x L) [mm]
Book ADF Book ADF
NA EU/Asia
Size (W x L) [mm]
Specifications
Book ADF Book ADF
Appendices:
Foolscap SEF (81/2" x 13") - Y*Sc Y*D3 Y*D3
Sizes with letters (a, b, c) means only either size with the corresponding letter can be selected for
size detection. D is for default set sizes, and when setting S sizes for size detection from SP
mode, D sizes can no longer be detected.
(*2)For detected originals smaller then A5 size, with SP mode either detect as A5 or Detect as
Unknown can be selected. (Default is Detect as unknown)
(*3)F Sizes (8.5 x 13 SEF, 8.25 x 13 SEF, 8 x 13 SEF) will be available by SP mode settings.
(*4)Switch Book scanner original detection between K series and A/B series from SP mode.
(Can not set both to detect, but 8K/16K detect can de set from SO mode)
8K SEF -> Switch between A3, B4 SEF
16K SEF -> Switch between A4, A5, B5 SEF
16K LEF -> Switch between A4, A5, B5 LEF *Can not switch only either size.
(*5)Can be selected with switching A4/LT from SP mode:
Standard detect (default)
When placing A4/LT size LEF, detect as A4 LEF. When placing SEF, detect as LT SEF.
When placing A4/LT size LEF, detect as LT LEF. When placing SEF, detect as A4 SEF.
Remarks:
A Auto detectable. Also can be selected with size button of initial setting.
D Set dial to *, then select with size button from initial setting.
Bypass setting
E Copy window/Bypass/Standard size/Size select or select with the print bypass
paper size/size button from initial setting.
Bypass setting
I With bypass tray, after 1st sheet trailing edge goes through, auto detects size,
then fixed to size detected from the 2nd sheet.
Bypass setting
J
Auto detect of Copy window/Bypass/Standard size/Select with size button.
- Not available
Even the paper size is in the range or available sizes for duplex, envelopes can
*1
not be done so.
Tray 1 through 3
Specifications
Appendices:
Tray 3/4
Size (W x L) [mm] Tray 1 Tray 2 1 drawer
/2 drawers bank
A3 SEF G2 A2 G2 A2 G2 A2
A4 SEF A A A A A A
A4 LEF G1 A1 G1 A1 G1 A1
A5 SEF B B B B B B
A5 LEF A A A A A A
A6 SEF B B B B B B
B4 SEF G3 A3 G3 A3 G3 A3
B5 SEF A A A A A A
B5 LEF G4 A4 G4 A4 G4 A4
B6 SEF B B B B B B
DLT SEF A2 G2 A2 G2 A2 G2
Legal SEF A3 G3 A3 G3 A3 G3
Foolscap SEF B B B B B B
Letter SEF A A A A A A
Letter LEF A1 G1 A1 G1 A1 G1
GovernmentLG SEF B B B B B B
Folio SEF B B B B B B
F/GL SEF B B B B B B
Executive SEF B B B B B B
Executive LEF A4 G4 A4 G4 A4 G4
Tray 3/4
Size (W x L) [mm] Tray 1 Tray 2 1 drawer
/2 drawers bank
Com10 SEF B B B B B B
Com10 LEF B B B B B B
Monarch SEF B B B B B B
Monarch LEF - - - - - -
C5 SEF B B B B B B
C5 LEF B B B B B B
C6 SEF B B B B B B
C6 LEF B B B B B B
DL Env SEF B B B B B B
DL Env LEF B B B B B B
8K SEF B B B B B B
16K SEF B B B B B B
16K LEF B B B B B B
12x18 SEF - - - - - -
11x15 SEF B B B B B B
10x14 SEF B B B B B B
Bypass Trays
Specifications
Appendices:
Size (W x L) [mm] Bypass One Action Bypass
A3 SEF E J E J
A4 SEF E J J J
A4 LEF E J J J
A5 SEF E J J J
A5 LEF E J J J
A6 SEF E J E E
B4 SEF E J J J
B5 SEF E J J J
B5 LEF E J J J
B6 SEF J E J J
DLT SEF G1 E G1 E
Legal SEF E E E E
Foolscap SEF J1 E J1 E
Letter SEF J E J J
Letter LEF E E E E
Gov. LG SEF E E E E
Folio SEF E E J J
F/GL SEF E E E E
Executive SEF E E J J
Executive LEF J E J J
DL Env LEF E E J J
8K SEF E E E E
16K SEF E E E E
16K LEF J E J J
12x18 SEF E E E E
11x15 SEF E E J J
10x14 SEF E J E J
Specifications
Appendices:
Main Unit Tray, 1 Bin Tray, Shift Tray, Side Tray
A3 SEF A A A A A A
A4 SEF A A A A A A
A4 LEF A A A A A A
A5 SEF A A A A A A
A5 LEF A A A A A A
A6 SEF A B*1 A A A A
B4 SEF A A A A A A
B5 SEF A A A A A A
B5 LEF A A A A A A
B6 SEF A B*1 A A A A
DLT SEF A A A A A A
Legal SEF A A A A A A
Foolscap SEF A A A A A A
Letter SEF A A A A A A
Letter LEF A A A A A A
Gov. LG SEF A A A A A A
Folio SEF A A A A A A
F/GL SEF A A A A A A
Executive SEF A A A A A A
Executive LEF A A A A A A
C5 SEF A B*1 A A A A
C5 LEF A B*1 A A A A
C6 SEF A B*1 A A A A
8K SEF A A A A A A
16K SEF A A A A A A
16K LEF A A A A A A
11x15 SEF A A A A A A
10x14 SEF A A A A A A
Remarks:
Specifications
Appendices:
A Paper through, paper exit available.
- Not available.
The printer drivers and utility software are provided on one CD-ROM. An auto-run installer allows
you to select which components to install.
Y = Supported; N = Not Supported
Windows Environment
Windows Professional N N N N
2000
Server N N N N
Advanced Server N N N N
Datacenter Server N N N N
Windows Starter N N N N
Vista
Home Basic Y Y*1 Y*1 Y*1
Windows 7 Starter N N N N
Home Basic N N N N
Home Premium Y Y Y Y
Professional Y Y Y Y
Ultimate Y Y Y Y
Enterprise Y Y Y Y
Specifications
Windows 8 Windows 8 Y Y Y Y
Appendices:
Pro Y Y Y Y
Enterprise Y Y Y Y
RT N N N N
Datacenter Edition N N N N
Web Edition N N N N
Datacenter Edition N N N N
Web Edition N N N N
Web Edition N N N N
Windows Foundation Y Y Y Y
Server 2012
Essentials Y Y Y Y
Standard Y Y Y Y
Datacenter N N N N
Windows OS Drivers
Windows Server 7 Y Y Y N
2003 /2003 R2
8 Y Y Y N
Vista Y Y Y N
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows Server 7 Y Y Y Y
2008
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows Server 7 Y Y Y Y
2008R2
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows 2000 7 N N N N
Professional
8 N N N N
Server &
Advanced Vista N N N N
Server
XP N N N N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows XP 7 Y Y Y N
Windows OS Drivers
Specifications
Server Client(Push to) PCL5e PCL6 PostScript3 XPS
Appendices:
Professional 8 Y Y Y N
Vista Y Y Y N
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows Vista 7 Y Y Y Y
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows 7 7 Y Y Y Y
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows 8 7 Y Y Y Y
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
W2K Pro N N N N
Windows Server 7 Y Y Y Y
2012
8 Y Y Y Y
Vista Y Y Y Y
XP Y Y Y N
Platforms Version
Sun Solaris 9, 10
Specifications
Appendices:
Driver
Operating System
TWAIN*9 LAN-FAX
Windows XP*1*6 Y Y
Windows Vista*2*6 Y Y
Windows 7*3*6 Y Y
Windows 8*6*7 Y Y
Windows 8.1 Y Y
Macintosh N N
*1 Microsoft Windows XP Professional Edition / Home Edition / Media Center Edition / Tablet PC
Edition
*2 Microsoft Windows Vista Ultimate / Enterprise / Business / Home Premium / Home Basic
*3 Microsoft Windows 7 Home Premium / Professional / Ultimate / Enterprise
*4 Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition / Enterprise Edition / Microsoft Windows
Server 2003 R2 Standard Edition / Enterprise Edition
*5 Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Standard / Enterprise / Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2
Standard / Enterprise
*6 Supports both 32bit, 64bit (Scanner driver works on 32bit compatible mode)
*7 Microsoft Windows 8 (Core Edition) / Pro / Enterprise
*8 Microsoft Windows Server 2012 Standard / Datacenter / Essentials
*9 TWAIN scanner runs on a 64-bit operating system, but is not compatible with 64-bit
applications. Use it with 32-bit applications.
Item Description
Number of Trays: 2
Paper Capacity (80 g/m 2, 20 1100 sheets (550 sheets 2 trays with 80g/m 2 paper)
lb. Bond):
Item Description
Paper Output Capacity: 550 sheets (550 sheets x 1 tray with 80 g/m 2 paper)
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Description
Item Description
Item Description
Item Description
Item Description
Original Simplex: A3, A4, A5, B4, B5, B6 / DLT, LG, LT, HLT(11"*17" -
Size: 5.5"*8.5")
Custom Paper:
Vertical: 5.1"-11.7" / 128-297 mm
Horizontal: 5.1"- 49.6" / 128 - 1, 260 mm)
*Image quality of custom paper is not guaranteed.
Duplex: A3, A4, A5, B4, B5 / LG, LT, HLT, DLT (8.5 14
5.5*8.5)
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Description
Original Simplex: A3, A4, A5, B4, B5, B6, DLT, LG, LT, HLT
Size:
Duplex: A3, A4, A5, B4, B5, DLT, LG, LT, HLT
Item Description
Item Description
Item Description
Paper Output Capacity: 250 sheets with 80 g/m2 paper (A4, LT or smaller)
125 sheets with 80 g/m2 paper (B4, LG or smaller)
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Description
Power Consumption: 12 W
Item Description
[D689]
3,000 sheets:A4 LEF, LT LEF
1,500 sheets:A3 SEF, A4 SEF, B4 SEF, B5, DLT SEF, LG
SEF, LT SEF, 12"x18" SEF, SRA3 SEF, 13" x 19.2" SEF
500 sheets:A5 LEF
100 sheets:A5 SEF, B6 SEF, A6 SEF, HLT SEF
*Paper size not listed above:
1,500 sheets: Length: 182 488 mm
500 sheets: Length: 148 182 mm
Item Description
Specifications
Stack Normal [D688]
Appendices:
Capacity: Staple Sort: 2-12 sheets/set A4/LT LEF:
No. of sets: 150 set
Max Stack Capacity: 2,000 sheets
13-50 sheets/set A4/LT LEF:
No. of sets: 150-40 set
Max Stack Capacity: 2,000 sheets
2-9 sheets/set A4/LT SEF, B5:
No. of sets: 100 set
Max Stack Capacity: 1,000 sheets
10-50 sheets/set A4/LT SEF, B5:
No. of sets: 100-20 set
Max Stack Capacity: 1,000 sheets
2-9 sheets/set Paper size not listed above:
No. of sets: 100 set
Max Stack Capacity: 1,000sheets
10-50 sheets/set Paper size not listed above:
No. of sets: 100-20 set
Max Stack Capacity: 1,000sheets
Item Description
Stack Mixed Size 2-50 sheets: A4 LEF and A3 SEF, B5 LEF and B4 SEF, LT
Capacity: (D689 only): LEF and DLT SEF
No. of sets: 30set
Item Description
Specifications
Staple Paper Weight: Normal Staple: 52 105 g/m 2 (14 28 lb.)
Appendices:
Saddle Stitch Staple (D688 only): 64 105 g/m 2 (17 28
lb.)
Weight: [D688]
52.5 kg (115.7 lb.) or less
56.5 kg (124.6 lb.) or less with Punch Unit
[D689]
33.5 kg (73.9 lb.) or less
38.0 kg (83.8 lb.) or less with Punch Unit
Item Description
Item Description
[D687]
1000 sheets: A4, LT or smaller
500 sheets: B4, LG or larger
Item Description
Specifications
Stack Normal [D686]
Appendices:
Capacity: Staple Sort: 2-9 sheets/set A4/B5/LT LEF:
No. of sets: 100 set
10-50 sheets/set A4/B5/LT LEF:
No. of sets: 100-20 set
Max Stack Capacity: 1,000 sheets
2-9 sheets/set A4/B5/LT SEF:
No. of sets: 50set
10-50 sheets/set A4/B5/LT SEF:
No. of sets: 50-10 set
Max Stack Capacity: 500 sheets
2-9 sheets/set A3/B4/DLT/LG:
No. of sets: 50 set
10-30 sheets/set A3/B4/DLT/LG:
No. of sets: 50-10 set
Max Stack Capacity: 500 sheets
Mixed Size 2-22 sheets: A4 LEF and A3 SEF, B5 LEF and B4 SEF, LT
(D687 only): LEF and DLT SEF (No. of sets: 22 set)
Item Description
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Description
Item Description
Specifications
Appendices:
Item Description
Staple Paper Size: A3, B4, A4 SEF/LEF, B5 SEF/LEF, DLT, LG, LT SEF/LEF,
Foolscap , Government LG, Folio, Executive SEF/LEF, 8K,
16K SEF/LEF
Item Description
Paper Size: NA/2 Holes: SEF: A3, A4, DLT, LG, LT, Foolscap, Executive
LEF: A4, LT
EU/2 Holes: SEF: A3, A4, B4, B5, DLT, LG, LT, Foolscap, Executive,
8K, 16K
LEF: A4, B5, LT, 16K
SC/2 Holes: SEF: A3, A4, B4, B5, DLT, LG, LT, Foolscap, Executive
LEF: A4, B5, LT
TABLES
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
2.1.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE ITEMS
TABLES
The amounts mentioned as the PM interval indicate the number of prints.
Chart: A4/LT (LEF) / 6%
Mode:
D197/D198: 3 copies/original (prints/job)
D199/D200/D201/D202: 5 copies/original (prints/job)
Environment: Normal temperature and humidity
Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions.
Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricant, I: Inspect
Mainframe: D197/D198/D199
Development C/I/L - - - -
Roller
Development Side R - - - -
Seal
Charge Roller R - - - -
Cleaner
Cleaning Blade R - - - -
Pick-off Pawl R - - - -
MAINTENANCE
Quenching Lamp C/I/L - - - -
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
TABLES
PCL C/I/L - - - -
MAINTENANCE
Pickup Roller - - - C -
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
TABLES
Duplex Transport - - - C -
Roller
Mainframe: D200/D201/D202
Development C/I/L - - - -
Roller
Development Side R - - - -
Seal
Charge Roller R - - - -
Cleaner
Cleaning Blade R - - - -
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
TABLES
Cleaning Blade C/I/L - - - -
Side Seal
Pick-off Pawl R - - - -
PCL C/I/L - - - -
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
TABLES
Vertical Transport - - - C - Wipe with a cloth
Roller dampened with
ethyl alcohol.
Duplex Transport - - - C -
Roller
ARDF DF3090
Platen Sheet C - - -
Wipe with a cloth dampened
Other Rollers C - - -
with ethyl alcohol.
Scanner Guide Plate C - - -
SPDF DF3080
MAINTENANCE
Wipe with a cloth dampened
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
Feed Belt C R R R
TABLES
with ethyl alcohol or water.
Platen Sheet C - - -
Wipe with a cloth dampened
Other Rollers C - - -
with ethyl alcohol.
Scanner Guide Plate C - - -
Item EM Note
Pick-up Roller C
Wipe with a cloth dampened with ethyl alcohol.
Separation Roller C
Relay Rollers C
LCIT PB3170/PB3230
Item EM Note
Pick-up Roller C
Wipe with a cloth dampened with ethyl alcohol.
Separation Roller C
Relay Rollers C
LCIT RT3030
Item EM Note
Pick-up Roller C
Wipe with a cloth dampened with ethyl alcohol.
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
Separation Roller C
TABLES
Relay Rollers C
Item EM Note
Item EM Note
Item EM Note
Item EM Note
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
Clean with a dry cloth if dirt
Quenching brush - - - C
TABLES
adheres on it.
Item EM Note
Item EM Note
MAINTENANCE
APPENDICES:
PREVENTIVE
Symbol keys: U: Unique for this model, C: Common with listed model
TABLES
Mainframe:
Part Unique or
Description Qty/Unit Expected Yield (Pages)
Number Common
Part Unique or
Description Qty/Unit Expected Yield (Pages)
Number Common
Part Unique or
Description Qty/Unit Expected Yield (Pages)
Number Common
1. INSTALLATION ................................................................................ 1
1.1 FAX OPTION TYPE M12 ...............................................................................1
1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................1
1.1.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................................2
1.2 G3 INTERFACE UNIT TYPE M12 .................................................................6
1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK .........................................................................6
1.2.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ............................................................7
For Installing the single G3 Board ............................................................7
For Installing the Double G3 Boards ......................................................10
1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS ...................................................................................16
1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT TYPE M12 64MB ......................................................16
1.3.2 HANDSET HS3020 .............................................................................18
1.4 FAX CONNECTION UNIT TYPE M12 .........................................................22
1.4.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ..........................................................22
Installing the application in the Remote Machine and Client-side Machine22
Registering the Client-side Machine(s)...................................................24
Registering the Remote Machine ...........................................................26
Configuring the Remote Reception Settings ..........................................27
Remote Fax Icon Addition for Remote Machine .....................................29
3. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................... 35
3.1 ERROR CODES ..........................................................................................35
3.2 FAX CONNECTION UNIT ERROR CODES ................................................58
3.2.1 FAX CONNECTION UNIT ERROR CODE LIST .................................58
MACHINE_ERR_01 ...............................................................................58
MACHINE_ERR_02 ...............................................................................58
MACHINE_ERR_03 ...............................................................................59
MACHINE_ERR_04 ...............................................................................59
MACHINE_ERR_05 ...............................................................................60
MACHINE_ERR_06 ...............................................................................60
MACHINE_ERR_07 ...............................................................................60
SM i D3A5
MACHINE_ERR_08 ...............................................................................61
3.3 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ........................................................................62
3.4 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................65
3.4.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION ....................................................................65
Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name .................................................65
Cannot send via VoIP Gateway .............................................................66
Cannot send by Alias Fax number. ........................................................67
3.4.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ..........................................................................69
Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. ...........................................69
Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway...........................................................70
Cannot receive by Alias Fax number......................................................71
SM iii D3A5
6.5.1 G3 INTERFACE UNIT TYPE M12 .................................................... 219
D3A5 iv SM
READ THIS FIRST
Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord.
The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this
type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer.
Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturers instructions and local
regulations.
Screw
Connector
Clip ring
Clamp
Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of
valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine.
Always obey these guidelines to avoid serious problems such as misfeeds, damage to
originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. bold is added for
emphasis.
This document provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.
Fax Option Type M12
1. INSTALLATION
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
1.1 FAX OPTION TYPE M12
1 FCU 1
2 Clamp 2
3 Ferrite Core 2
4 Screw: M3x6 1
SM 1 D3A5
Fax Option Type M12
3. Remove the "TEL" [A] and "LINE1" [B] covers on the FCU slot cover with a screw
driver.
D3A5 2 SM
Fax Option Type M12
FAX OPTION
SC672 may occur when turning on the machine with the jumper switch OFF.
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
5. Insert the SAF memory [A] in the memory slot on the FCU board if the optional memory
is to be installed.
6. Align the FCU board with the rails [A], and then install the FCU [B] fully into the FCU
slot.
SM 3 D3A5
Fax Option Type M12
For details, refer to "Handset Installation" in the Service Manual for the Fax Unit
(D3A5).
Only for the Taiwan model, install the telephone jack cap in the TEL jack if the handset
is not installed on the machine.
11. Make two loops with the telephone cord, and then attach the ferrite core [A].
D3A5 4 SM
Fax Option Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
14. Attach the fax key top decal [A] to the second key top from the top.
15. Attach the fax serial number decal [A] to the bottom of the controller cover.
16. Attach the FCC decal on the rear lower cover of the machine (NA only).
17. Put the power plug into the outlet and turn on the main power of the machine.
SM 5 D3A5
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
This G3 interface unit option is used only for Fax Option Type M12 model.
2 Screw: M3x6 4
3 Flat Cable 1
- Ferrite Core 1
D3A5 6 SM
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Before installing this optional unit:
Print out all data in the printer buffer.
Turn off the main switch and disconnect the power cord and the network cable.
You can add two more SG3 boards to this model. Follow the procedures for adding the single SG3
board installation or double SG3 board installation as the customer needs.
SM 7 D3A5
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
5. Attach one end of the flat cable [B] to CN660 on the CCU I/F board [A] of the SG3
interface unit.
Make sure that the blue tape of the flat cable faces outward.
Lock the FFC with the black tab [A].
6. Connect the other end [A] of the flat cable to CN603 on the FCU board.
D3A5 8 SM
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
7. Install the SG3 interface unit [A] ( x 4).
Insert the tab of the SG3 interface unit in the cutout of the controller box.
Push the flat cable [B] inside the machine.
10. Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE 2" jack for single SG3 board installation.
11. Hold the telephone line with the clamps [A] as shown below.
SM 9 D3A5
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
12. Connect the power plug to a power outlet and turn on the main power switch.
13. Enter the service mode. Set bit 1 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023).
14. Exit the service mode.
15. Turn the main power switch off and on.
16. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option.
17. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-2 communications.
D3A5 10 SM
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
3. Remove the controller rear cover [A] ( x 5).
4. Remove the "LINE2" [A] and "LINE3" [B] covers with a screw driver.
SM 11 D3A5
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
5. Remove the SG3 board [A] from one of the SG3 interface units ( x 2).
6. Attach the SG3 board [A] removed in step 5 to the CCU I/F of the other SG3 interface
unit [B] ( x 2).
7. Attach one end [A] of the flat cable to CN660 on the CCU I/F board of the SG3 interface
unit [B].
Make sure that the blue tape of the flat cable faces outward.
D3A5 12 SM
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Make sure that the blue tape of the flat cable faces outward.
Lock the FFC with the black tab [A].
8. Connect the other end [A] of the flat cable to CN603 on the FCU board.
SM 13 D3A5
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
Only for installing the double SG3 board in Taiwan, attach the NCC decal to the frame [A]
of the SG3 interface unit as shown below.
12. Connect the telephone cords to the "LINE2" and "LINE3" jacks.
13. Hold the telephone lines with the clamps [A] as shown below.
D3A5 14 SM
G3 Interface Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
14. Connect the power plug to a power outlet and turn on the main power switch.
15. Enter the service mode. Set bit 1 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023).
16. Set bit 3 of communication switch 16 to "1" (SP1-104-023).
17. Exit the service mode.
18. Turn the main power switch off and on.
19. Print out the system parameter list. Then check that "G3" shows as an option.
20. Set up and program the items required for PSTN-2 communications.
SM 15 D3A5
Fax Unit Options
D3A5 16 SM
Fax Unit Options
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
4. Install the memory option [A] on the FCU.
SM 17 D3A5
Fax Unit Options
D3A5 18 SM
Fax Unit Options
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
4. Remove the left rear cover [A] ( 2).
SM 19 D3A5
Fax Unit Options
12. Make two loops with the telephone cord, and then attach the ferrite core [A] to the
cable.
D3A5 20 SM
Fax Unit Options
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
13. Connect the cable to the "TEL" jack on the left side of the controller box.
SM 21 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
Do not register the Remote Machine before the Client-side Machine is registered in
the Remote Machine. Otherwise, registering the Remote Machine fails.
4. Register the Remote Machine in the Client-side Machine.
2. Insert the SD card (Fax Connection Unit Type M12) in SD slot 1 (upper) with its label
face towards the front of the machine if SD slot 1 is vacant. If not, follow the procedure
below.
D3A5 22 SM
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
4. Press [Firmware Version] in the [Administrator Tools].
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
[User Tools/Counter] > [System Settings] > [Administrator Tools]
5. Check whether the aics version is displayed.
SM 23 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
Do not register the Remote Machine in the Client-side machine before the Client-side
Machine is registered in the Remote Machine. Otherwise, registering the Remote
Machine fails.
On the Remote Machine:
1. Press the [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel.
2. Press [System Settings].
3. Press [Administrator Tools].
4. Press [Program/Change/Delete Remote Machine].
5. Press one of the machine registration lines, and then enter the IP address or host
name of one of the Client-side Machines.
6. Press [Connection Test] to check the connection with the client-side machine.
D3A5 24 SM
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
If an error message is displayed, check the network connection with the client-side
machine and make sure that the IP address of the client-side machine is correct.
8. Presss [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel to terminate the System
Settings.
SM 25 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
First register the Client-side Machine in the Remote Machine before proceding this
procedure. Otherwise, registering the Remote Machine fails.
7. Press [Connection Test] to check the connection with the remote machine.
If an error message is displayed, check the network connection with the remote machine
and make sure that the IP address of the remote machine is correct.
D3A5 26 SM
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
8. Press [OK] after Connection Test has been successfully done.
9. Presss [User Tools/Counter] key on the operation panel to terminate the System
Settings.
SM 27 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
D3A5 28 SM
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
The icon of the fax communication is supposed to appear automatically on the home screen of the
(D3A5)
Client-side Machine(s) after installation of the Fax Communication. If the icon of the fax
communication does not appear, add the icon manually. This procedure allows the remote fax
icon to appear on the home screen of the operation panel.
On both the Remote Machine and the Client-side Machines:
1. Press [User Tools].
2. Press [Edit Home].
SM 29 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Type M12
D3A5 30 SM
FCU
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
2.1 FCU
The following data can be transfered: TTI, RTI, CSI, Fax bit switch settings, RAM address
settings, NCU parameter settings
1. Remove the controller cover [A] ( x 4).
3. Replace the installed FCU board [A] with a new FCU board ( x 3, x 1).
SM 31 D3A5
FCU
4. Attach the flat cable [A] to CN603 of the new fax unit.
Use caution to avoid an oblique insertion of the cable.
Make sure that the blue tapes of the flat cable face outward.
If you do not switch the battery jumper switch position, SC820 will occur.
6. Reinstall the new fax unit in the FCU slot ( x 3).
7. Remove the controller rear cover [A] ( x 5).
D3A5 32 SM
FCU
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
8. Attach the bracket [A] provided with the new fax unit to the center frame of the
controller box ( x 1).
9. Attach the FCU board removed in step 3 to the bracket attached in step 8. Then attach
the flat cable attached in step 4 to CN603 of the removed FCU board ( x 1).
Make sure that the blue tape of the flat cable faces outward.
The removed FCU board must be away from the metal frames. Otherwise, the
removed FCU board may get a short circuit.
10. Install the jumper switch [B] in CN616 on the replaced FCU [A].
SM 33 D3A5
FCU
D3A5 34 SM
Error Codes
3. TROUBLESHOOTING
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
3.1 ERROR CODES
If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the
problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display
and on the service report.
SM 35 D3A5
Error Codes
D3A5 36 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
The other end may have jammed, or run
out of paper or memory space.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.
The other end sent RTN or
The other end may have a defective
PIN after receiving a page,
0-08 modem/FCU; try sending to another
because there were too many
machine.
errors
Check for line problems and noise.
Cross reference
Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Dedicated Tx parameters in Service
Program Mode
SM 37 D3A5
Error Codes
Communication was If the Stop key was not pressed and this error
0-17 interrupted by pressing the keeps occurring, replace the operation panel or
Stop key the operation panel drive board.
D3A5 38 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
Defective remote terminal.
The signal from the other end
Check for line noise or other line problems.
was interrupted for more than
0-22 Try adjusting the acceptable modem
the acceptable modem carrier
carrier drop time.
drop time (default: 200 ms)
Cross reference
Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3
Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1
SM 39 D3A5
Error Codes
The called terminal fell back to The terminal could not detect ANSam.
T.30 mode, because it could Check the line connection and condition.
0-75
not detect a CM in response Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34
to ANSam (ANSam timeout). fax.
D3A5 40 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
The calling terminal could not detect a JM
The called terminal fell back to due to noise, etc.
T.30 mode, because it could A network that has narrow bandwidth
0-77 not detect a CJ in response to cannot pass JM to the other end.
JM Check the line connection and condition.
(JM timeout). Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34
fax.
The called terminal detected Check for line noise or other line problems.
0-79 CI while waiting for a V.21 If this error occurs, the called terminal falls
signal. back to T.30 mode.
The line was disconnected The guard timer expired while starting
0-80 due to a timeout in V.34 phase these phases. Serious noise, narrow
2 line probing. bandwidth, or low signal level can cause
these errors.
The line was disconnected
If these errors happen at the transmitting
0-81 due to a timeout in V.34 phase
terminal:
3 equalizer training.
Try making a call at a later time.
The line was disconnected Try using V.17 or a slower modem using
due to a timeout in the V.34 dedicated tx parameters.
0-82
phase 4 control channel Try increasing the tx level.
start-up. Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.
If these errors happen at the receiving terminal:
The line was disconnected Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting.
SM 41 D3A5
Error Codes
JBIG compression or
2-23 Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
reconstruction error
2-24 JBIG ASIC error Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
D3A5 42 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
JBIG data reconstruction error
2-25
(BIH error)
FCU defective
2-29 JBIG trailing edge maker error
Check the destination device.
The machine resets itself for a If this is frequent, update the ROM, or
2-50
fatal FCU system error replace the FCU.
Communication failed
because of an ID Code Get the ID Codes the same and/or the
mismatch (Closed Network) or CSIs programmed correctly, then resend.
4-10
Tel. No./CSI mismatch The machine at the other end may be
(Protection against Wrong defective.
Connections)
SM 43 D3A5
Error Codes
D3A5 44 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Check for a noisy line.
Adjust the tx levels of the communicating
6-09 G3 ECM - ERR received
machines.
See code 6-05.
V.21 flag detected during high The other terminal may be defective or
6-21
speed modem communication incompatible.
SM 45 D3A5
Error Codes
D3A5 46 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Failed to access the SMTP server because
the access is denied.
SMTP server operating incorrectly.
Contact the system administrator to
determine if there is a problem with the
SMTP server and to check that the SMTP
server settings are correct.
Folder send destination is incorrect.
Access to SMTP Server Contact the system administrator to
14-03
Denied (450) determine that the SMTP server settings
and path to the server are correct.
Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the
user name and password settings are
correct.
Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact
the system administrator to determine if
there is a problem at the destination at that
the settings at the destination are correct.
SM 47 D3A5
Error Codes
D3A5 48 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Failed to access the SMTP server because
the transmission failed.
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Data Send to SMTP Server
14-08 Destination folder setting incorrect.
Failed (5XX)
Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly.
Software application error.
SM 49 D3A5
Error Codes
Cancelled the Mail Due to Error detected with NFAX and send was
14-32
Error Detected by NFAX cancelled due to a software error.
D3A5 50 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send
was cancelled:
14-50 Mail Job Task Error Address book was being edited during
creation of the notification mail.
Software error.
Notification Mail Send Failed All addresses for return notification mail
14-61
for All Destinations failed.
SM 51 D3A5
Error Codes
15-03 Mail Address Not Registered The mail address has not been registered.
15-10 DCS Mail Receive Error Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.
D3A5 52 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
POP3/IMAP4 send authorization failed:
Incorrect IFAX user name or password.
15-12 Authorization Error Access was attempted by another device,
such as the PC.
POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect.
15-18 Incomplete Mail Received Only one portion of the mail was received.
SM 53 D3A5
Error Codes
15-61 Attachment File Format Error The attached file is not TIFF format.
D3A5 54 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Could not find the Disposition line in the
15-73 MDN Status Error header of the Return Receipt, or there is a
problem with the firmware.
SM 55 D3A5
Error Codes
No G3 parameter confirmation
22-05 Defective FCU board or firmware.
answer
D3A5 56 SM
Error Codes
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
The machine software resets
Update the ROM
25-00 itself after a fatal transmission
Replace the FCU.
error occurred
SM 57 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Error Codes
MACHINE_ERR_01
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
MACHINE_ERR_02
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
D3A5 58 SM
Fax Connection Unit Error Codes
MACHINE_ERR_03
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
MACHINE_ERR_04
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
SM 59 D3A5
Fax Connection Unit Error Codes
MACHINE_ERR_05
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
MACHINE_ERR_06
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
MACHINE_ERR_07
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
D3A5 60 SM
Fax Connection Unit Error Codes
MACHINE_ERR_08
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Error
Suggested Cause Action
Code
SM 61 D3A5
IFAX Troubleshooting
Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is
causing the problem.
Communication
Item Action [Remarks]
Route
General LAN 1. Connection with Check that the LAN cable is connected
the LAN to the machine.
Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit.
Between IFAX and 1. Network settings Check the network settings on the PC.
PC on the PC [Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP
properties in the network setup correct?
Check the IP address with the
administrator of the network.]
D3A5 62 SM
IFAX Troubleshooting
Communication
Item Action [Remarks]
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Route
(D3A5)
Between machine 1. LAN settings in Check the LAN parameters
and e-mail server the machine Check if there is an IP address conflict
with other PCs.
[Use the Network function in the User
Tools.
If there is an IP address conflict, inform the
administrator.]
Between e-mail 1. E-mail account on Make sure that the PC can log into the
server and internet the Server e-mail server.
Check that the account and password
stored in the server are the same as in
the machine.
[Ask the administrator to check.]
SM 63 D3A5
IFAX Troubleshooting
Communication
Item Action [Remarks]
Route
D3A5 64 SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
3.4.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION
SM 65 D3A5
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
6 Number of the specified fax correct? Check the remote fax number.
D3A5 66 SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3
(D3A5)
IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the
DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to
1.
10 IP address of local fax registered? Register the IP address of the local fax.
SM 67 D3A5
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
D3A5 68 SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name.
Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port
4
fax (if required)? number.
Specified port number correct (if Request the sender to check the port
5
required)? number.
7 Network bandwidth too narrow? Lower the start modem reception baud
rate on the receiving side.
IPFAX SW06
SM 69 D3A5
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP
5
Gateway correct on senders side? address/host name.
D3A5 70 SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Check Point Action
SM 71 D3A5
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
10 Network bandwidth too narrow? Lower the start modem reception baud rate
on the receiving side.
IPFAX SW06
D3A5 72 SM
Cautions
4. SERVICE TABLES
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
4.1 CAUTIONS
Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power
off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.
The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the
main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.
SM 73 D3A5
Service Program Tables
System Switch
101 Change the bit switches for system settings for the
001 032 00 1F fax option
"page 84" : "System Switches"
Ifax Switch
102 Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for
001 016 00 0F the fax option
"page 99" : "I-Fax Switches"
Printer Switch
103 Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax
001 016 00 0F option
"page 99" : "Printer Switches"
Communication Switch
G3-1 Switch
G3-2 Switch
D3A5 74 SM
Service Program Tables
G3-3 Switch
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
107 Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of
001 016 00 0F the optional G3 board
"page 137" : "G3-2 and G3-3 Switches"
G4 Internal Switch
108
001 032 00 1F Not used (Do not change the bit switches)
G4 Parameter Switch
109
001 016 00 0F Not used (Do not change the bit switches)
IP fax Switch
RAM Read/Write
Memory Dump
G3-1 Memory Print out RAM data for the fax board.
001
Dump page 179
G3-2 Memory Print out RAM data for the optional SG3
102 002
Dump board.
G3-3 Memory Print out RAM data for the optional SG3
003
Dump board.
SM 75 D3A5
Service Program Tables
Service Station
101 001 Fax Number Enter the fax number of the service station.
Serial Number
102
000 Enter the fax units serial number.
Memory Lock
003 Not used
Disabled
104 Select the line setting for the G3-2 line. If the
001 Select Line machine is installed on a PABX line, select
PABX, PABX(GND) or PABX(FLASH).
D3A5 76 SM
Service Program Tables
PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-2
002
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Number line.
(D3A5)
Memory Lock
003 Not used
Disabled
PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-3
105 002
Number line.
Memory Lock
003 Not used
Disabled
Transmission
004
Disabled
SM 77 D3A5
Service Program Tables
IPFAX Protocol
007 Select "H323" or "SIP".
Priority
FAX SW
201
001 032 00 1F
101 001 FCU ROM Version Displays the FCU ROM version.
102 001 Error Codes Displays the latest 64 fax error codes.
103 001 G3-1 ROM Version Displays the G3-1 modem version.
104 001 G3-2 ROM Version Displays the G3-2 modem version.
105 001 G3-3 ROM Version Displays the G3-3 modem version.
106 001 G4 ROM Version Not used (Do not change the settings.)
D3A5 78 SM
Service Program Tables
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
5 Mode No. Function
101 Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in
000
the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock.
Factory Setting
104 Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the
000
SRAM and files in the SAF memory.
106 Resets only the security bit switches. If you select automatic
000 output/display for the user parameter switches, the security
settings are initialized.
SM 79 D3A5
Service Program Tables
D3A5 80 SM
Service Program Tables
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
006 Bch 2 Link Layer
002 Printer
004 Decompression
005 Scanner
107 006 JOB/SAF These log print out functions are for designer
008 JBIG
010 G3CCU
012 CCU
SM 81 D3A5
Service Program Tables
7 Function
D3A5 82 SM
Service Program Tables
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
118 G3-3 DTMF Tests
SM 83 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
D3A5 84 SM
Bit Switches - 1
Example:
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
(1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors.
(2): Symbol rate (V.34 only)
(3): Final modem type used
(4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps)
(5): Final data rate
(6): Rx revel (see below for how to read the rx level)
(7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
(8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
Rx level calculation
Example:
The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after "L" indicates the rx level.
The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of
N by -16 to get the rx level.
In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256.
So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB
SM 85 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
G3 Communication Parameters
D3A5 86 SM
Bit Switches - 1
0: 0 ms/line
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
5: 5 ms/line
(D3A5)
10: 10 ms/line
20: 20 ms/line
I/O rate 25: 2.5 ms/line
40: 40 ms/line
System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
System Switch 03 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
SM 87 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
Printing of the error code on the 1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.
3 error report This can be used for detecting an error which
0: No 1: Yes occurs rarely.
D3A5 88 SM
Bit Switches - 1
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
1: A power failure report will be automatically
printed after the power is switched on if a fax
Power failure report message disappeared from the memory when
5 0: Disabled the power was turned off last.
1: Enabled (default) NOTE: If "0" is selected, no reports are printed
and no one may recognize that fax data is gone
due to a power failure.
No Function Comments
SM 89 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
On hook dial
5 0: On hook dial is disabled.
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
D3A5 90 SM
Bit Switches - 1
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
System Switch 0F (SP No. 1-101-016)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
11: USA
SM 91 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm
Input even numbers only.
This setting determines the print start position
for the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the
TTI printing position in the main
0-7 TTI is moved too far to the right, it may
scan direction
overwrite the file number which is on the top
right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is
moved over by more than 50 mm, it may
overwrite the page number.
D3A5 92 SM
Bit Switches - 1
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
System Switch 13 - Not used (do not change these settings)
(D3A5)
System Switch 14 - Not used (do not change these settings)
No Function Comments
1 0 1 hour
1 1 24 hours
SM 93 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
No Function Comments
Priority setting for the G3 line. This function allows the user to select the
1 0: PSTN-1 > PSTN-2 or 3 default G3 line type. The optional SG3 units are
1: PSTN-2 or 3 > PSTN-1 required to use the PSTN-2 or 3 setting.
D3A5 94 SM
Bit Switches - 1
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
System Switch 19 (SP No. 1-101-026)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
* This setting can be used for the client machine which has no FCU.
No Function Comments
SM 95 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
D3A5 96 SM
Bit Switches - 1
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
scanning for a memory transmission, the
(D3A5)
successfully scanned pages are transmitted.
Action when the SAF memory 1: If the SAF memory becomes full during
has become full during scanning for a memory transmission, the file is
1* scanning erased and no pages are transmitted.
0: The current page is erased.
1: The entire file is erased. This setting is effective only when
Automatic Journal printout is enabled
but the machine cannot print the report
(e.g., no paper).
* This setting can be used for the client machine which has no FCU.
SM 97 D3A5
Bit Switches - 1
No Function Comments
D3A5 98 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
0 A4
1 B4
2 A3 -
3-6 Reserved
7 Not used
SM 99 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
No Function Comments
0 200x100 Standard
1 200x200 Detail
0: Not selected
2 200x400 Fine 1: Selected
If more than one of these three bits is set to "1",
3 300 x 300 Reserve
the higher resolution has priority. For example,
4 400 x 400 Super Fine if both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to "1" Then The
Resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400.
5 600 x 600 Reserve
6 Reserve
7 mm/inch
D3A5 100 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
I-fax Switch 02 (SP No. 1-102-003)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails
when they are received.
0: Prints only text mail.
0 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail.
When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the "From" address and
"Subject" address are printed as header information.
When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this
setting is ignored and no header is printed.
This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail
attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs.
1 This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their
intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example.
0: Prints 1st page only.
1: Prints all pages.
2-3 This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms
the transmission was received normally at the destination.
SM 101 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
00: "Dispatched"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "dispatched" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched
The "dispatched" string is included in the Subject string.
01: "Displayed"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "displayed" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed
The "displayed" string is included in the Subject string.
10: Reserved
11: Reserved
A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to "00"
(for "dispatched") received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any
setting other than "displayed" (01) causes a problem, change the setting to "01" to
enable normal sending of the Return Receipt.
This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to
confirm a reception.
4 0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail
1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail.
Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer
mail, which contains the media accept feature field.
7 0: 200 x 200
1: 400 x 400
The "1" setting requires installation of the Memory Unit in order to have enough
SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.
D3A5 102 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
I-fax Switch 04 (SP No. 1-102-005)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the
RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents.
0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the
0 RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line.
1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line.
When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in
the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to
determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail.
This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up
for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and
when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving
transmissions).
SM 103 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
No Function Comments
0 For example:
"1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a
broadcast to 9 destinations.
0: Not recorded
1: Recorded
IFAXTX Retries
Determines whether the machine retries sending IFAX when connection and
1 transmission fails due to errors.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
No Function Comments
This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF
stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and
also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of
0-7 SAF memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received;
received mail is then stored on the mail server.
00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX)
The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount
of memory.
D3A5 104 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
I-fax Switch 09 (SP No. 1-102-010)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
0 1 No setting
1 0 Individual setting
1 1 Always sign
0 1 No setting
1 0 Individual setting
SM 105 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
1 1 Always sign
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered
0 or output immediately.
0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery.
1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations.
1 0: No sign
1: Always sign
2 0: No encryption
1: Encryption
D3A5 106 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Printer Switch 00 (SP No. 1-103-001)
No Function Comments
SM 107 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
No Function Comments
1 0 B4
1 1 A4
Relationship between available paper sizes and printer width used in the setup protocol
B5 256 mm width
D3A5 108 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
* This setting can be used for the client-side machine which has no FCU.
SM 109 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
No Function Comments
* This setting can be used for the client-side machine which has no FCU.
D3A5 110 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Printer Switch 04 (SP No. 1-103-005)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0
above.
[Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + (N x 5mm)
"N" is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4.
0 0 1 0 0 20 mm
1 1 1 1 1 155 mm
Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has
taken place.
5 0 0 4 mm
6
0 1 10 mm
1 0 15 mm
1 1 Not used
SM 111 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
No Function Comments
* This setting can be used for the client-side machine which has no FCU.
No Function Comments
D3A5 112 SM
Bit Switches - 2
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
Paper size selected for printing A4 This switch determines which paper size
width fax data is selected for printing A4 width fax data,
1*
0: 8.5" x 11" size when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x
1: A4 size 11" size paper.
1 1 Not used
SM 113 D3A5
Bit Switches - 2
* This setting can be used for the client-side machine which has no FCU.
No Function Comments
Smoothing feature
1 1 Not used
Duplex printing
1: The machine always prints received
2* 0: Disabled
fax messages in duplex printing mode:
1: Enabled
* This setting can be used for the client-side machine which has no FCU.
D3A5 114 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
1 0 MH/MR/MMR
1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG
1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG
SM 115 D3A5
Bit Switches - 3
No Function Comments
Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting digits of the received CSI do not match the last
8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This
2-3 0 0 None does not work when manually dialed.
0 1 8 digit CSI (1,0): The same as above, except that only the
last 4 digits are compared.
1 0 4 digit CSI (1,1): The machine will disconnect the line
without sending a fax message, if the other end
1 1 CSI/RTI
D3A5 116 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(0,0): Nothing is checked; transmission will
(D3A5)
always go ahead.
1 0 A4 (297 mm)
1 1 Not used
No Function Comments
SM 117 D3A5
Bit Switches - 3
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Remote mode switch (FAX mode) Set this bit to ON when you wish to turn on
1 0: Disable the remote mode switch after automatic
1: Enable (Active) reception with FAX mode.
Remote mode switch (AUTO mode) Set this bit to ON when you wish to turn on
2 0: Disable the remote mode switch after automatic
1: Enable (Active) reception with AUTO mode.
D3A5 118 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
SM 119 D3A5
Bit Switches - 3
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
D3A5 120 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Communication Switch 0E (SP No. 1-104-015)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s
Minimum interval between (e.g., 06(H) = 12 s)
0-7
automatic dialing attempts This value is the minimum time that the machine
waits before it dials the next destination.
No Function Comments
Memory transmission:
Maximum number of dialing
0-7 01 FE (Hex) times
attempts to the same
destination
No Function Comments
SM 121 D3A5
Bit Switches - 3
No Function Comments
1 1 Not used
D3A5 122 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Communication Switch 16 (SP No. 1-104-023)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
2 Not used
No Function Comments
PWD reception
0: Disables features that require PWD
2 0: Disabled
(Password) signal reception.
1: Enabled
SM 123 D3A5
Bit Switches - 3
No Function Comments
IP-Fax dial-in routing selection 1: Transfers received data to each IP-Fax dial-in
5 0: Off number.
1: On IP-Fax dial-in number is a 4-digit number.
D3A5 124 SM
Bit Switches - 3
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Communication Switch 1B (SP No. 1-104-028)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
SM 125 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES
No Function Comments
Dedicated G3 line mode selection Set this bit to 1 when you wish to dedicate a
6
0: Off 1: On (Dedicated) line for G3.
D3A5 126 SM
Bit Switches - 4
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
G3 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-105-002)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
SM 127 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
No Function Comments
D3A5 128 SM
Bit Switches - 4
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3
(D3A5)
polarity in ringing
7 ringing). Do not change this setting
0: Off
0: No detection
1: On
1: Detection (Japan and Korea only)
No Function Comments
0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits
Training error detection If the number of error bits in the received TCF is
0-3
threshold below this threshold, the machine informs the
sender that training has succeeded.
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
These bits set the initial starting modem
0 0 1 0 4.8
rate for transmission.
1 0 0 1 21.6
1 0 1 0 24.0
SM 129 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
1 0 1 1 26.4
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
1 1 1 0 33.6
1 0 V.34
1 1 Not used
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
These bits set the initial starting modem
0 0 1 0 4.8 rate for reception.
Use a lower setting if high speeds pose
0 0 1 1 7.2
problems during reception.
0-3 0 1 0 0 9.6 If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is
selected, V.8 protocol should be
0 1 0 1 12.0
disabled manually.
0 1 1 0 14.4 Cross reference
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
0 1 1 1 16.8
1 0 0 0 19.2
1 0 0 1 21.6
D3A5 130 SM
Bit Switches - 4
1 0 1 0 24.0
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
1 0 1 1 26.4
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
1 1 1 0 33.6
4-7 0 0 0 1 V.27ter
0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29
SM 131 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
No Function Comments
D3A5 132 SM
Bit Switches - 4
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
5 Not used Do not change the settings.
(D3A5)
0: This uses the fixed table in the ROM
for dial tone detection.
Parameter selection for dial tone
1: This uses the specific parameter
detection
6 adjusted with SRAM (69ECBEH -
0: Normal parameter
69ECDEH). Select this if the dial tone
1: Specific parameter
cannot be detected when the "Normal
parameter: 0" is selected.
No Function Comments
1 0 800
1 1 Not used
SM 133 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
D3A5 134 SM
Bit Switches - 4
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
G3 Switch 0B Not used (do not change the settings).
(D3A5)
G3 Switch 0C (SP No. 1-105-013)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms
0-7 High order bit 3000 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= FF (2250
ms)
00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms
Low order bit 3000 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= 0F (3700
ms)
SM 135 D3A5
Bit Switches - 4
No Function Comments
D3A5 136 SM
Bit Switches - 5
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
SM 137 D3A5
Bit Switches - 5
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
D3A5 138 SM
Bit Switches - 5
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
G3-2 Switch 03 (SP No. 1-106-004)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
SM 139 D3A5
Bit Switches - 5
No Function Comments
0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits
Training error detection If the number of error bits in the received TCF is
0-3
threshold below this threshold, the machine informs the
sender that training has succeeded.
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
These bits set the initial starting modem
0 0 1 0 4.8
rate for transmission.
1 0 0 1 21.6
1 0 1 0 24.0
D3A5 140 SM
Bit Switches - 5
1 0 1 1 26.4
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
1 0 V.34
1 1 Not used
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
1 0 0 0 19.2
1 0 0 1 21.6
1 0 1 0 24.0
SM 141 D3A5
Bit Switches - 5
1 0 1 1 26.4
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
4-7 0 0 0 1 V.27ter
0 0 1 0 V.27ter
0 0 1 1 V.27ter
0 1 0 0 V.27ter
0 1 0 1 V.27ter
D3A5 142 SM
Bit Switches - 5
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
G3-2 Switch 07 (SP No. 1-106-008)
(D3A5)
No Function Comments
SM 143 D3A5
Bit Switches - 5
No Function Comments
1 0 800
1 1 Not used
D3A5 144 SM
Bit Switches - 5
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
5 Not used Do not change the settings.
(D3A5)
When the sending terminal is controlled
by a computer, there may be a delay in
receiving page data after the local
machine accepts set-up data and sends
Reconstruction time for the first line in CFR. This is outside the T.30
6 receive mode recommendation. But, if this delay
0: 6 s 1: 12 s occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the
sending machine more time to send data.
Refer to error code 0-20.
ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line
should come within 5 s of CFR.
G3-2 Switch 0B- Not used (do not change the settings)
G3-2 Switch 0C- Not used (do not change the settings)
G3-2 Switch 0E- Not used (do not change the settings)
G3-2 Switch 0F- Not used (do not change the settings)
SM 145 D3A5
Bit Switches - 6
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
IP Fax Transport
1 Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax
0: TCP, 1: UDP
IP Fax Gatekeeper
4 Enables/disables the gatekeeper for IP-Fax.
0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)
D3A5 146 SM
Bit Switches - 6
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
without checking the telephone number.
(D3A5)
When "1" is selected, fax data is received
IP Fax received telephone number
only when confirming that the telephone
7 confirmation
number from the sender matches the
0: No confirmation, 1: Confirmation
registered telephone number in this
machine. If this confirmation fails, the line is
disconnected.
0 0 0 1 Level 1
0 0 1 0 Level 2
0 0 1 1 Level 3
SM 147 D3A5
Bit Switches - 6
D3A5 148 SM
Bit Switches - 6
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
IP Fax Switch 03 (SP No. 1-111-004)
(D3A5)
No. Function Comments
SM 149 D3A5
Bit Switches - 6
0 0 0 1 2.4
Sets the modem bit rate for
0-3 0 0 1 1 4.8 transmission. The default is "0110"
0 1 0 0 9.6
0 1 0 1 12.0
0 1 1 0 14.4
1 0 Not used
1 1 Not used
D3A5 150 SM
Bit Switches - 6
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
IP Fax Switch 06 (SP No. 1-111-007)
(D3A5)
No. Function Comments
0 0 0 1 V.27ter
4-7
0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29
Number of times for training Selects the number of times training is done
4
0: 1 time, 1: 2 times at the same bit rate.
SM 151 D3A5
Bit Switches - 6
T1 timer adjustment
Bit 1 Bit 0
1 0 50 s
1 1 60 s
T4 timer adjustment
Bit 3 Bit 2
1 0 4s
1 1 5s
T0 timer adjustment
Adjusts the fail safe timer. This timer sets
Bit 5 Bit 4
the interval between "setup" data
D3A5 152 SM
Bit Switches - 6
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
6-7 Not used Do not change these settings.
(D3A5)
IP Fax Switch 09 (SP No. 1-111-010)
Bit 4 Bit 3
This changes the interval for transmit
3-4 0 0 No delay re-INVITE after receiving the ACK message
1 0 2 sec
1 1 3 sec
SM 153 D3A5
Bit Switches - 6
D3A5 154 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
The following tables give the RAM addresses and the parameter calculation units that the
machine uses for ringing signal detection and automatic dialing. The factory settings for each
country are also given. Most of these must be changed by RAM read/write (SP2-102), but some
can be changed using NCU Parameter programming (SP2-103, 104 and 105); if SP2-103, 104
and 105 can be used, this will be indicated in the Remarks column. The RAM is programmed in
hex code unless (BCD) is included in the Unit column.
Address Function
Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this
address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001
Country Country
Decimal Hex Decimal Hex
/Area /Area
France 00 00 Asia 18 12
Germany 01 01 Japan 19 13
UK 02 02 Hong Kong 20 14
680500
Italy 03 03 South Africa 21 15
Austria 04 04 Australia 22 16
Denmark 06 06 Singapore 24 18
Finland 07 07 Malaysia 25 19
Ireland 08 08 China 26 1A
Norway 09 09 Taiwan 27 1B
SM 155 D3A5
NCU Parameters
Address Function
Sweden 10 0A Korea 28 1C
Switzerland 11 0B Brazil 29 1D
Portugal 12 0C Turkey 32 20
Holland 13 0D Greece 33 21
Spain 14 0E Hungary 34 22
Israel 15 0F Czech 35 23
USA 17 11 Poland 36 24
680509 PSTN dial tone reset time (LOW) FF(H), the machine
pauses for the pause
68050A PSTN dial tone reset time (HIGH) 20 ms
time (address 68050D /
D3A5 156 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
PSTN dial tone permissible drop
68050C
time
SM 157 D3A5
NCU Parameters
D3A5 158 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
limit (low byte)
(D3A5)
68052A Busy tone ON time: range 1
Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles
required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or
OFF-ON-OFF must be detected twice).
Tolerance ()
680533 Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 75% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 50% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 25%
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 12.5%
Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection
SM 159 D3A5
NCU Parameters
D3A5 160 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Country dial tone permissible drop
(D3A5)
680547
time
20 ms -
680548 Country dial wait interval (LOW)
See Note 3.
68054B Break time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-013
(parameter 12).
See Note 3.
68054C Make time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-014
(parameter 13).
SP2-103-018
680550 DTMF tone on time
(parameter 17).
1 ms
SP2-103-019
680551 DTMF tone off time
(parameter 18).
SM 161 D3A5
NCU Parameters
SP2-103-020
Tone attenuation level of DTMF -N x 0.5
680552 (parameter 19).
signals while dialing 3.5 dBm
See Note 5.
SP2-103-021
(parameter 20).
Tone attenuation value difference
The setting must be less
between high frequency tone and
680553 -dBm x 0.5 than 5dBm, and should
low frequency tone in DTMF
not exceed the setting at
signals
680552h above.
See Note 5.
SP2-103-022
PSTN: DTMF tone attenuation -N x 0.5
680554 (parameter 21). See
level after dialling 3.5 dBm
Note 5.
D3A5 162 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
each pause input after
(D3A5)
the PSTN access code.
If this address contains
68055D PSTN access pause time 20 ms FF[H], the pause time
stored in address
68054F is used.
Do not set a number
more than 7 in the UK.
68055F
Do not change the
To Not used -
settings.
680564
680567
Do not change the
to Not used -
settings.
680571
SM 163 D3A5
NCU Parameters
SP2-103-007
Number of rings until a call is (parameter 06).
680576 1
detected The setting must not be
zero.
See Note 4.
Minimum required length of the
680577 20 ms SP2-103-008
first ring
(parameter 07).
68057B
Do not change the
to Not used -
settings.
680580
D3A5 164 SM
NCU Parameters
680583
Do not change the
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
To Not used -
(D3A5)
settings.
6805A0
20 ms 20
6805A5 CED detection time Factory setting: 200 ms
ms
SM 165 D3A5
NCU Parameters
SP2-103-002
6805B4 PSTN: Tx level from the modem -N 3 dBm
(parameter 01).
D3A5 166 SM
NCU Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
Modem turn-on level (incoming -37-0.5N
(D3A5)
6805BD
signal detection level) (dBm)
SM 167 D3A5
NCU Parameters
NOTES
1. If a setting is not required, store FF in the address.
2. Italy and Belgium only
RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning.
Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium)
Bit 1 - Not used
Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy)
If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed.
680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state
D3A5 168 SM
NCU Parameters
duration (%), and number of cycles required for detection, coded as in address 680533.
FAX OPTION
68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)
3. Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is
used, the machine automatically compensates.
4. The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this
parameter.
5. The calculated level must be between 0 and 10.
The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are:
High frequency tone:
0.5 x N680552/6805543.5 dBm
0.5 x N680555 dBm
Low frequency tone:
0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) 3.5 dBm
0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm
SM 169 D3A5
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
D3A5 170 SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
4.10.2 PARAMETERS
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Fax Parameters
The initial settings of the following fax parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled.
Switch 00
Switch 01
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Tx level
1 1 1 1 1 Disabled
SM 171 D3A5
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
Switch 02
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
0 1 0 0 9600
Do not use settings other than listed
0 1 0 1 12000 on the left. If the setting is
"Disabled", the bit switch setting is
0 1 1 0 14400
used.
0 1 1 1 16800
1 0 0 0 19200
D3A5 172 SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
1 0 0 1 21600
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
1 0 1 0 24000
1 0 1 1 26400
1 1 0 0 28800
1 1 0 1 31200
1 1 1 0 33600
1 1 1 1 Disabled
Switch 03
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
SM 173 D3A5
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
Compression modes available This bit determines the capabilities that are
in transmit mode informed to the other terminal during transmission.
5
0: MH only If the setting is "Disabled", the bit switch setting is
1: Disabled used.
D3A5 174 SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
E-mail Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
The initial settings of the following e-mail parameters are all "0" (all parameters disabled).
Switch 00
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
MH Compression mode
for e-mail attachments Switches MH compression on and off for files
0
0: Off attached to e-mails for sending.
1: On
MR Compression mode
for e-mail attachments Switches MR compression on and off for files
1
0: Off attached to e-mails for sending.
1: On
SM 175 D3A5
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
Switch 01
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 02
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
D3A5 176 SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
attachment: 200 x 400 Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as
(D3A5)
2
0: Off 200 x 400.
1: On
Switch 04
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
SM 177 D3A5
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
Switch 05
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Directr transmission
selection to SMTP server Allows or does not allow the direct transmission to
0
0: ON SMTP server.
1: OFF
D3A5 178 SM
Service RAM Addresses
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Do not change the settings which are marked as Not used or Read only.
680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only)
680001(H) - Revision number (BCD)
680002(H) - Year (BCD)
680003(H) - Month (BCD)
680004(H) - Day (BCD)
680006 to 680015(H) - Machines serial number (16 digits - ASCII)
680016(H) - Language code
0: Japanese, 1: UK English, 2: US English, 3: French, 4: German, 5: Spanish, 6: Italian, 7: Dutch,
8: Swedish, 9: Norwegian, 10: Danish, 11: Finnish, 12: Czech, 13: Hungarian, 14: Polish, 15:
Portuguese, 16: Russian, 17: Traditional Chinese, 18: Simplified Chinese, 19: Korean
680018(H) - Total program checksum (low)
680019(H) - Total program checksum (high)
680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches
680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches
680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches
680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches
680090 to 68009F(H) - G3-2 bit switches: Not used
6800A0 to 6800AF(H) - G3-3 bit switches: Not used
6800D0(H) - User parameter switch 00 (SWUER_00) : Not used
6800D1(H) - User parameter switch 01 (SWUSR_01) : Not used
6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02)
Bit 0: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1: Center mark printing on received copies
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.)
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 2: Reception time printing
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.)
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 3: TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 4: Checkered mark printing
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.)
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 5: Not used
Bit 6: Not used
Bit 7: Not used
SM 179 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
D3A5 180 SM
Service RAM Addresses
FAX OPTION
Bit 0 Ringing 0: Off, 1: On
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Bit1: Automatic answering message 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On
Bits 3 and 4: Not used
Bit 5: Remote control 0: Off, 1: On
Bits 6 and 7: Not used
6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08)
Bits 0 and 1: Not used.
Bit 2: Authorized reception
0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this feature are accepted.
1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this feature are accepted.
Bits 3 to 7: Not used.
6800D9(H) - User parameter switch 09 (SWUSR_09): Not used
6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A)
Bits 0 to 2: Not used
Bit 3: Page reduction 0: Off, 1: On
Bits 4 and 5: Not used
Bit 6: Use both e-mail notification and printed reports to confirm the transmission results 0: Off, 1:
On
Bit 7: Not used
6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B)
Bits 0 and 1: Not used
Bit 2: White original detection 0: Off, 1: On (alarm and alert message on the LCD)
Bit 3: Receive rejection for 1300 Hz transmission 0: Off (receive), 1: On (not receive)
Bit 5: Not used
Bit 6: Printout of messages received while acting as a forwarding station 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 7: Not used
6800DC(H) - User parameter switch 12 (SWUSR_0C): Not used
6800DD(H) - User parameter switch 13 (SWUSR_0D): Not used
SM 181 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
D3A5 182 SM
Service RAM Addresses
FAX OPTION
Bit 0: TTI date 0: Off, 1: On
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Bit 1: TTI sender 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 2: TTI file number 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 3: TTI page number 0: Off, 1: On
Bits 4 to 6: Not used
Bit 7: Japan only
6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13)
Bit 0: Not used
Bit 1: Journal format
0: The Journal is separated into transmissions and receptions
1: The Journal is separated into G3-1, G3-2, and G3-3 communications
Bit 2: Not used
Bit 3: 90 image rotation during B5 portrait Tx (This switch is not printed on the user parameter
list.) 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and sub-scan directions.
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch 0E
bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction
Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off,
1: On
Bits 6 and 7: Not used
6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14)
Bit 0: Automatic printing of the LAN fax result report 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Not used.
Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC fax (LAN fax) driver
0 0 0 0 0 min.
0 0 0 1 1 min.
1 1 1 0 14 min.
1 1 1 1 15 min.
SM 183 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
D3A5 184 SM
Service RAM Addresses
FAX OPTION
6800F2(H) - User parameter switch 34 (SWUSR_22)
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Bit 0: Gatekeeper server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1: SIP server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bits 2 to 7: Not used
6800F3(H) - User parameter switch 35 (SWUSR_23)
Redial interval when sending a backup file
6800F4(H) - User parameter switch 36 (SWUSR_24)
Maximum number of redials when sending a backup file
6800F5(H) - User parameter switch 37 (SWUSR_25)
Bit 0: Whether to stop sending a backup file if the destination folder becomes full while the
machine is sending or waiting to send a fax or the backup file. 0: No, 1: Yes
Bit 2 and 3: Backup file is printed along with the TX communication failure report when a backup
file transmission failure occurs. 00: Do not print, 01: Print first page only, 10: Print whole file
Bit 4: Display the sender's information in the file name of documents that are forwarded to folder
destinations. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 5: Limit the file names of documents that are forwarded to folder destinations to plain
characters only. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 6: When using the remote fax function, the sub-machine beeps to let you know when it has
printed a received document (If you specify "On", the machine will beep according to the setting of
[Panel Key Sound] under [System Settings].) 0: On, 1: Off
Bit 7: Not used
6800F6(H) - User parameter switch 38 (SWUSR_26)
Maximum number of transmissions the machine attempts before determining that a fax cannot be
forwarded from a sender (including special senders) to a folder destination
6800F7(H) - User parameter switch 39 (SWUSR_27)
Interval (in minutes) between resend attempts after failing to forward a fax from a sender
(including special senders) to a folder destination
6800F8(H) - User parameter switch 40 (SWUSR_28)
Bit 0: When memory space is insufficient, the machine prints and then deletes the oldest faxes,
creating memory space for storage of new faxes. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1 to 7: Not used
6800FD(H) - User parameter switch 45 (SWUSR_2D)
Bit 0 and 1:
Bit 2: File format for files transmitted to e-mail addresses and folders registered as forwarding,
destinations of backup file transmission, receivers for Personal Box, or end receivers for Transfer
Box. 0: PDF 1: PDF/A
Bit 3:
Bit 4 to 7: Not used
SM 185 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 32 for TTI), add a stop
code (00[H]) after the last character.
68044F(H)
Printing format for TTI 1
0: DOM (Japan), 1:EXP (Export)
680450(H)
Printing format for TTI 2
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680451(H)
Printing format for TTI 3
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680452(H)
Printing format for TTI 4
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680453(H)
Printing format for TTI 5
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680454(H)
Printing format for TTI 6
0: DOM, 1:EXP
D3A5 186 SM
Service RAM Addresses
680455(H)
FAX OPTION
Printing format for TTI 7
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680456(H)
Printing format for TTI 8
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680457(H)
Printing format for TTI 9
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680458(H)
Printing format for TTI 10
0: DOM, 1:EXP
680459 to 68046C(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII)
68046D to 680480(H) - PSTN-2 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII)
680481 to 680494(H) - PSTN-3 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII)
680495(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex)
680496(H) - Number of PSTN-2 CSI characters (Hex)
680497(H) - Number of PSTN-3 CSI characters (Hex)
6804C6(H) - Memory Lock ID (BCD)
6804D2 to 6804D9(H) - Last power off time (Read only)
6804D2(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM)
6804D3(H) - Year (BCD)
6804D4(H) - Month (BCD)
6804D5(H) - Day (BCD)
6804D6 (H) Hour
6804D7 (H) Minute
6804D8(H) Second
6804D8 (H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, /// , 06: Sunday
6804E6(H) - Optional equipment (Read only Do not change the settings)
Bit 0: Page Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 1: SAF Memory (4M) 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 2: SAF Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bits 3 to 7; Not used
6804E7(H) - Optional equipment (Read only Do not change the settings)
Bits 0 to 3: Not used
Bit 4: G3-2 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 5: G3-3 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 6 and 7: Not used
SM 187 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
D3A5 188 SM
Service RAM Addresses
FAX OPTION
68096D(H) - Dialing monitor volume 00 - 07(H)
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
68096E(H) - Buzzer volume 00 - 07(H)
68096F(H) - Beeper volume 00 - 07(H)
680980(H) - Machine code (Check ram 4)
680982(H) - Machine serial number (ASCII)
687178 to 68717B(H) - Transmission counter (Max.24 characters - ASCII)
68717C to 68717F(H) - Reception counter (Max.24 characters - ASCII)
6871E8 to 6871EB(H) - Mail transmission counter (Max.24 characters - ASCII)
6871EC to 6871EF(H) - Mai reception counter (Max.24 characters - ASCII)
6A6DEE(H) to 6A70ED(H) - SIP server address (Read only)
6A6DEE(H) - Proxy server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6E6E(H) - Proxy server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6EEE(H) - Redirect server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6F6E(H) - Redirect server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6FEE(H) - Registrar server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A706E(H) - Registrar server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A70EE(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A716E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A71EE(H) - Alias Number (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A726E(H) - SIP user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A72EE(H) - SIP digest authentication password (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A736E(H) - Gateway address information (Max. 7100 characters - ASCII)
6A8F2A(H) - NGN initial setting method 0: Simple, 1: Manual
6A8F2B(H) - SIP digest authentication user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A8FAB(H) - NGN-SIP domain name (Max. 64 characters - ASCII)
6A8FEB(H) - NGN-home gateway address (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A906C(H) - Stand-by port number for H.323 connection
6A906E(H) - Stand-by port number for SIP connection
6A9070(H) - RAS port number
6A9072(H) - Gatekeeper port number
6A9074(H) - Port number of data waiting for T.38
6A9076(H) - Port number of SIP server
6A9078(H) - Priority for SIP and H.323 0: H.323, 1: SIP
6A9079(H) - SIP function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
6A907A(H) - H.323 function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
SM 189 D3A5
Service RAM Addresses
NA F4 01
EU F4 01
ASIA F4 01
D3A5 190 SM
Overview
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
5.1 OVERVIEW
The FCU, which is composed of one PCB, controls all the fax communications and fax features, in
cooperation with the controller board.
Fax Options:
Extra G3 Interface option: This provides one more analog line interface. This allows full dual
access. Two extra G3 interface options can be installed.
Memory Expansion: This expands the SAF memory and the page memory (used for image
rotation); without this expansion, the page memory is not big enough for image rotation at 400
dpi, so transmission at 400 dpi is not possible.
SM 191 D3A5
Boards
5.2 BOARDS
5.2.1 FCU
The FCU (Facsimile Control Unit) controls fax communications, the video interface to the base
copiers engine, and all the fax options.
FACE3.5 (Fax Application Control Engine)
CPU
Data compression and reconstruction (DCR)
DMA control
Clock generation
DRAM backup control
Modem (FAME2)
V.34, V33, V17, V.29, V.27ter, V.21, and V.8
DRAM
The 16 MB of DRAM is shared as follows.
SAF memory: 4MB
Working memory: 4MB
Page memory: 8MB
The SAF memory is backed up by a rechargeable battery.
ROM
4MB flash ROMs for system software storage
D3A5 192 SM
Boards
SRAM
FAX OPTION
The 512 KB SRAM for system and user parameter storage is backed up by a lithium battery.
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Memory Back-up
A rechargeable battery backs up the SAF memory (DRAM) for 12 hours.
A lithium battery backs up the system parameters and programmed items in the SRAM, in
case the base copier's main switch is turned off.
Switches
Item Description
SM 193 D3A5
Boards
The SG3 board allows up to three simultaneous communications when used in combination with
the FCU and optional G3 boards. The NCU is on the same board as the common SG-3 board.
This makes the total board structure smaller. But, the specifications of the SG3 board do not
change.
NCCP (New Communication Control Processor)
Controls the SG3 board.
CPU (RU30)
DPRAM (Dual Port RAM): Handshaking with the FCU is done through this block.
DMA controller
JBIG
DSP V34 modem (RL5T892): Includes the DTMF Receiver function
DCR for MH, MR, MMR, and JBIG compression and decompression
FROM
1Mbyte flash ROM for SG3 software storage and modem software storage
D3A5 194 SM
Boards
SDRAM
FAX OPTION
4Mbyte DRAM shared between ECM buffer, line buffer, and working memory
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
AFE (Analog Front End)
Analog processing
CODEC (COder-DECoder)
A/D & D/A conversions for modem
REG
Generates +3.3 V from the +5V from the FCU
SM 195 D3A5
Video Data Path
5.3.1 TRANSMISSION
When scanning a fax original, the IPU uses the MTF, independent dot erase and
thresholding parameter settings programmed in the fax units scanner bit switches, not
the copier's SP modes.
Then, the FCU converts the data to mm format, and compresses the data in MMR or raw format to
store it in the SAF memory. If image rotation will be done, the image is rotated in page memory
before compression.
At the time of transmission, the FCU decompresses the stored data, then re-compresses and/or
reduces the data if necessary for transmission. The NCU transmits the data to the line.
D3A5 196 SM
Video Data Path
Immediate Transmission
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
The base copier's scanner scans the original at the resolution agreed with the receiving terminal.
(D3A5)
The IPU video processes the data and transfers it to the FCU.
When scanning a fax original, the IPU uses the MTF, independent dot erase and
thresholding parameter settings programmed in the fax units scanner bit switches, not
the copier's SP modes.
Then the FCU stores the data in page memory, and compresses the data for transmission. The
NCU transmits the data to the line.
JBIG Transmission
Memory transmission: If the receiver has JBIG compression, the data goes from the DCR to the
QM-Coder. Then the NCU transmits the data to the line. When an optional G3 unit (SG3) is
installed and PSTN2 is selected as the line type, JBIG compression is available, but only for the
PSTN-2 line.
Immediate transmission: If the receiver has JBIG compression, the data goes from the page
memory to the QM-Coder. Then the NCU transmits the data to the line. When an optional G3 unit
(SG3) is installed and PSTN2 is selected as the line type, JBIG compression is available, but only
for the PSTN-2 line.
Adjustments
Priority for the line used for G3 transmissions (PSTN 1/PSTN 2 or 3): System switch 16 bit 1
SM 197 D3A5
Video Data Path
5.3.2 RECEPTION
First, the FCU stores the incoming data from either an analog line to the SAF memory. (The data
goes to the FACE3 at the same time, and is checked for error lines/frames.)
The FCU then decompresses the data and transfers it to page memory. If image rotation will be
done, the image is rotated in the page memory. The data is transferred to the IPU.
If the optional G3 unit is installed, the line that the message comes in on depends on the
telephone number dialled by the other party (the optional G3 unit has a different telephone
number from the main fax board).
JBIG Reception
When data compressed with JBIG comes in on PSTN-1 (the standard analog line), the data is
sent to the QM-CODER for decompression. Then the data is stored in the page memory, and
transferred to the IPU.
When data compressed with JBIG comes in on PSTN-2 (optional extra analog line), the data is
sent to the QM-CODER on the SG3 board for decompression.
D3A5 198 SM
Fax Communication Features
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
5.4.1 MULTI-PORT
When the optional extra G3 Interface Unit is installed, communication can take place at the same
time through the two or three lines at once.
Available protocol
Option Available Line Type
Combinations
The base copier's scanner scans the original at the selected resolution. The IPU video processes
the data and transfers it to the controller board.
Then the controller stores the data in the page memory for the copier function, and compresses
the data in MMR (by software) to store it in the HDD. If image rotation will be done, the image is
rotated in the page memory before compression.
SM 199 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
For transmission, the stored image data is transferred to the FCU. The FCU decompresses the
image data, then recompresses and/or reduces the data if necessary for transmission. The NCU
transmits the data to the line.
The documents can be stored in the HDD (Document Server) from the fax application. The stored
documents in the document sever can be used for the fax transmission in many times. More than
one document and the scanned document can be combined into one file and then the file can be
transmitted.
When using the document server, the SAF memory is not used.
The document is compressed with MMR and stored.
Up to 9,000 pages can be stored (1 file: Up to 1,000 pages) from the fax application.
Only stored documents from the fax application can be transmitted.
Scanned documents are given a name automatically, such as "FAX001". But it is possible to
change the file name, user name and password.
Up to 30 files can be selected at once.
The compression method of the fax application is different from the copy application. The
storing time is longer than the copier storing.
When selecting "Print 1st page", the stored document will be reduced to A4 size.
Mail Transmission
T.37 simple and full modes
This machine supports T.37 full mode. (ITU-T Recommendation, RFC2532). The difference
between T.37 simple mode and full mode is as follows.
200 x100
200 x 100 200 x 200
Resolution
200 x 200 200 x 400
400 x 400 (if available)
D3A5 200 SM
Fax Communication Features
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Image data transmission,
exchange of capability
Image data information between the two
Signals
transmission only terminals, and
acknowledgement of receipt of
fax messages
Data Formats
The scanned data is converted into a TIFF-F formatted file.
The fields of the e-mail and their contents are as follows:
Field Content
Multipart/mixed
Content Type
Attached files: image/tiff
SM 201 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
In this case, this feature destination e-mail address (gts@ricoh.co.jp) is read as the SMTP server
address "gts.abcd.com", and the transmissions bypass the SMTP server. This leads to decrease
the server load and to reduce the time lag during transferring the mail.
Requirements for destination server:
Supports with Internet FAX (as a destination of Internet FAX)
Can receive mails (as a destination of mail)
Is installed in the same LAN as this machine
Supports with the SMTP mail reception, and the reception protocol is set to SMTP
Set the port number for [SMTP server] to 25 to enable this feature.
If the sender server sends an Internet FAX or a mail using this feature, the SMTP
authentication is disabled even if the server sets it.
Using this feature, error notification mail will not be sent even if the mail is not properly
received.
Also, error mail will not be sent even if the mail is not sent properly.
This feature refers to A records (not supported with MX records).
Selectable Options
These options are available for selection:
With the default settings, the scan resolution can be either standard or detail. Inch-mm
conversion before TX depends on IFAX SW01 Bit 7. Detail resolution will be used if Super
Fine resolution is selected, unless Fine resolution is enabled with IFAX SW01.
The requirements for originals (document size, scan width, and memory capacity) are the
same as for G3 fax memory TX.
The default compression is TIFF-F format.
IFAX SW00: Acceptable paper widths for sending
IFAX SW09: Maximum number of attempts to the same destination
D3A5 202 SM
Fax Communication Features
FAX OPTION
SMTP Authentication:
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> SMTP Authentication
POP Before SMTP:
User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> POP Before SMTP
Mail Reception
Three Types
This machine supports three types of e-mail reception:
POP3 (Post Office Protocol Ver. 3.)
IMAP4 (Internet Messaging Access Protocol)
SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)
An error will be issued and error mail will be sent to the mail source when the reception
protocol is not set to SMTP even If you configure to enable SMTP reception in the DNS
server.
If the received mail contains error, the reception operation is stopped, the mail is
discarded and error report is output. Error mail is also sent to the mail source.
When a mail is received from SMTP server during sending a mail in the machine, the
SMTP server will give a Busy response. The SMTP server will usually try to send the
mail again later until the time-out is reached.
This feature cannot be used with the POP server.
SM 203 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
1. Conditions
The length of the Access Limit Entry is limited to 127 characters.
If the Access Limit Entry address and the mail address of the incoming mail do not match,
the incoming mail is discarded and not delivered, and the SMTP server responds with an
error. However, in this case an error report is not output.
If the Access Limit Entry address is not registered, and if the incoming mail specifies a
delivery destination, then the mail is delivered unconditionally.
D3A5 204 SM
Fax Communication Features
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Abnormal files
When an error of this type occurs, the machine stops receiving and commands the server to erase
the message. Then the machine prints an error report and sends information about the error by
e-mail to the sender address (specified in the "From" or "Reply-to" field of the message). If there is
an incomplete received message in the machine memory, it will be erased.
The machine prints an error message when it fails to send the receive error notification after a
certain number of attempts.
The following types of files are judged to be abnormal if one or more of the following are detected:
1. Unsupported MIME headers.
Supported types of MIME header
Content-Transfer-
Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable
Encoding
SM 205 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
Field Content
Multipart/mixed
Content-Type
Text/Plain (for a text part), image/tiff (for attached files)
D3A5 206 SM
Fax Communication Features
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Subject
--- Entry Condition
Entry
1. "CSI" ("RTI")
Fax Message No.
2. "RTI" CSI not registered +
No Subject File No.
Entry 3. "CSI" RTI not registered
RTI or CSI of
the station
Mail delivery
designated
Mail error
--- Error Message No. xxxx From CSI (RTI)
notification
SM 207 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
E-mail Messages
After entering the subject, you can enter a message with: TX Mode> Text
An e-mail message (up to 5 lines) can be pre-registered with: User Tools> System Settings> File
Transfer> Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message
- Limitations on Entries -
Item Maximum
D3A5 208 SM
Fax Communication Features
2. Sending the disposition notification must be enabled (User Parameter Setting SW21 (15 [H])
FAX OPTION
Bit 1 for this model). The content of the response is as follows:
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
Normal reception: "Return Receipt (dispatched)" in the Subject line
Handling Reports
- Sending a Request for a Return Receipt by Mail -
After the mail sender transmits a request for a return receipt, the mail sender's journal is
annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and a "Q" in the Mode column.
- Mail Receipt (Request for Receipt Confirmation) and Sending Mail Receipt Response -
After the mail receiver sends a response to the request for a return receipt, the mail receiver's
journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and an "A" in the Mode column.
- Receiving the Return Receipt Mail -
After the mail sender receives a return receipt, the information in the mail sender's journal
about the receipt request is replaced, i.e. the journal is annotated with "OK" in the Result
column.
When the return receipt reports an error, the journal is annotated with an "E" in the Result
column.
The arrival of the return receipt is not recorded in the journal as a separate communication. Its
arrival is only reported by the presence of "OK" or "E" in the Result column.
If the mail address used by the sender specifies a mailing list (i.e., a Group destination; the
machine sends the mail to more than one location. See "How to set up Mail Delivery"), the
Result column of the Journal is updated every time a return receipt is received. For example,
if the mailing list was to 5 destinations, the Result column indicates the result of the
communication with the 5th destination only. The results of the communications to the first 4
destinations are not shown.
Exceptions:
If one of the communications had an error, the Result column will indicate E, even if
subsequent communications were OK.
If two of the communications had an error, the Journal will indicate the destination for the first
error only.
SM 209 D3A5
Fax Communication Features
Report Sample
D3A5 210 SM
IP-Fax
5.5 IP-FAX
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
5.5.1 WHAT IS IP-FAX?
For details: Core Technology Manual Facsimile Processes Faxing from a PC Internet/LAN
Fax Boards IP-FAX
IP-Fax Switch 01
SM 211 D3A5
IP-Fax
5.5.3 SETTINGS
User parameter switch 34 (22[H]), bit 0
IP-Fax Gate Keeper usage, 0: No, 1: Yes
IP Fax Switches: Various IP-FAX settings (see the bit switch table)
D3A5 212 SM
General Specifications
6. SPECIFICATIONS
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
6.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
6.1.1 FCU
G3
8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard)
8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Detail)
8 x 15.4 line/mm (Fine) See Note1
16 x15.4 line/mm (Super Fine) See Note 1
Resolution:
200 x 100 dpi (Standard)
200 x 200 dpi (Detail)
400 x 400 dpi (Super Fine) See Note 1
SM 213 D3A5
General Specifications
G3: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/
Data Rate: 19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps
Automatic fallback
SAF
Standard: 4 MB
With optional Expansion Memory: 60 MB (4 MB+ 56 MB)
Memory Capacity: Page Memory
Standard: 8 MB (Print: 4 MB + Scanner: 4 MB)
With optional Expansion Memory: 16 MB (8 MB + 8 MB)
(Print 8 MB + Scanner: 8 MB)
D3A5 214 SM
Capabilities of Programmable Items
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
The following table shows the capabilities of each programmable items.
Item Standard
Groups 100
Programs 100
Auto Document 6
The following table shows how the capabilities of the document memory will change after the
Expansion Memory are installed.
Memory Transmission
800 800
file
Maximum number of
page for memory 1000 1000
transmission
Measured using an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at the standard resolution,
the auto image density mode and the Text mode.
SM 215 D3A5
IFAX Specifications
To use 200 400 dpi and 400 400 dpi, IFAX SW01 Bit 2
and/or bit 4 must be set to 1.
Document Size:
To use B4 and A3 width, IFAX SW00 Bit 1 (B4) and/or Bit 2
(A3) must be set to 1.
Single/multi-part
E-mail File
MIME conversion
Format:
Image: TIFF-F (MH, MR, MMR)
Transmission:
SMTP, TCP/IP
Protocol:
Reception:
POP3, SMTP, IMAP4, TCP/IP
D3A5 216 SM
IFAX Specifications
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
1000 Mbps (1000 Base-T)
(D3A5)
Data Rate: 100 Mbps (100base-Tx)
10 Mbps (10base-T)
SMTP-AUTH
Authentication
POP before SMTP
Method:
A-POP
SM 217 D3A5
IP-FAX Specifications
Maximum scanning
297 mm x 1200 mm (11.7 x 47.3)
size:
Transmission
TCP, UDP/IP communication
protocol:
Compatible
IP-Fax compatible machines
machines:
D3A5 218 SM
Fax Unit Configuration
FAX OPTION
TYPE M12
(D3A5)
6.5.1 G3 INTERFACE UNIT TYPE M12
D3A5-01, -02,
FCU 1 -
-03, -11, -12
SM 219 D3A5
D148-81
SMART OPERATION PANEL TYPE M3
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SMART OPERATION PANEL TYPE M3
(D148-81)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
2. MECHANISM .................................................................................... 8
2.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................................8
2.1.1 SYSTEM COMPONENTS ....................................................................8
Specification .............................................................................................8
Available languages .................................................................................9
2.1.2 APPEARANCE/SCREEN LAYOUT ....................................................10
1. Key specification ................................................................................11
2. LED specification................................................................................11
3. External I/F specification ....................................................................12
4. Screen layout .....................................................................................12
2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ...........................................................13
2.2 POWER SUPPLY CONTROL ......................................................................14
2.2.1 ENERGY-SAVE RECOVERY OPERATION .......................................14
2.2.2 SCREEN STARTUP MODE ...............................................................15
2.2.3 SPECIAL SHUTDOWN.......................................................................16
D148-81 ii SM
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Android is a trademark of Google Inc.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Operation Panel Unit
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
Prior to installing the SOP or changing the SPs, the machine must be updated with all
the firmware's for the Smart Operation Panel version of the machine. (Refer to the
Mainframe Firmware History document for more information.)
SM 1 D148-81
Operation Panel Unit
There are 4 hooks inside the operation panel. Before removing the operation panel
rear cover, see the photos below.
D148-81 2 SM
Operation Panel Unit
PANEL TYPE M3
4. Operation panel arm bracket [A] ( 7, 3, 1)
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
5. Bracket [A] ( 6)
SM 3 D148-81
Operation Panel Unit
D148-81 4 SM
Operation Panel Unit
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
1. Operation panel (page 1)
(D148-81)
SMART
2. Operation panel arm bracket (page 2)
3. Harness guide and bracket cover (page 4)
4. Bracket (page 4)
5. I/O Board [A] ( 1, FFC2)
1.1.5 SPEAKER
1. Operation panel (page 1)
2. Operation panel rear cover (page 2)
3. Operation panel arm bracket (page 2)
4. Harness guide and bracket cover (page 4)
5. Bracket (page 4)
6. Speaker [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 5 D148-81
Operation Panel Unit
1.1.6 LCD
1. Microcomputer Board (page 2)
2. CPU Board (page 4)
3. I/O Board (page 5)
4. Speaker (page 5)
5. Remove the LCD with the bracket [A] ( 2).
7. LCD [A] ( 1)
D148-81 6 SM
Operation Panel Unit
1.1.7 MICROPHONE
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
1. Microcomputer Board (page 2)
2. CPU bracket (page 4)
3. Disconnect a connector. ( 1)
SM 7 D148-81
Overview
2. MECHANISM
2.1 OVERVIEW
Specification
D148-81 8 SM
Overview
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
Program area and
SMART
data area for the
Non-volatile memory NAND: 2GB
OS and
applications
In sleep mode or
Available languages
Japanese, American English, German, French, Italian, Spanish, Dutch, Russian, Chinese
(simplified Chinese characters) and Chinese (traditional Chinese characters)
SM 9 D148-81
Overview
8 Status LED
D148-81 10 SM
Overview
1. Key specification
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
Key Description
* The Back and Menu keys are used for operation of Android applications (browser, gallery, etc.).
2. LED specification
LED Description
SM 11 D148-81
Overview
4. Screen layout
D148-81 12 SM
Overview
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
No. Item Description
2 Speaker -
SM 13 D148-81
Power Supply Control
D148-81 14 SM
Power Supply Control
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
Login/logout No key Does not recover.
SMART
2.2.2 SCREEN STARTUP MODE
As control unit start-up modes, a Normal Startup Mode (power-saving mode) and Quick Startup
Mode are provided. Each mode can be changed over from Screen Features Screen Device
Settings Screen Startup Mode.
To avoid preparations for the next startup, press the power button while holding the
Stop key until the shutting down message shows up. This may help you shut down
smoothly when you are maintaining the machine.
When shutdown is performed in Quick Startup Mode, the screen changes in the
following order:
1. Displays the shutting down message on the screen.
2. The screen turns off.
3. The power LED blinks.
4. The power LED turns off.
SM 15 D148-81
Power Supply Control
After shutdown is completed by this procedure, when the MFP is left for 5 minutes or
longer, it starts up in normal startup mode the next time that the power is switched
ON.
D148-81 16 SM
System Maintenance
3. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
3.1 SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Shutdown can be performed in a short time even when the Quick Startup Mode is set.
When upgrading the Android screen firmware version, switch the power OFF by the
normal procedure.
If reset is performed when the Android screen is in operation, data stored in the Android
screen may be corrupted.
1. Press the reset button on the left side of the control unit in order to reboot the control
unit.
SM 17 D148-81
System Maintenance
Android OS maintenance
Recovery mode OS update -
Full data format
D148-81 18 SM
System Maintenance
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
Preparing Version Update SD card
1. Download the update module update_sig.zip.
2. Move the downloaded file to the root directly of the SD card.
If extended security for firmware update is set to "prohibit", it is not possible to shift to
recovery mode. (System Settings>Administrator Tools>Extended Security is displayed in
log-on screen for machine administrator)
If firmware update is required with the above settings, ask customer (machine
administrator) to request a change of the setting.
1. Turn off the main power.
2. Insert the SD card in the control unit SD slot, and start the recovery mode.
3. Select "apply update from sdcard.", and press [Home] key.
SM 19 D148-81
System Maintenance
6. The current version of the firmware, and the update version of the firmware in the SD
card are displayed. Check that the version is correct.
7. When "Continue Update?" is displayed, press OK ([HOME] key).
8. Version Update is started.
9. When "Install from SD card complete." is displayed, select "reboot system now", press
the [HOME] key, and perform a system reboot.
D148-81 20 SM
System Maintenance
PANEL TYPE M3
OPERATION
(D148-81)
Version update via SD card
SMART
Preparing the version update SD card
1. Download the update file. (.zip)
2. Create the folder app on root directly.
3. Move the downloaded file to the app folder.
The files with extension ".apk" & ".dalp must be on the root directory of the
SD Card.
SM 21 D148-81
System Maintenance
3.1.5 SELF-DIAGNOSIS
The following menus can be performed as self-diagnosis functions of the control unit. Either
Japanese or English can be displayed.
1. LED Check
The following control unit LED can be changed over between all on/all off.
Data in
USB access
HOME
Status check (When lit, R->G->B->R->G->B is repeated at 500 ms intervals)
BACK/MENU
FAX
SD access
2. Key check
Check pressing hard keys other than the [HOME] key on the control unit. When a key is
depressed, the corresponding key displayed on the control unit is shown highlighted.
If a foot switch is fitted, while the switch is depressed, the "FOOT SW" column is highlighted.
When the [End] key is depressed, the display returns to the self-diagnosis top screen (the
Back key works as a key check, so it cannot be used as a key to return to the self-diagnosis
top screen).
D148-81 22 SM
System Maintenance
PANEL TYPE M3
3. LCD Check
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
Whenever the screen is touched, the display cycles through All-white -> All-black -> All-green
-> All-blue -> End in full screen view, and the display status of each color is visually verified.
By cycling through all the colors, the LCD check is completed, and the display returns to the
self-diagnosis top screen.
4. Speaker check
The following standard sounds are generated according to the button instructions on the
screen.
Frequency: 220 Hz, 440 Hz, 880 Hz, 1760 Hz, 2000 Hz
Sound volume: 16 levels from minimum to maximum
Sounds standard sound by START/STOP toggle switch
SM 23 D148-81
System Maintenance
D148-81 24 SM
System Maintenance
PANEL TYPE M3
7. Touch panel calibration
OPERATION
(D148-81)
SMART
Perform a touch-panel calibration, and set a value.
One + mark after another is displayed at locations (5 points) required for calibration. Press the
center point.
When input of 5 points is complete, a display for set/reset appears.
OK: Press Menu key
Retry: Press Back key
When it is desired to set the current value, the operation is completed by pressing the "Menu" key,
and the display returns to the self-diagnosis screen.
To repeat the setting, or to stop touch panel calibration, press the Back key.
When the Return key is pressed, a + mark is displayed in the first position for performing
calibration. When this display appears, by pressing the Back key again, the display returns to
the self-diagnosis screen.
SM 25 D148-81
SP Mode List
Menu level
Description
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3
D148-81 26 SM
SP Mode List
Menu level
PANEL TYPE M3
Description
OPERATION
(D148-81)
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3
SMART
Select from the SD card, and
Install speech
install speech synthesis
data
data.
Audio speed
(speed: 5 Select audio speed.
selection levels)
Language
Engine
Interface setting
wi-fi setting
Device IP
address
Legal information
(display)
SM 27 D148-81
Recovery Menu
Menu Description
System reboot
Reboot system now
(used to come out of recovery mode)
D148-81 28 SM
D683
SPDF DF3080
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SPDF DF3080 (D683)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D683
1.6.16 ADF FEED COVER INTERLOCK SWITCH / PICK-UP ROLLER HP
SENSOR ......................................................................................................35
1.7 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE .............................................................................36
1.7.1 ADF ENTRANCE MOTOR ..................................................................36
1.7.2 ADF SCANNING MOTOR ..................................................................37
1.7.3 ADF EXIT MOTOR .............................................................................38
1.7.4 ADF FEED MOTOR ............................................................................38
D683 ii SM
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
ADF Removal
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1.1 ADF REMOVAL
SM 1 D683
ADF Removal
5. Disconnect the I/F cable [A] along with the bracket [B] ( 2, 2).
D683 2 SM
ADF Removal
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
7. Open the ADF [A].
SM 3 D683
ADF Removal
9. While holding the left and right sides of the ADF, lift up to remove it.
D683 4 SM
Adjustment after Replacing the ADF
SPDF DF3080
1.2 ADJUSTMENT AFTER REPLACING THE ADF
(D683)
1.2.1 CIS RGB ADJUSTMENT
Enter the four-digit numeric values for RGB that are listed on the paper that comes with the ADF
into the following SP.
R: SP4-712-001 (CIS GB Adj Value: R)
G: SP4-713-001 (CIS GB Adj Value: G)
B: SP4-714-001 (CIS GB Adj Value: B)
SM 5 D683
Adjustment after Replacing the ADF
D683 6 SM
Platen Adjustment
SPDF DF3080
1.3 PLATEN ADJUSTMENT
(D683)
1. Open the ADF and remove the white cover (fabric fastener 10).
2. Put the white cover [A] in the correct position on the exposure glass, aligning it with
the glass cover [B] and the rear scale [C].
3. Close the ADF [A] slowly and paste the ADF and the white cover [B] with the fabric
fastener.
SM 7 D683
ADF Covers
Check the position of the hooks in the photo below before removing.
D683 8 SM
ADF Covers
SPDF DF3080
1. Open the feed cover [A].
(D683)
2. Cover [A] ( 1).
Check the position of the hooks in the photo below before removing.
SM 9 D683
ADF Covers
D683 10 SM
Document Feed Components
SPDF DF3080
1.5 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS
(D683)
1.5.1 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT
1. Open the feed cover.
2. Remove the snap-fit [A].
3. Pull the original feed unit [A] forward to release the back side of the shaft.
Open the original lift plate [B] when pulling the original feed unit forward. This makes it
easier to remove the original feed unit.
SM 11 D683
Document Feed Components
When reassembling this unit, make sure that the boss [B] of the pick-up roller unit is
in the hole [A] of the original lift plate.
When reassembling this unit, make sure that the tab on the front guide plate [A] is
above the pick-up roller [B].
3. Pick-up roller cover [A] and pick-up roller [B] ( 2, bushing2, one-way clutch1) .
D683 12 SM
Document Feed Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
4. Lift the left and right sides of the feed belt holder [A], then remove it.
5. Remove the feed belt [B] from the feed belt holder [A].
SM 13 D683
Document Feed Components
4. ADF separation roller [A] and torque limiter clutch [B] ( 1).
3. Slide the tab [A], and open the exit unit [B].
D683 14 SM
Document Feed Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
4. Exit unit [A] ( 2).
5. Exit lower guide [A], and the CIS exit lower guide unit [B] ( 2 each).
6. Two springs at the both ends of CIS entrance lower guide unit [A] ( 2).
SM 15 D683
Document Feed Components
D683 16 SM
Document Feed Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
10. Springs on both sides of the white roller [A], and the bearing at the left side of the unit
( 1 each, bearing 1).
SM 17 D683
Electrical Components
D683 18 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
8. CIS unit [A] ( 2, 3)
To prevent scratches on the surface of the CIS glass, removal of the CIS unit must be
done with the white cover [A] open.
SM 19 D683
Electrical Components
4. ADF transport motor [A] along with the bracket ( 2, 1, timing belt1).
D683 20 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
1. ADF entrance motor along with the frame (page 36).
(D683)
2. ADF bottom plate lift motor [A] ( 2, 1).
SM 21 D683
Electrical Components
D683 22 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. ADF rear cover (page 9).
2. Disconnect the relay harness [A] ( 1, 1).
5. Slide the tab to the left and then open the white cover [A].
SM 23 D683
Electrical Components
6. Remove the original exit sensor [B], which is mounted on the upper guide [A] ( 6).
7. Remove the original exit sensor [B] from the upper guide [A] ( 1, 1).
D683 24 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. ADF rear cover (page 9).
2. ADF control board [A] ( 4, all).
SM 25 D683
Electrical Components
D683 26 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. Feed cover (page 10).
2. Guide plate [A] ( 3).
4. Remove the original width sensor guide plate [A] ( 2), then remove the original
width sensors [B] ( 1 each).
SM 27 D683
Electrical Components
D683 28 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. ADF rear cover (page 9).
2. APS Feeler [A] ( 1).
SM 29 D683
Electrical Components
D683 30 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. ADF front cover (page 8).
2. Original feed unit (page 11).
3. Remove the screw and raise the original tray [A] ( 1).
SM 31 D683
Electrical Components
D683 32 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. Original feed unit (page 11).
2. ADF front cover (page 8).
3. Remove the screw and raise the original tray [A] ( 1).
SM 33 D683
Electrical Components
D683 34 SM
Electrical Components
SPDF DF3080
HP SENSOR
(D683)
1. ADF rear cover (page 9).
2. Remove the ADF feed cover interlock switch [A] from the retaining bracket ( 1,
spring1, pin1).
SM 35 D683
Original Feed Drive
D683 36 SM
Original Feed Drive
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
1. ADF entrance motor along with the frame (page 36).
2. ADF read motor [A] along with the bracket ( 2, 1 , spring1, timing belt1)
SM 37 D683
Original Feed Drive
D683 38 SM
Original Feed Drive
SPDF DF3080
(D683)
5. ADF feed motor [A] ( 2).
SM 39 D683
D685
BRIDGE UNIT BU3070
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
BRIDGE UNIT BU3070 (D685)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D685
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Drive Motor Unit
BU3070 (D685)
BRIDGE UNIT
1.1 DRIVE MOTOR UNIT
SM 1 D685
Drive Motor Unit
D685 2 SM
Paper Exit Sensor
BU3070 (D685)
BRIDGE UNIT
1. Bridge unit (page 1).
2. Drive motor unit cover (page 1).
3. Bridge unit rear cover (page 1).
4. Paper exit tray [A].
SM 3 D685
Paper Exit Sensor
D685 4 SM
Paper Exit Sensor
BU3070 (D685)
BRIDGE UNIT
8. Guide plate [A].
SM 5 D685
Bridge Unit Transport Sensor
D685 6 SM
Paper Exit Tray Set Detection Switch
BU3070 (D685)
BRIDGE UNIT
1. Paper exit tray (page 3).
2. Paper exit tray set switch cover [A].
SM 7 D685
Paper Exit Switching Unit Set Switch
D685 8 SM
D686/D687
Booklet Finisher SR3150/
Finisher SR3140
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
BOOKLET FINISHER SR3150/
FINISHER SR3140 (D686/D687)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D686/D687
1.2.16 STAPLER TRAY ...........................................................................21
1.2.17 STAPLER TRAY PAPER DETECTION SENSOR.........................23
1.2.18 PAPER BUNDLE TRANSPORT UPPER PRESSURE RELEASE
HP SENSOR ................................................................................................24
1.2.19 RELEASE CLAW HP SENSOR ....................................................24
1.2.20 JOGGER HP SENSOR .................................................................25
1.2.21 JOGGER MOTOR .........................................................................25
1.2.22 PAPER BUNDLE TRANSPORT UPPER PRESSURE RELEASE
MOTOR 26
1.2.23 RELEASE CLAW MOTOR ............................................................27
1.3 BOARDS ......................................................................................................28
1.3.1 MAIN CONTROL BOARD ...................................................................28
1.4 BOOKLET STAPLER UNIT .........................................................................29
1.4.1 STAPLER UNIT ..................................................................................29
1.4.2 BOOKLET STAPLER UNIT ................................................................35
1.4.3 CENTER-FOLDING UNIT...................................................................36
1.4.4 CENTER-FOLDING TRAY PAPER EJECT SENSOR ........................38
1.4.5 TRAILING EDGE STOPPER TRANSPORT SENSOR .......................39
1.4.6 TRAILING EDGE STOPPER HP SENSOR ........................................40
1.4.7 CENTER-FOLDING BLADE HP SENSOR .........................................40
1.4.8 CENTER-FOLDING CAM HP SENSOR .............................................41
1.4.9 TRAILING EDGE STOPPER MOTOR ................................................42
1.4.10 FOLDING BLADE MOTOR ...........................................................42
1.4.11 FOLDING TRANSPORT MOTOR .................................................43
1.4.12 CENTER-FOLDING TRAY FULL SENSORS 1, 2 .........................44
1.4.13 STAPLER TRANSFER MOTOR (MIDDLE) ..................................45
1.4.14 PAPER BUNDLE TRANSPORT LOWER PRESSURE RELEASE
HP SENSOR ................................................................................................46
D686/D687 ii SM
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
The Aim of Anti-tip Components and Precautions
The anti-tip components are necessary for meeting the requirements of IEC60950-1, the
international standard for safety.
The aim of these components is to prevent the products, which are heavy in weight, from toppling
as a result of people running into or leaning onto the products, which can lead to serious accidents
such as persons becoming trapped under the product. (U.S.: UL60950-1, Europe: EN60950-1)
Therefore, removal of such components must always be with the consent of the customer.
Do not remove them at your own judgment.
Exterior Parts
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.1 EXTERIOR PARTS
2. Front cover ( 1)
SM 1 D686/D687
Exterior Parts
D686/D687 2 SM
Exterior Parts
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.1.3 REAR COVER
1. Rear cover [A] ( 2)
SM 3 D686/D687
Exterior Parts
D686/D687 4 SM
Exterior Parts
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
When reattaching the upper cover, attach the clips so that their tabs face forward.
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.1.6 UPPER FRONT COVER
1. Front left cover (page 4)
2. Upper cover (page 4)
3. Upper front cover [A] ( 3)
SM 5 D686/D687
Exterior Parts
D686/D687 6 SM
Exterior Parts
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Upper front cover (page 5)
2. Upper rear cover (page 6)
3. Proof tray [A] ( 2)
SM 7 D686/D687
Exterior Parts
D686/D687 8 SM
Exterior Parts
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Front cover (page 1)
2. Rear cover (page 3)
3. Shift tray (page 7)
4. Shift tray front bracket [B] ( 2)
5. Shift tray bracket [A] with the shift tray rear bracket [C]
SM 9 D686/D687
Exterior Parts
D686/D687 10 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.2.1 PAPER EJECT COVER OPEN/CLOSE MOTOR
1. Proof tray (page 7)
2. Paper eject cover open/close motor [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 11 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 12 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.2.5 ENTRANCE SENSOR
1. Entrance sensor [A] ( 1, 1, 1)
SM 13 D686/D687
Main Unit
When reattaching the upper cover, attach the clips so that their tabs face the inside of
the unit.
D686/D687 14 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Proof tray (page 7)
2. Intermediate transport sensor left [A] ( 1, 1, 1)
SM 15 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 16 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Bracket of the shift tray (page 16)
2. Shift tray upper limit switch [A] ( x2, hook 1)
SM 17 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 18 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Rear cover (page 3)
2. Shift motor [A] ( 2, x1)
SM 19 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 20 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.2.16 STAPLER TRAY
1. Inner cover (page 2)
2. Front left cover (page 4)
3. Booklet stapler unit (Booklet Stapler Unit)
4. Paper eject transport motor bracket [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 21 D686/D687
Main Unit
Be careful not to damage the shape of the claw enclosed by the blue circle when
removing the approach rollers.
6. Stapler tray [A] ( 7, 2, 1)
D686/D687 22 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Stapler tray (page 21)
2. Stapler tray paper detection sensor bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 23 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 24 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Stapler tray (page 21)
2. Separate the jogger fence [A] from the jogger HP sensor [B].
3. Jogger HP sensor ( 1)
SM 25 D686/D687
Main Unit
D686/D687 26 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Stapler tray (page 21)
2. Release claw motor bracket [A] ( 2, 1, 2)
SM 27 D686/D687
Boards
1.3 BOARDS
An EEPROM is installed in the control board to record the drive frequency and number of
sheets.
When the control board is replaced, take the EEPROM off the old board and install it on
the new one.
(There is an EEPROM on the new main control board, but this is not needed and can be
discarded or kept as a spare part.)
1. Rear cover (page 3)
2. Main control board [A] ( 4, 23)
D686/D687 28 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1.4.1 STAPLER UNIT
1. Open the front cover, and then remove two knobs ( x1 for each)
3. Pull out the booklet stitch unit, and then disconnect three connectors and release four
clamps on the stapler unit.
4. Bracket [A] ( 4, 3, 1)
SM 29 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 30 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
8. Cover [A] ( 2)
10. Disconnect three connectors and release four clamps on the stapler unit (driver side).
SM 31 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
12. Attach the special tool to the stapler unit to adjust the staple position of the stapler
unit.
Check that four pins ([A] and [B]) on the special tool are fixed in the slots [C] on the stapler
unit as shown below.
[A]: Two pins for driver
[B]: Two pins for clincher
D686/D687 32 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
13. Tighten the wing screw [A] on the special tool to secure the stapler and special tool.
14. Tighten the screws completely to secure the clincher side [A] of the stapler ( 3).
SM 33 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
Make sure that the harnesses [B] are routed behind the resin part [A]. Otherwise, the
harnesses block the route of the stapler, which causes a stapler transfer motor error.
D686/D687 34 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Rear cover (page 3)
2. Remove connectors ( 9, 2, ground plate1)
3. Stopper [A] ( 2)
When you remove the booklet stapler unit from the main frame, be careful not to catch
the cable on the frame.
SM 35 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 36 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
5. Bracket [A] ( 1, 3, 1)
SM 37 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 38 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Center-folding unit (page 36)
2. Trailing edge stopper transport sensor bracket [A] ( 2, 1, 4)
SM 39 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 40 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Center-folding unit (page 36)
2. Center-folding cam HP sensor bracket [A] ( 1, 2)
SM 41 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 42 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Center-folding unit (page 36)
2. Folding transport motor [A] ( 2)
SM 43 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 44 SM
Booklet Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3140 (D686/D687)
SR3150/ FINISHER
1. Control board bracket (page 20)
2. Stapler transfer motor (Mid.) [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 45 D686/D687
Booklet Stapler Unit
D686/D687 46 SM
D688/D689
Booklet Finisher SR3170 /
Finisher SR3160
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
BOOKLET FINISHER SR3170 /
FINISHER SR3160 (D688/D689)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D688/D689
1.4.1 TRAY EXIT MOTOR ...........................................................................28
1.4.2 MIDDLE TRANSPORT MOTOR .........................................................28
1.4.3 PRE-STACK TRANSPORT MOTOR ..................................................29
1.4.4 ENTRANCE TRANSPORT MOTOR ...................................................30
1.4.5 HORIZONTAL TRANSPORT MOTOR ...............................................31
1.4.6 TRAY LIFT MOTOR............................................................................31
1.4.7 LOWER JUNCTION GATE MOTOR...................................................33
1.4.8 SHIFT MOTOR / LOWER JUNCTION GATE HP SENSOR / SHIFT
ROLLER HP SENSOR.................................................................................34
1.4.9 PAPER EXIT GATE MOTOR ..............................................................36
1.4.10 PAPER EXIT GATE HP SENSOR ................................................38
1.4.11 CORNER STAPLING PAPER SENSORS ....................................39
1.4.12 PROOF TRAY FULL SENSOR .....................................................40
1.4.13 PROOF TRAY EXIT SENSOR ......................................................40
1.4.14 POSITIONING ROLLER MOTOR / FEED OUT GUIDE HP
SENSOR ......................................................................................................41
1.4.15 ENTRANCE SENSOR ..................................................................42
1.4.16 HORIZONTAL TRANSPORT SENSOR ........................................43
1.4.17 SWITCHBACK TRANSPORT SENSOR / PAPER TRANSPORT
SENSOR ......................................................................................................44
1.4.18 SHIFT TRAY LOWER LIMIT SENSORS .......................................45
1.4.19 BOOKLET PAPER FULL SENSOR 1, BOOKLET PAPER FULL
SENSOR 2 (D688 ONLY) ............................................................................46
1.5 BOOKLET UNIT (D688 ONLY) ....................................................................47
1.5.1 BOOKLET UNIT .................................................................................47
1.5.2 PRESS FOLDING MOTOR ................................................................50
1.5.3 BOOKLET JOGGER MOTOR ............................................................53
1.5.4 BOOKLET GUIDE MOTOR ................................................................53
1.5.5 MOVEMENT ROLLER TRANSPORT MOTOR ..................................54
1.5.6 BOOKLET FENCE MOTOR ...............................................................54
1.5.7 FOLDING TRANSPORT MOTOR.......................................................55
1.5.8 BOOKLET STAPLER MOTOR UNIT ..................................................55
1.5.9 TRAY UPPER LIMIT SWITCH............................................................56
1.5.10 FOLDING BLADE CAM HP SENSOR ...........................................59
1.5.11 BOTTOM PAPER EXIT SENSOR .................................................61
1.5.12 BOOKLET PAPER SENSOR (UPPER) ........................................63
1.5.13 BOOKLET PAPER SENSOR (LOWER)........................................64
1.5.14 BOOKLET ADJUSTMENT HP SENSOR ......................................64
1.5.15 BOOKLET JOGGER HP SENSOR ...............................................65
D688/D689 ii SM
1.5.16 BOOKLET GUIDE SENSOR .........................................................66
1.5.17 BOOKLET BOTTOM FENCE HP SENSOR ..................................67
1.6 PUNCH UNIT ...............................................................................................68
1.7 ADJUSTMENT OF THE FLAT FOLD BOOKLET UNIT ...............................70
1.7.1 ADJUSTING THE ALIGNMENT OF THE FLAT FOLD ROLLERS......70
1.7.2 ADJUSTING THE FOLDING SPEED .................................................73
1.8 STAPLER UNIT ...........................................................................................74
1.8.1 STAPLER MOVEMENT MOTOR .......................................................75
1.8.2 STAPLER MOVEMENT HP SENSOR ................................................76
SM iii D688/D689
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
Spring
Timing belt
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.1 EXTERIOR COVERS
3. Open the front door [A], and remove the screws secured on the front side of the upper
cover [B] ( 2)
4. Remove the screws secured on the rear side of the upper cover [A] ( 2, hook2)
SM 1 D688/D689
Exterior Covers
Check the positions of the bosses and hooks before removing the upper cover.
D688/D689 2 SM
Exterior Covers
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.1.2 FRONT COVER, FRONT LEFT SIDE COVER, FRONT INNER
FINISHER SR3160
COVER
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Open the front cover [A].
2. Release the shaft bracket [B] ( upper direction) ( 1).
3. Front cover [A].
Note that there is a LED connector inside the front inner cover. Be careful when
removing the front inner cover.
SM 3 D688/D689
Exterior Covers
Check the positions of the bosses and hooks before removing the paper exit cover.
D688/D689 4 SM
Exterior Covers
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.1.4 LOWER TRAY
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Lower tray [A]
SM 5 D688/D689
Exterior Covers
D688/D689 6 SM
Exterior Covers
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.1.7 END FENCE (D688 ONLY)
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Remove the following covers.
Front cover (page 3)
Front left side cover (page 3)
Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Upper tray [A] ( 1)
SM 7 D688/D689
Exterior Covers
D688/D689 8 SM
Exterior Covers
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
1. Upper tray [A] ( 1)
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
2. Rear mold bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 9 D688/D689
Exterior Covers
D688/D689 10 SM
Boards
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.2 BOARDS
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.2.1 MAIN BOARD
1. Remove the following covers.
Rear upper cover (page 1)
Rear lower cover (page 1)
2. Main board [A] ( 8, all)
Keep the EEPROM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static
electricity can damage EEPROM data.
Make sure that the DIP-switch settings on the old main board are the same for the new
main board. Do not change the DIP switches on the main board in the field.
1. Check the settings of dip switch [A] on the old main board.
2. Replace the main board.
3. Change the settings of dip switch [A] on the new main board to match the settings on the old
main board.
4. Make sure the switches of dip switch [B] on the new main board are all OFF.
SM 11 D688/D689
Boards
D688/D689 12 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.3 CORNER STAPLING UNIT
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.3.1 CORNER STAPLING UNIT
1. Remove the following covers.
Front cover (page 3)
Front left side cover (page 3)
Front inner cover (page 3)
End fence (page 7
Rear upper cover and Rear lower cover (page 1)
2. Screws ( 7).
SM 13 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
D688/D689 14 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
9. Release six clamps ( 6).
SM 15 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
12. Pull out the harnesses disconnected in step 13 to the right side of the finisher through
the hole [A].
13. Release four clamps ( 4).
D688/D689 16 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.3.2 STACKING ROLLER MOTOR
1. Corner stapling unit (page 13)
2. Stapler bracket [A] ( 3, 2)
SM 17 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
D688/D689 18 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.3.4 LEADING EDGE GUIDE MOTOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Corner stapling unit (page 13)
2. Stapler bracket [A] ( 3, 1)
SM 19 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
D688/D689 20 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.3.7 TRAILING EDGE PRESSURE PLATE HP SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Corner stapling unit (page 13)
2. Stapler bracket [A] ( 3, 1)
3. Turn back the stapler bracket, and remove the trailing edge pressure plate HP sensor
bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 21 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
3. Turn back the stapler bracket, and remove the tray upper limit switch [A] ( 1, 1)
D688/D689 22 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.3.9 FEED OUT MOTOR
1. Corner stapling unit (page 13)
2. Feed out motor [A] ( 2, 1, 2)
SM 23 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
D688/D689 24 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.3.12 JOGGER HP SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Jogger motor (page 24)
2. Screw ( 1)
SM 25 D688/D689
Corner Stapling Unit
D688/D689 26 SM
Corner Stapling Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.3.14 STAPLE TRAY PAPER SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Corner stapling unit (page 13)
2. Stapler bracket [A] ( 3, 1)
SM 27 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 28 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.4.3 PRE-STACK TRANSPORT MOTOR
1. Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Pre-stack transport motor [A] ( 2, 1, 1)
SM 29 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 30 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.4.5 HORIZONTAL TRANSPORT MOTOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Horizontal transport motor [A] ( 2, 1, 1)
SM 31 D688/D689
Main Unit
5. Turn back the tray lift motor bracket, and remove the connector and timing belt ( 1,
1)
D688/D689 32 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.4.7 LOWER JUNCTION GATE MOTOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Upper cover (page 1)
3. Proof tray (page 5)
4. Screws ( 2)
5. Remove the lower junction gate motor bracket [A] while sliding it ( 1)
SM 33 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 34 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
7. Shift roller HP sensor [A]
SM 35 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 36 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
8. Clamps in the proof tray ( 6)
9. Hold up the paper exit guide plate [A] to remove the clip [B] ( 1)
10. Turn back the paper exit guide plate [A] to remove the paper exit gate motor bracket [B]
( 2, 3, 1)
SM 37 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 38 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.4.11 CORNER STAPLING PAPER SENSORS
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Upper cover (page 1)
2. Proof tray (page 5)
3. Bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 39 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 40 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
SENSOR
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Front inner cover (page 3)
2. Positioning roller motor bracket [A] ( 3, 2, 2)
SM 41 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 42 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.4.16 HORIZONTAL TRANSPORT SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Front inner cover (page 3)
3. Screw and clamps ( 1, 10)
SM 43 D688/D689
Main Unit
D688/D689 44 SM
Main Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.4.18 SHIFT TRAY LOWER LIMIT SENSORS
1. Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Rear lower cover (page 1)
3. Shift tray lower limit sensors [A] ( 1 for each sensor)
SM 45 D688/D689
Main Unit
4. Booklet paper full sensor 1 [A], Booklet paper full sensor 2 [B]
D688/D689 46 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5 BOOKLET UNIT (D688 ONLY)
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.5.1 BOOKLET UNIT
1. Remove the following covers (page 1)
Rear Upper Cover
Rear Lower Cover
2. Remove the ground wire [A] in the left lower side of the main unit ( 1)
4. Disconnect the 7 connectors of the booklet unit from the main board as shown below
( 7)
SM 47 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
5. Open the front door [A] and pull out the booklet unit [B].
6. Remove the screws that hold the finisher and booklet unit. ( 6)
D688/D689 48 SM
SM
49
D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3170 /
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 50 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
7. Disconnect the connectors shown below ( 2)
SM 51 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
9. Remove the spring [B] from the press folding motor bracket [A] ( 1, 1)
D688/D689 52 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
1. Booklet unit (page 47)
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
2. Press folding motor bracket (page 50).
3. Booklet Jogger Motor [A] ( 2)
SM 53 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 54 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5.7 FOLDING TRANSPORT MOTOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Booklet unit (page 47)
2. Folding Transport Motor [A] ( 2, 1, 1)
3. Remove Booklet stapler motor unit [A] while sliding it to the front side and then pulling
it out from the rear part of the unit. ( 1)
SM 55 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 56 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
7. Disconnect the connectors shown below ( 2)
SM 57 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
9. Rotate the cam [A] to remove the screw of the tray upper limit switch bracket [B].
D688/D689 58 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1.5.10 FOLDING BLADE CAM HP SENSOR
1. Booklet unit (page 47)
2. Booklet unit front cover [A] ( 5, 2, 1, 2)
3. Bracket [A] ( 3, 1)
SM 59 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 60 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5.11 BOTTOM PAPER EXIT SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Booklet unit (page 47)
2. Booklet unit front cover [A] ( 5, 2, 1, 2)
SM 61 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 62 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5.12 BOOKLET PAPER SENSOR (UPPER)
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Booklet unit (page 47)
2. Bracket [A] ( 1, 1, 2)
SM 63 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 64 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5.15 BOOKLET JOGGER HP SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Pull out the booklet unit.
2. Bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 65 D688/D689
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
D688/D689 66 SM
Booklet Unit (D688 Only)
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.5.17 BOOKLET BOTTOM FENCE HP SENSOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Pull out the booklet unit.
2. Bracket [A] ( 1)
SM 67 D688/D689
Punch Unit
The punch unit is already adjusted in the factory, so you dont need to adjust it. When you need to
replace the parts of the punch unit, replace the whole unit.
Do not disassemble the punch unit. This unit is precisely adjusted in the factory.
Do not drop or give a shock to the unit when you replace it. The unit could be damaged.
1. Remove the following covers.
Rear upper cover and rear lower cover (page 1)
2. Stepper motor bracket [A] ( 2, 2, x2)
D688/D689 68 SM
SM
69
D688/D689
Punch Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
SR3170 /
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
Adjustment of the Flat Fold Booklet Unit
D688/D689 70 SM
Adjustment of the Flat Fold Booklet Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
4. Adjust the position of the flat fold lower roller [A] to adjust the difference in alignment
between the upper and lower rollers of the flat fold booklet unit.
To lower the booklet fold height (increase folding strength), roller offset is increased.
To raise the booklet fold height (decrease folding strength), roller offset is decreased.
When the machine is shipped from the factory, the booklet fold height is set low by
offsetting the rollers. However, since the folding strength is high, toner cracking
may occur at fold lines. In such a case, toner cracking at fold lines may be reduced
by adjusting the offset amount to 0 mm.
Difference in Alignment and Folding Strength
SM 71 D688/D689
Adjustment of the Flat Fold Booklet Unit
D688/D689 72 SM
Adjustment of the Flat Fold Booklet Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.7.2 ADJUSTING THE FOLDING SPEED
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
You can adjust the thickness of the booklet by adjusting the moving speed of the flat fold booklet
unit.
If you want to make the booklet thinner, set a slower speed. If you want to make the booklet
thicker, set a faster speed.
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Set the moving speed of the flat fold booklet unit for each paper size with SP6-114-001
to 010 (Fold Speed Adj.: 2K/3K FIN).
Default
SP Setting Items Selection
Value
SM 73 D688/D689
Stapler Unit
D688/D689 74 SM
Stapler Unit
BOOKLET FINISHER
1.8.1 STAPLER MOVEMENT MOTOR
FINISHER SR3160
(D688/D689)
SR3170 /
1. Remove the following cover.
Rear upper cover (page 1)
2. Stapler Movement Motor [A] ( 2, 1)
SM 75 D688/D689
Stapler Unit
D688/D689 76 SM
D690
INTERNAL FINISHER SR3130
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
INTERNAL FINISHER SR3130 (D690)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D690
1.5.10 PAPER OUTPUT MOTOR ............................................................30
1.6 STAPLER UNIT ...........................................................................................32
D690 ii SM
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
The Aim of Anti-tip Components and Precautions
The anti-tip components are necessary for meeting the requirements of IEC60950-1, the
international standard for safety.
The aim of these components is to prevent the products, which are heavy in weight, from toppling
as a result of people running into or leaning onto the products, which can lead to serious accidents
such as persons becoming trapped under the product. (U.S.: UL60950-1, Europe: EN60950-1)
Therefore, removal of such components must always be with the consent of the customer.
Do not remove them at your own judgment.
D690 4 SM
Inner Finisher
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1.1 INNER FINISHER
SM 1 D690
Inner Finisher
D690 2 SM
Covers and Trays
FINISHER SR3130
1.2 COVERS AND TRAYS
INTERNAL
(D690)
1.2.1 FINISHER FRONT COVER
1. Pull the finisher [A].
SM 3 D690
Covers and Trays
D690 4 SM
Covers and Trays
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Left lower cover [A] ( 2).
SM 5 D690
Control Board
When a control board is replaced, use the same DIP switch settings as those of the
control board before replacement.
1. Finisher front cover (page 3).
2. Control board [A] ( 3, all, plastic rivet1).
3. Release four clamps and remove the harness bracket [A] on the control board bracket
( 4).
D690 6 SM
SM
7
D690
Control Board
INTERNAL
FINISHER SR3130
(D690)
Sensors
1.4 SENSORS
D690 8 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1.4.2 PAPER EXIT FULL SENSOR
1. Paper output tray (page 5).
2. Paper exit full sensor [A] ( 1, 1).
SM 9 D690
Sensors
D690 10 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Finisher upper cover (page 4).
2. Transport sensor unit [A] ( 1, 1, 1).
SM 11 D690
Sensors
D690 12 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
1. Control board (page 6).
INTERNAL
(D690)
2. Rotate the paper output guide plate gear [A] counterclockwise, and release the paper
output guide plate [B] from the paper output guide plate HP sensor [C].
SM 13 D690
Sensors
D690 14 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Control board bracket (page 6).
2. Knob [A].
SM 15 D690
Sensors
D690 16 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Paper output cover (page 5).
2. Jogger fence home position sensor (front) unit [A] ( 1, 1, 1).
SM 17 D690
Sensors
D690 18 SM
Sensors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Paper output cover (page 5).
2. Paper exit roller unit [A] ( 1).
SM 19 D690
Sensors
When installing this sensor, be careful not to damage the sensor actuator.
D690 20 SM
Motors
FINISHER SR3130
1.5 MOTORS
INTERNAL
(D690)
1.5.1 ENTRANCE MOTOR
1. Finisher rear cover (page 4).
2. Finisher right rear bracket [A] ( 2).
SM 21 D690
Motors
D690 22 SM
Motors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
1. Paper output cover (page 5).
2. Paper bail motor [A] ( 2, 1).
SM 23 D690
Motors
D690 24 SM
Motors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
After attaching, rotate the knob, and check that all gear trains can rotate.
After attachment, when the cam [A] is rotated, check that the link [B] interlocks.
SM 25 D690
Motors
D690 26 SM
Motors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
When the finisher is inverted, be careful not to deform the frame.
1. Paper output cover (page 5).
2. Remove the four clamps ( 4).
3. Place the inner finisher upside down on the table with holding the parts below [A].
Hold the parts [A] shown below to lift the inner finisher. Otherwise, other brackets and
parts may be deformed.
SM 27 D690
Motors
During attachment, remove the jogger fence motor (rear) bracket, and check that the
motor pulley has not separated from the timing belt.
D690 28 SM
Motors
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
During attachment, check that the motor pulley has not separated from the timing
belt.
SM 29 D690
Motors
5. Remove the screws of the fan [A] and then lay it down ( 2).
D690 30 SM
SM
31
D690
Motors
INTERNAL
FINISHER SR3130
(D690)
Stapler Unit
D690 32 SM
Stapler Unit
FINISHER SR3130
INTERNAL
(D690)
7. Move the stapler unit to the front, and remove the cartridge [A].
SM 33 D690
Stapler Unit
D690 34 SM
D692
1 BIN TRAY BN3110
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
1 BIN TRAY BN3110 (D692)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D692
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Paper Sensor
BN3110 (D692)
1 BIN TRAY
1.1 PAPER SENSOR
The main power switch cover has three tabs: two on the left side (paper exit) and one
on the right side (right cover).
SM 1 D692
Paper Sensor
6. Cover [A].
Do not twist the cover to remove the cover as shown below. Otherwise, some hooks
inside the cover may be broken.
D692 2 SM
Paper Sensor
BN3110 (D692)
1 BIN TRAY
7. 1 bin tray [A] ( 1).
SM 3 D692
Paper Sensor
D692 4 SM
Controller Board
BN3110 (D692)
1 BIN TRAY
1. 1 bin tray unit (page 1).
2. Controller board [A] ( 1, 3).
SM 5 D692
D694
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3150
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3150 (D694)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D694
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
The Aim of Anti-tip Components and Precautions
The anti-tip components are necessary for meeting the requirements of IEC60950-1, the
international standard for safety.
The aim of these components is to prevent the products, which are heavy in weight, from toppling
as a result of people running into or leaning onto the products, which can lead to serious accidents
such as persons becoming trapped under the product. (U.S.: UL60950-1, Europe: EN60950-1)
Therefore, removal of such components must always be with the consent of the customer.
Do not remove them at your own judgment.
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
SM 1 D694
1.2 TRAY LIFT MOTOR
D694 2 SM
1.3 TRANSPORT MOTOR
SM 3 D694
1.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR
D694 4 SM
1.5 CONTROLLER BOARD
SM 5 D694
1.6 TRANSPORT SENSOR, LIMIT SENSOR, PAPER END
D694 6 SM
6. Paper end sensor [A] ( 1).
SM 7 D694
1.7 PAPER FEED UNIT
D694 8 SM
7. Harness guide [A] ( 2).
8. Release the clamp, and then disconnect the harness at the right rear of the unit ( 1,
1).
SM 9 D694
10. Paper feed unit [A] ( 2).
D694 10 SM
1.8 PICK-UP ROLLER, FEED ROLLER, FRICTION ROLLER
SM 11 D694
D694 12 SM
D716
PUNCH UNIT PU3040
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
PUNCH UNIT PU3040 (D716)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D716
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Punch Unit
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
1.1 PUNCH UNIT
SM 1 D716
Punch Unit
6. Hopper [A].
D716 2 SM
Punch Unit
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
8. Punch unit [A] ( 1).
SM 3 D716
Controller Board
D716 4 SM
Punch Unit Home Position Sensor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
1. Punch unit (page 1).
2. Upper front cover [A] ( 1).
SM 5 D716
Punch Motor
D716 6 SM
Punch Unit Pulse Detection Sensor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
1. Upper front cover (page 5).
2. Punch unit pulse detection sensor [A] ( 1, 1).
SM 7 D716
Horizontal Registration Movement Unit Home Position Sensor
D716 8 SM
Horizontal Registration Movement Unit Motor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
MOTOR
4. Bracket with the horizontal registration movement unit motor ( x3, x2).
5. Horizontal registration movement unit motor [A] ( x2, Timing belt x1).
SM 9 D716
Horizontal Registration Movement Unit Motor
D716 10 SM
Punch Unit
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
1. Upper front cover (page 5).
2. Upper cover [A] ( 2).
To prevent it from falling out, press the moving parts [A] of the detached upper inlet
guide plate into the groove in the blue circle.
SM 11 D716
Punch Unit
During attachment, attach while bringing moving parts close to the left-hand side.
D716 12 SM
Horizontal Registration Detection Unit Home Position Sensor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
HOME POSITION SENSOR
SM 13 D716
Horizontal Registration Detection Unit Home Position Sensor
When reassembling the horizontal registration detection unit [A], the protrusion of the
joint needs to be in the notch of the cam [B].
D716 14 SM
Horizontal Registration Detection Unit Motor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
MOTOR
SM 15 D716
Punch Hopper Full Sensor
D716 16 SM
Horizontal Registration Sensor
PU3040 (D716)
PUNCH UNIT
1. Horizontal registration detection unit (page 13).
2. Horizontal registration unit bracket [A] ( 2).
SM 17 D716
D725
SIDE TRAY TYPE M3
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
SIDE TRAY TYPE M3 (D725)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D725
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Drive Motor Unit
M3 (D725)
1.1 DRIVE MOTOR UNIT
SM 1 D725
Drive Motor Unit
D725 2 SM
Drive Motor Unit
SM 3 D725
Upper Paper Exit Sensor
D725 4 SM
Upper Paper Exit Sensor
SM 5 D725
Upper Paper Exit Sensor
D725 6 SM
Left Paper Exit Sensor
M3 (D725)
1. Upper paper exit tray (page 4).
2. Turn it upside down.
SM 7 D725
Upper Paper Exit Tray Set Switch
D725 8 SM
Paper Exit Switching Unit Set Switch
M3 (D725)
1. Open the Paper exit switching unit [A].
SM 9 D725
D766
INTERNAL FINISHER SR3180
RE V IS ION H IST ORY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Up d ated / New
None
INTERNAL FINISHER SR3180 (D766)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D766
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Internal Finisher SR3180
SR3180 (D766)
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1.1 INTERNAL FINISHER SR3180
SM 1 D766
Internal Finisher SR3180
5. Finisher [A].
D766 2 SM
Finisher Front Cover
SR3180 (D766)
1.2 FINISHER FRONT COVER
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Paper output cover (page 6).
2. Finisher front cover [A] ( 2).
SM 3 D766
Finisher Upper Cover
D766 4 SM
Paper Output Tray
SR3180 (D766)
1.4 PAPER OUTPUT TRAY
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Paper output tray [A] ( 2).
SM 5 D766
Paper Output Cover
D766 6 SM
Rear Cover
SR3180 (D766)
1.6 REAR COVER
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Finisher (page 1).
2. Rear cover [A] ( 2).
The screw on the right as you face the rear cover [A] is a step screw
SM 7 D766
Control Board
D766 8 SM
Entrance Sensor
SR3180 (D766)
1.8 ENTRANCE SENSOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Rear cover (page 7).
2. Remove the entrance sensor [A] together with the bracket ( 1, 1).
SM 9 D766
Transport Motor
3. Loosen the screw securing the spring bracket [A], and then release the belt tension
( 1).
D766 10 SM
Shift Motor
SR3180 (D766)
1.10 SHIFT MOTOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Finisher front cover (page 3).
2. Shift motor [A] ( 2, 1, 2).
SM 11 D766
Junction Solenoid Motor
D766 12 SM
Exit Paper Pressure Motor
SR3180 (D766)
1.12 EXIT PAPER PRESSURE MOTOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Paper output cover (page 6).
2. Rear cover (page 7).
3. Release the clamp ( 1).
SM 13 D766
Side-to-Side Registration Sensor
3. Remove the Side-to-Side registration sensor [A] together with the bracket ( 1).
D766 14 SM
Open/Close Door Switch
SR3180 (D766)
1.14 OPEN/CLOSE DOOR SWITCH
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Rear cover (page 7).
2. Remove the screw ( 1).
SM 15 D766
Shift Home Position Sensor
D766 16 SM
Paper Output Sensor
SR3180 (D766)
1.16 PAPER OUTPUT SENSOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Finisher upper cover (page 4).
2. Remove the screw ( 1).
SM 17 D766
Paper Output Pressure HP Sensor
D766 18 SM
Junction Solenoid Motor HP Sensor
SR3180 (D766)
1.18 JUNCTION SOLENOID MOTOR HP SENSOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Remove the screw ( 1).
SM 19 D766
Paper Output Full Sensor 1 / Paper Output Full Sensor 2 (Staple)
D766 20 SM
Stapler Unit
SR3180 (D766)
1.20 STAPLER UNIT
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Rear cover (page 7).
2. Disconnect the connecter and release the clamps ( 1, 2).
SM 21 D766
Stapler Unit
D766 22 SM
Stapler Drive HP Sensor
SR3180 (D766)
1.21 STAPLER DRIVE HP SENSOR
INTERNAL
FINISHER
1. Stapler unit (page 21).
2. Loosen the screw and release the clamp ( 1, 1).
SM 23 D766
Stapler Motor
D766 24 SM
D779
ARDF DF3090
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
ARDF DF3090 (D779)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D779
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
Covers and Original Tray
ARDF DF3090
(D779)
1.1 COVERS AND ORIGINAL TRAY
1.1.1 DF REPLACEMENT
1. Scanner rear cover [A] ( 3).
2. The screw on harness securing bracket, and then the connector and screw on the
earth plate ( 2, 1).
SM 1 D779
Covers and Original Tray
D779 2 SM
Covers and Original Tray
ARDF DF3090
(D779)
1. Open the left cover.
2. Rear cover (page 2).
3. Front cover [A] ( 1).
Keep the original tray open when you remove the front cover.
4. Original tray [A] ( 1, 1, 1).
SM 3 D779
Original Feed Unit
Pull the original feed unit forward to release the back side of the shaft.
D779 4 SM
Pick-Up Roller
ARDF DF3090
1.3 PICK-UP ROLLER
(D779)
1. Original feed unit (page 4)
2. Pick-up roller [A] ( 1)
SM 5 D779
Feed Belt
When reassembling the feed belt cover, make sure that the projection [B] of the feed
belt cover is on the guide plate rear [C].
3. Belt tension unit [D]
D779 6 SM
Separation Roller
ARDF DF3090
1.5 SEPARATION ROLLER
(D779)
1. Original Feed Unit (page 4).
2. Separation roller cover [A].
SM 7 D779
ARDF Drive Board and DF Position Sensor
D779 8 SM
Original Length Sensors and Original Sensor
ARDF DF3090
1.7 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND ORIGINAL
(D779)
SENSOR
SM 9 D779
Original Set Sensor
D779 10 SM
Original Set Sensor
ARDF DF3090
(D779)
6. Original set sensor bracket [A] (hook 2).
SM 11 D779
Original Size Sensors and Skew Correction Sensor
SENSOR
D779 12 SM
Stamp Solenoid
ARDF DF3090
1.10 STAMP SOLENOID
(D779)
1. Rear cover (page 2).
2. Stamp solenoid harness [A] ( 1, 1).
SM 13 D779
Stamp Solenoid
D779 14 SM
Original Exit Sensor
ARDF DF3090
1.11 ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR
(D779)
1. Original feed-in guide plate (page 10).
2. The Original Exit Sensor [A] is located in the ARDF mainframe.
SM 15 D779
Registration Sensor
D779 16 SM
Left Cover Switch
ARDF DF3090
1.13 LEFT COVER SWITCH
(D779)
1. Rear cover (page 2).
2. Left cover switch [A] ( 2, 2).
SM 17 D779
Feed Motor
4. Feed motor with bracket [A] ( 2, spring [B]1, Timing belt 1).
D779 18 SM
Feed Motor
ARDF DF3090
(D779)
5. Feed motor [A] ( 2).
SM 19 D779
Pick-up Solenoid
D779 20 SM
Inverter Solenoid
ARDF DF3090
1.16 INVERTER SOLENOID
(D779)
1. Rear cover (page 2).
2. Harness guide (page 18).
3. Inverter solenoid [A] ( 2, 1, 1, gear 1, gear cover 1, Timing belt 1).
SM 21 D779
Feed Clutch
D779 22 SM
Transport Motor
ARDF DF3090
1.18 TRANSPORT MOTOR
(D779)
1. Rear cover (page 2).
2. Transport motor bracket [A] (spring 1, 2, 1).
SM 23 D779
D787
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3220 / PB3210
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3220 / PB3210
(D787)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i D787
READ THIS FIRST
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
The Aim of Anti-tip Components and Precautions
The anti-tip components are necessary for meeting the requirements of IEC60950-1, the
international standard for safety.
The aim of these components is to prevent the products, which are heavy in weight, from toppling
as a result of people running into or leaning onto the products, which can lead to serious accidents
such as persons becoming trapped under the product. (U.S.: UL60950-1, Europe: EN60950-1)
Therefore, removal of such components must always be with the consent of the customer.
Do not remove them at your own judgment.
Rear Cover
PB3220 / PB3210
(D787)
1.1 REAR COVER
SM 1 D787
Tray Lift Motor (Upper)
D787 2 SM
Tray Lift Motor (Lower)
(D787)
1. Rear cover (page 1).
2. Tray lift motor (lower) [A] ( 2, 1).
SM 3 D787
Transport Motor
D787 4 SM
Paper Feed Motor
(D787)
1. Rear cover (page 1).
2. Paper feed motor [A] ( 2, 1).
SM 5 D787
Controller Board
D787 6 SM
Transport Sensor, Limit Sensor, Paper End Sensor, Paper Feed Sensor
(D787)
SENSOR, PAPER FEED SENSOR
SM 7 D787
Transport Sensor, Limit Sensor, Paper End Sensor, Paper Feed Sensor
D787 8 SM
2nd Paper Feed Unit
(D787)
1. Pull out the paper trays.
2. Rear cover (page 1).
3. Right front cover [A] ( 1).
SM 9 D787
2nd Paper Feed Unit
D787 10 SM
2nd Paper Feed Unit
SM 11 D787
2nd Paper Feed Unit
12. Release the clamps, and then disconnect the harness at the right rear of the unit
( 1, 4).
D787 12 SM
1st Paper Feed Unit
(D787)
1. 2nd Paper feed unit (page 9).
2. Release the clamps, and then disconnect the harness at the right rear of the unit
( 1, 6).
SM 13 D787
Pick-up Roller, Feed Roller, Friction Roller
D787 14 SM
Pick-up Roller, Feed Roller, Friction Roller
SM 15 D787